16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
0 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
As you read this manual, you will find Information that is preceded
by a NOTICE symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid
damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
Symbols
on labels attached to your vehicle are to remind
you to read this owner’s manual for proper and safe operation of
your vehicle.
is colour-coded to indicate “danger” (red), “warning”
(orange), or “caution” (amber).
A Few Words About Safety
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And
operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.
To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and other information on labels and
in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that
could hurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You
must use your own good judgement.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
● Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
● Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol 3 and
one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don’t follow instructions.
You CAN be HURT if you don’t follow
instructions.
● Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
● Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
● Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information - please
read it carefully.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
1 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Event Data Recorders
Service Diagnostic Recorders
Your vehicle is equipped with several devices commonly referred to
as Event Data Recorders. They record various types of real time
vehicle data such as SRS airbag deployment and SRS system
components failure.
This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by
anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the
vehicle owner.
However this data may be accessed by Honda, its authorised
dealers and authorised repairers, employees, representatives and
contractors only for the purpose of the technical diagnosis,
research and development of the vehicle.
Your vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record
information about powertrain performance and driving conditions.
The data can be used to help technicians diagnose, repair and
maintain the vehicle. This data may not be accessed by anyone else
except as legally required or with the permission of the vehicle
owner.
However this data may be accessed by Honda, its authorised
dealers and authorised repairers, employees, representatives and
contractors only for the purpose of the technical diagnosis,
research and development of the vehicle.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
4 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Contents
This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your
particular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual represent features and
equipment that are available on some, but not all, models. Your
particular model may not have some of these features.
2 Safe Driving P. 33
For Safe Driving P. 34
Seat Belts P. 38
Airbags P. 50
2 Instrument Panel P. 85
Indicators P. 86
Gauges and Displays P. 128
2 Controls P. 145
Clock P. 146
Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 148
Opening and Closing the Windows P. 167
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 172
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 207
2 Features P. 229
The information and specifications included in this publication were
in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.
reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications
or design at any time without notice and without incurring any
obligation.
Audio System P. 230
Audio System Basic Operation P. 237, 268
Customized Features P. 322
Hands-Free Telephone System P. 348
2 Driving P. 387
Before Driving P. 388
Towing a Trailer P. 392
When Driving P. 397
Refueling P. 479
Multi-View Rear Camera * P. 477
2 Maintenance P. 485
Although this manual is applicable to both right-hand and left-hand
drive models, the illustrations contained in this manual mainly refer
to the left-hand drive models.
Before Performing Maintenance P. 486
Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Regeneration * P. 517
Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 534
Battery P. 540
2 Handling the Unexpected P. 555
Tools P. 556
Overheating P. 583
Refueling P. 605
If a Tyre Goes Flat P. 557
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 585
2 Information P. 607
Specifications P. 608
Identification Numbers P. 614
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
5 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Contents
Quick Reference Guide
Child Safety P. 63
Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 82
Opening and Closing the Tailgate P. 161
Opening and Closing the Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade * P. 170
Adjusting the Mirrors P. 193
Adjusting the Seats P. 197
Climate Control System P. 219
Security System P. 163
Audio Error Messages P. 314
General Information on the Audio System P. 317
Braking P. 458
Fuel Economy P. 483
Parking Your Vehicle P. 472
Accessories and Modifications P. 484
Service Reminder System * P. 489
Replacing Light Bulbs P. 519
Remote Transmitter Care P. 544
Maintenance Under the Bonnet P. 502
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 530
Climate Control System Maintenance P. 546
Engine Does Not Start P. 575
Fuses P. 591
Jump Starting P. 579
Emergency Towing P. 600
Devices that Emit Radio Waves * P. 615
P. 4
Safety Labels P. 83
Cleaning P. 549
Shift Lever Does Not Move P. 582
When You Cannot Open the TailgateP. 603
EC Declaration of conformity Content Outline * P. 616
Safe Driving
P. 33
Instrument Panel
P. 85
Controls
P. 145
Features
P. 229
Driving
P. 387
Maintenance
P. 485
Handling the Unexpected
P. 555
Information
P. 607
Index
P. 617
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
4 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Quick Reference Guide
Visual Index
Left-hand drive type
Quick Reference Guide
❙ System Indicators (P86)
❙ Gauges (P128)
❙ Multi-information Display (P129)
❙ Clock (P146)
❙ Hazard Warning Button
❙ Audio/Information Screen (P238, 269)
❙ Audio System (P230)
❙ Climate Control System (P219)
❙ Rear Window Demister/Heated Door
Mirror Icon (P191)
❙ Auto Idle Stop OFF Button (P415, 419)
❙ ENGINE START/STOP Button * (P173)
❙ Ignition Switch * (P172)
❙ Steering Wheel Adjustments (P192)
❙ (Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System OFF) Button (P454)
❙ Parking Sensor System Button * (P474)
❙ Lane Departure Warning Button * (P443)
❙ Headlight Adjuster * (P183)
❙ ECON Button (P423)
4
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
Right-hand drive type
5 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
❙ System Indicators (P86)
❙ Gauges (P128)
❙ Multi-Information Display (P129)
❙ Clock (P146)
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Audio/Information Screen (P238, 269)
❙ Audio System (P 230)
❙ Hazard Warning Button
❙ Ignition Switch * (P172)
❙ ECON Button (P423)
❙ (Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)
System OFF) Button (P454)
❙ Parking Sensor System Button *
(P474)
❙ Lane Departure Warning Button *
(P443)
❙ Ultrasonic Sensor OFF Button *
(P165)
❙ Headlight Adjuster * (P183)
❙ Steering Wheel Adjustments (P192)
❙ ENGINE START/STOP Button * (P173)
❙ Climate Control System (P219)
❙ Auto Idle Stop OFF Button (P415, 419)
❙ Rear Window Demister/Heated Door Mirror Icon (P191)
* Not available on all models
5
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
6 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Headlights/Turn Signals (P177)
❙ Front Fog Lights * (P181)
❙ Rear Fog Light (P181)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift down) * (P409)
❙
(Display) Button * (P234)
❙ (Select/Reset) Knob (P190)
❙ Brightness Control (P190)
❙ Paddle Shifter (Shift up) * (P409)
❙ Wipers/Washers (P187)
❙ Cruise Control Buttons (P424)
/Adjustable Speed Limiter Buttons (P427)
/Intelligent Speed Limiter Buttons * (P431)
❙
(information) Buttons (P129)
❙ SEL/RESET Button (P130)
❙ Horn (Press an area around
❙ Hands-Free Telephone System Buttons (P348, 369)
❙ Audio Remote Controls (P234)
6
.)
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
Left-hand drive type
7 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
❙ Passenger’s Front Airbag (P52)
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Power Window Switches (P167)
❙ Power Door Lock Master Switch (P159)
❙ Door Mirror Controls (P194)
❙ Interior Fuse Box (P594)
❙ Driver’s Front Airbag (P52)
❙ Seat Heater Icons *(P218)
❙ Glove Box (P210)
❙ Shift Lever
Continuously Variable
Transmission * (P405, 407)
Manual Transmission * (P412)
❙ USB Port(s) (P231)
❙ HDMITM Port * (P232)
❙ Accessory Power Socket (P214)
❙ Electric Parking Brake Switch (P458)
❙ Automatic Brake Hold Button (P461)
❙ Bonnet Release Handle (P504)
❙ Fuel Fill Door Release Handle (P481)
* Not available on all models
7
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
8 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Visual Index
Right-hand drive type
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Glove Box (P210)
❙ Passenger's Front Airbag (P52)
❙ USB Port(s) (P231)
❙ HDMITM Port * (P232)
❙ Accessory Power Socket (P214)
❙ Driver's Front Airbag (P52)
❙ Interior Fuse Box (P594)
❙ Door Mirror Controls (P194)
❙ Power Door Lock Master Switch
(P159)
❙ Power Window Switches (P167)
❙ Fuel Fill Door Release Handle
(P481)
❙ Bonnet Release Handle (P504)
❙ Seat Heater Icons
❙ Shift Lever
* (P218)
Continuously Variable Transmission * (P405, 407)
Manual Transmission * (P412)
❙ Electric Parking Brake Switch (P458)
❙ Automatic Brake Hold Button (P461)
8
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
9 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor (P46)
❙ Map Lights (P208)
❙ Seat Belts (P38)
❙ Seat Belt (Installing a Child Restraint System) (P75)
❙ Seat Belt to Secure a Child Restraint System (P75)
❙ Side Curtain Airbags (P59)
❙ Grab Handle
❙ Coat Hooks (P216)
❙ Sun Visors
❙ Vanity Mirrors
❙ Rearview Mirror (P193)
❙ Map Lights (P208)
❙ Panoramic Glass Roof/Sunshade
Switch * (P170)
❙ Side Airbags (P57)
❙ Front Seat (P197)
❙ Rear Seat (P203)
❙ Lower Anchorage Points to Secure a Child Restraint System (P72)
❙ Luggage Area Light (P209)
❙ Under-Floor Storage Area (P213)
❙ Tonneau Cover * (P217)
* Not available on all models
9
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
10 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❙ Maintenance Under the Bonnet (P502)
❙ Windscreen Wipers (P187, 530)
❙ Power Door Mirrors (P194)
❙ Side Turn Signal Lights (P177, 524)
❙ Door Lock/Unlock Control (P152)
❙ Headlights (P178, 519)
❙ Front Turn Signal Lights (P177, 523)
❙ Position Lights (P178, 524)
❙ Daytime Running Lights (P186, 524)
❙ Tyres (P534, 557)
❙ Front Fog Lights * (P181, 521)
❙ How to Refuel (P481, 482)
❙ High-Mount Brake Light (P527)
❙ Multi-View Rear Camera * (P477)
❙ Rear Wiper (P189, 532)
❙ Opening/Closing the Tailgate (P161)
❙ Tailgate Release Button (P162)
❙ Rear Licence Plate Lights (P527)
❙ Brake/Taillights (P526)
❙ Back-Up Lights (P526)
❙ Rear Turn Signal Lights (P525)
❙ Rear Fog Light (P181, 528)
10
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
11 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Eco Assist System
Quick Reference Guide
ECON Mode Indicator (P104)
Comes on when ECON button is pressed.
Ambient Meter
● Changes colour to reflect your driving style.
Green: Fuel efficient driving
Light green: Moderate acceleration/deceleration
White: Aggressive acceleration/deceleration
● The ambient meter colour changes in accordance with
your brake or accelerator pedal operation.
● You can change the white to some colours.
2 Customized Features (P136)
ECON Button (P423)
Helps to maximise fuel economy.
The message is displayed for a few seconds
when the ECON button is pressed.
* Not available on all models
11
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
12 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Auto Idle Stop Function
Quick Reference Guide
To improve fuel economy, the engine stops and then restarts as detailed below. When Auto Idle Stop is on, the Auto Idle Stop indicator
(green) comes on. (P415, 419)
At
Deceleration
Continuously variable transmission
Stop the vehicle and depress the
brake pedal.
Manual transmission
●
●
Engine status
Depress the brake pedal.
Fully depress the clutch pedal.
b
a
On
Stop
Keep the brake pedal depressed.
●
●
●
Continue to depress the brake pedal.
Move the shift lever to (N .
Release the clutch pedal.
Off
Start-up
Release the brake pedal.
●
●
●
Depress the clutch pedal again.
Move the shift lever to (1 .
Depress the accelerator pedal to
resume driving.
Restarting
12
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
13 ページ
Safe Driving
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
(P33)
Child Safety (P63)
● All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat.
● Small children should be properly restrained in a front facing child restraint
system.
● Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child restraint system on a
rear seat.
Quick Reference Guide
Airbags (P50)
● Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help to protect you and
your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision.
Exhaust Gas Hazard (P82)
● Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain
carbon monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces
where carbon monoxide gas can accumulate.
Seat Belts (P38)
● Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well
back in the seat.
● Check that your passengers are wearing
their seat belts correctly.
Before Driving Checklist (P37)
● Before driving, check that the front seats, head restraints,
steering wheel, and mirrors have been properly adjusted.
Fasten your lap belt as
low as possible.
13
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
14 ページ
2017年9月8日
Instrument Panel
午後1時53分
(P85)
Quick Reference Guide
Gauges (P128)/Multi-Information Display (P129)/System Indicators (P86)
Tachometer
Shift Lever Position
Indicator *
Ambient Meter
Speedometer
Multi-Information Display
System Indicators
System Indicators
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
Charging System
Indicator
Low Oil Pressure Indicator
High Temperature
Indicator (Red)
Low Temperature
Indicator (Blue)
Vehicle Stability Assist
(VSA) System Indicator
Turn Signal and Hazard
Warning Indicators
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
Door and Tailgate
Open Indicator
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
VSA OFF Indicator
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator
System Message
Indicator
Immobilizer System
Indicator
Keyless Access System
Indicator *
ECON mode Indicator
Lane Departure
Warning Indicator *
Forward Collision
Warning Indicator *
City-Brake Active System
(CTBA) Indicator
14
金曜日
Security System
Alarm Indicator *
Fuel Gauge
Ambient Meter
M (7-speed manual shift mode) Indicator/
Shift Indicator */Shift Up/Down Indicator *
Shift Up/Down
Indicator *
System Indicators
Automatic Brake Hold
System Indicator
Automatic Brake Hold
Indicator
Electric Parking Brake
System Indicator
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator
Lights Indicators
Lights On Indicator
Brake System
Indicator (Red)
Brake System
Indicator (Amber)
Auto Idle Stop
Indicator (Green)
Auto Idle Stop System
Indicator (Amber)
Glow Plugs Indicator *
High Beam Indicator
Low Fuel Indicator
Front Fog Light
Indicator *
Rear Fog Light
Indicator
High Beam Support
System Indicator *
Low Tyre Pressure/
Deflation Warning
System Indicator
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
Controls
15 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
(P145)
Models with colour audio system
Models with display audio system
Quick Reference Guide
Clock (P146)
Models with navigation system
The navigation system receives signals from
GPS satellites, updating the clock
automatically.
You should customize the time zone and
daylight saving.
2 Customized Features (P322)
All models
The clock in the multi-information display is
automatically updated along with the audio
system’s clock display.
a
Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK
button.
b
Rotate
.
to change hour, then press
c
Rotate
press
.
to change minute, then
d
Select Set, then press
.
These indications are used to show how to
operate the LIST/SELECT (List/Selector) knob.
• Rotate
to select.
• Press
to enter.
a
Select the
b
Select Settings.
c
Select Info.
d
Select the Clock tab.
e
Select Clock Adjustment.
f
Select 3 or 4 to change hour.
g
Select 3 or 4 to change minute, then
select OK.
icon.
* Not available on all models
15
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
16 ページ
ENGINE START/STOP
Button * (P173)
Quick Reference Guide
Press the button to change the vehicle’s
power mode.
2017年9月8日
午後1時53分
Turn Signals (P177)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Lights (P178)
Light Control Switches
Right
High Beam
Low
Beam
Flashing
Left
16
金曜日
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
17 ページ
Wipers and Washers
(P187)
MIST
OFF
AUTO*1: Wiper speed varies
automatically
INT*2: Low speed with
intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
金曜日
午後1時53分
Steering Wheel (P192)
● To adjust, pull the adjustment lever
towards you, adjust to the desired
position, then lock the lever back in place.
To adjust
Unlocking the Front
Doors from the Inside
(P158)
● Pull either front door inner handle to
unlock and open it in one motion.
Quick Reference Guide
Wiper/Washer Control Lever
2017年9月8日
To lock
Pull towards
you to spray
washer fluid.
Left-hand drive type
● Unlocking and opening the driver’s door
from the inner handle unlocks all the
other doors and the tailgate.
Adjustment Ring
: Low Sensitivity*1
: Lower speed, fewer sweeps*2
: High Sensitivity*1
: Higher speed, more sweeps*2
*1: Vehicle with automatic intermittent
wipers
*2: Vehicle without automatic intermittent
wipers
* Not available on all models
17
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
18 ページ
2017年9月8日
Tailgate (P161)
金曜日
午後1時53分
Power Door Mirrors
Power Windows (P167)
(P194)
● With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, open
and close the power windows.
● If the power window lock button is in the
off position, each passenger's window
can be opened and closed with its own
switch.
● If the power window lock button is in the
on position (indicator on), each
passenger's window switch is disabled.
Quick Reference Guide
● With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, move
the selector switch to L or R.
● Push the appropriate edge of the
adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
● Press the folding button to fold in and
out the door mirrors.
Selector Switch
Folding Button
Models without keyless access system
Indicator
● With all the doors unlocked, press the
tailgate release button and lift open the
tailgate.
Models with keyless access system
● Press the tailgate release button to
unlock and open the tailgate when you
carry the keyless remote.
Adjustment Switch
Window Switch
Power Window
Lock Button
*1 : Models with the keyless access system have an
ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition
switch.
18
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
19 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Climate Control System (P219)
Quick Reference Guide
● Select the AUTO icon to activate the climate control system.
● Select the
icon to turn the system on or off.
● Select the
icon to defrost the windscreen.
Models with SYNC icon
Dashboard
vents
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor
vents
Floor and
demister
vents
Mode Control Icon
Driver’s Side
Temperature Control
Icons
Passenger’s Side
Temperature Control
Icons
AUTO Icon
(On/Off) Icon
(Windscreen Demister)
Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
SYNC (Synchronized) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
Fan Speed Control Icon
19
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
20 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Models without SYNC icon
Quick Reference Guide
Dashboard
vents
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor
vents
Floor and
demister
vents
Mode Control Icon
Fan Speed Control Icons
Temperature Control Icons
AUTO Icon
(Windscreen Demister)
Icon
(On/Off) Icon
(Fresh Air) Icon
(Recirculation) Icon
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
20
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
Features
21 ページ
2017年9月8日
(P229)
金曜日
午後1時53分
Audio System (P230)
Models with colour audio system
(P237)
(P234)
Audio/Information Screen
(+ / (- /
/
Button
CD Slot
(CD Eject) Button
Button
Quick Reference Guide
Audio Remote Controls
SOURCE Button
● (+ / (- Button
Press to adjust the volume up/down.
● SOURCE Button
Models with colour audio system
Press to change the audio mode: FM1/
FM2/DAB1 */DAB2 */LW/MW/CD/USB/iPod/
Bluetooth® Audio/AUX.
RADIO Button
CD/AUX Button
VOL/
(Volume/Power)
Knob
LIST/SELECT
(Selector) Knob
MENU/CLOCK Button
Models with display audio system
Press to change the audio mode: FM/LW/
MW/DAB */CD/USB/iPod/Apps/Bluetooth®
Audio/AUX HDMITM
●
/
Button
Radio:Press to change the preset station.
Press and hold to select the next or
previous strong station.
CD/USB device:
Press to skip to the beginning of
the next song or return to the
beginning of the current song.
Press and hold to change a folder.
(Phone)
Button
TA Button
/
Buttons
(Skip/Seek)
(Back) Button
Preset Buttons (1-6)
* Not available on all models
21
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
Models with display audio system
22 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
(P268)
For navigation system operation () See the Navigation System Manual
Quick Reference Guide
CD Slot
(CD Eject) Button
Models with navigation system
Button
Button
(HOME) Icon
VOL (Volume) Icons
(MENU) Icon
(BACK) Icon
Audio/Information Screen
22
Models without navigation system
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
Driving
23 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
(P387)
● Shift to (P and depress the brake pedal when starting the engine.
Shifting
Models with
paddle shifter
Models without
paddle shifter
Depress the brake pedal and
press the release button to
move out of (P .
Move the shift lever without
pressing the release button.
Press the release button to
move the shift lever.
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode *(P409)
● Allows you to manually shift the transmission up or down
without removing your hands from the steering wheel.
When the shift lever is in (S
● Pulling a paddle shifter changes the mode from
continuously variable transmission to 7-speed manual
shift mode.
● The M indicator and the selected speed number are
displayed in the shift indicator.
When the shift lever is in (D
● Pulling a paddle shifter temporarily changes the mode
from continuously variable transmission to 7-speed
manual shift mode. The selected speed number is
displayed in the shift indicator.
M Indicator
Shift Lever
Park
Turn off or start the engine.
Transmission is locked.
Reverse
Used when reversing.
Neutral
Transmission is not locked.
Drive
Normal driving.
On models with paddle shifter,
D-paddle shift mode can be used.
Models with paddle shifter
S Position
7-speed manual shift mode can
be used.
Quick Reference Guide
Manual Transmission * (P412)
Continuously Variable Transmission * (P405, 407)
Shift Down (Paddle Shifter
Shift Up (+
Paddle Shifter
Shift Indicator
Release
Button
Models without paddle shifter
Drive (S)
● Better acceleration
● Used to increase engine braking
● Used when going up or down hills
Low
● Used to further increase engine braking
● Used when going up or down hills
* Not available on all models
23
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
24 ページ
金曜日
午後1時53分
Quick Reference Guide
Vehicle Stability Assist
(VSA) (P453)
Adjustable Speed Limiter
● The vehicle stability assist (VSA) system
helps to stabilise the vehicle during
cornering, and helps to maintain traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces.
● VSA comes on automatically every time
you start the engine.
● To turn VSA on or off, press and hold the
button until you hear a beep.
● This system enables you to set a maximum
speed that cannot be exceeded even if
you are depressing the accelerator pedal.
● To use the adjustable speed limiter, press
the MAIN button. Select the adjustable
speed limiter by pressing the LIM button,
then press the –/SET when your vehicle
reaches the desired speed.
● The vehicle speed limit can be set from 30
km/h (18 mph) to 250 km/h (156 mph).
Cruise Control (P424)
● Cruise control allows you to maintain a
set speed without keeping your foot on
the accelerator pedal.
● To use cruise control, press the MAIN
button. Select cruise control by pressing
the LIM button, then press –/SET once
you have achieved the desired speed
(above 30 km/h or 18 mph).
24
2017年9月8日
(P427)
Deflation Warning
System (DWS) (P455)
The DWS detects a change in tyre
revolutions as a decrease in tyre pressure.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
25 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Petrol models
Refueling (P479)
a
Pull the fuel fill door release handle.
b
Turn the fuel fill cap slowly to remove the cap.
c
Place the cap in the holder on the fuel fill door.
d
After refueling, screw the cap back on until it clicks at least
once.
Quick Reference Guide
Fuel recommendation: Premium unleaded petrol with a research octane number 95 or higher required
Fuel tank capacity:
50 L (11.0 Imp gal)
25
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
26 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Diesel models
Refueling (P480)
Quick Reference Guide
26
Fuel recommendation: EN 590 standard diesel fuel
Fuel tank capacity:
50 L (11.0 Imp gal)
a
Pull on the fuel fill door release handle under
the driver’s side lower outside corner of the
dashboard.
b
After refueling, wait for about 10 seconds
before removing the filler nozzle.
Wait for 10 seconds
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
27 ページ
Maintenance
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
(P485)
a
Pull the bonnet release handle under the corner of the
dashboard.
b
Locate the bonnet latch lever, push the lever and lift
up the bonnet.
c
When finished, close the bonnet and make sure it is
firmly locked in place.
Quick Reference Guide
Under the Bonnet (P502)
● Check engine oil, engine coolant, and washer fluid. Add
when necessary.
● Check brake fluid.
● Check the battery condition monthly.
Wiper Blades (P530)
● Replace blades if they leave streaks
across the windscreen.
Tyres (P534)
Lights (P519)
● Inspect tyres and wheels regularly.
● Check tyre pressures regularly.
● Install winter tyres for winter
driving.
● Inspect all lights regularly.
27
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
28 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Handling the Unexpected
Quick Reference Guide
28
Flat Tyre (P557)
(P555)
Engine Won’t Start (P575)
Overheating (P583)
● If the battery is dead, jump start using a
booster battery.
● Park in a safe location. If you do not see
steam under the bonnet, open the
bonnet, and let the engine cool down.
Indicators Come On (P585)
Blown Fuse (P591)
Emergency Towing (P600)
● Identify the indicator and consult the
owner’s manual.
● Check for a blown fuse if an electrical
device does not operate.
● Call a professional towing service if you
need to tow your vehicle.
Models with tyre repair kit
● Park in a safe location and repair the flat
tyre using the tyre repair kit.
Models with a compact spare tyre
● Park in a safe location and replace the
flat tyre with the compact spare tyre in
the luggage area.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
29 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
What to Do If
●
The steering wheel may be locked.
Models without keyless access system
●
Try to turn the steering wheel left and
right while turning the ignition key.
Models with keyless access system
●
Models without keyless access system
Move the steering wheel left and right
while pressing the ENGINE START/STOP
button at the same time.
Quick Reference Guide
The ignition switch does
not turn from (0 to (q *1.
Why?
The shift lever should be moved to (P .
The ignition switch does
not turn from (q to (0 and
I cannot remove the key.
Why?
Models with keyless access system
The power mode does not
change from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK). Why?
Why does the brake pedal
pulsate slightly when
applying the brakes?
This can occur when the ABS activates, and does not indicate a
problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never
pump the brake pedal.
*1 : Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
29
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
30 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Quick Reference Guide
The rear door cannot be
opened from inside the
vehicle. Why?
Check if the childproof lock is in the
lock position. If so, open the rear door
with the outside door handle.
To cancel this function, push the lever
to the unlock position.
Why do the doors lock
after I unlocked the doors
using a remote
transmitter?
If you do not open a door within 30 seconds, the doors are
relocked automatically for security.
Why does the beeper
sound when I open the
driver’s door?
The beeper sounds when:
● The exterior lights are left on.
● Auto Idle Stop is in operation.
Models with keyless access system
●
Why does the beeper
sound when I start driving?
30
The power mode is in ACCESSORY.
The beeper sounds when the driver and/or front passenger are
not wearing their seat belts.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
31 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Pressing the electric
parking brake switch does
not release the parking
brake. Why?
Press the electric parking brake switch with the brake pedal
depressed.
Depressing the accelerator
pedal does not release the
parking brake
automatically. Why?
●
●
Quick Reference Guide
Why do I hear a screeching
sound when I apply the
brake pedal?
Fasten the driver’s seat belt.
Check if the transmission is in (P or (N . If so, select any other
position.
31
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
32 ページ
Petrol models
Quick Reference Guide
32
Is it possible to use
unleaded petrol with a
Research Octane Number
(RON) of 91 or higher on
this vehicle?
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Your vehicle is designed to operate on premium unleaded
petrol with a research octane of 95 or higher. If this octane
grade is unavailable, regular unleaded petrol with a research
octane of 91 or higher may be used temporarily.
The use of regular unleaded petrol can cause metallic knocking
noises in the engine and will result in decreased engine
performance. The long-term use of regular-grade petrol can
lead to engine damage.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
33 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Safe Driving
You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.
For Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions ............. 34
Your Vehicle's Safety Features............ 36
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts........................ 38
Fastening a Seat Belt.......................... 43
Seat Belt Inspection............................ 48
Airbags
Airbag System Components............... 50
Types of Airbags ................................ 52
Front Airbags (SRS) ............................ 52
Side Airbags....................................... 57
Side Curtain Airbags .......................... 59
Airbag System Indicators.................... 60
Airbag Care ....................................... 62
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers ............... 63
Safety of Infants and Small Children .......66
Safety of Larger Children ................... 79
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas....................... 82
Safety Labels
Label Locations .................................. 83
33
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
34 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
For Safe Driving
The following pages explain your vehicle's safety features and how to use them
properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the
most important.
Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions
■ Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped
with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
■ Restrain all children
Children aged 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the
front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child restraint system.
Larger children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can
use the belt properly without a booster seat.
■ Be aware of airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants
who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children,
and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.
■ Don't drink and drive
Alcohol and driving don't mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to
changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink.
So don't drink and drive, and don't let your friends drink and drive, either.
34
1Important Safety Precautions
Some countries prohibit the use of mobile phones
other than hands-free devices by the driver while
driving.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
35 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Safety Precautions
■ Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely
■ Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds.
Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
Safe Driving
Engaging in mobile phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying
close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash.
Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to
divert some attention away from driving.
■ Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tyre blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous.
To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tyre pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
35
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
36 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle's Safety Features
Your Vehicle's Safety Features
1Your Vehicle's Safety Features
9
8
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that
work together to help to protect you and your
passengers during a crash.
9
6
7
8
10
7
6
7
8
9
10
Safety Cage
Crush Zones
Seats and Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Collapsible Steering Column
Seat Belts
Front Airbags
Side Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The following checklist will help you to take an active role in protecting yourself and
your passengers.
36
Some features do not require any action on your part.
These include a strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger compartment,
front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering
column, and tensioners that tighten the front and
rear outer seat belts in a sufficient crash.
However, you and your passengers cannot take full
advantage of these features unless you remain seated
in the correct position and always wear your seat
belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to
injuries if they are not used properly.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
37 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle's Safety Features
■ Safety Checklist
If the door and tailgate open indicator is on, a door
and/or the tailgate is not completely closed. Close all
doors and the tailgate tightly until the indicator goes
off.
2 Door and Tailgate Open Indicator P. 97
Safe Driving
For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items
each time before you drive.
• Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are
adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the
vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a
crash.
1Safety Checklist
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 197
• Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective
when the centre of the head restraint aligns with the centre of your head. Taller
persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 199
• Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any
passengers are properly belted as well.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 43
• Protect children by using seat belts or child restraint systems according to a child's
age, height and weight.
2 Child Safety P. 63
37
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
38 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts
Safe Driving
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you
connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety
features. They also help to keep you from being thrown against the inside of the
vehicle, against other passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat
belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full
advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.
In addition, seat belts help to protect you in almost every type of crash, including:
- frontal impacts
- side impacts
- rear impacts
- rollovers
1About Your Seat Belts
3 WARNING
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases
the chance of serious injury or death in a
crash, even though your vehicle has
airbags.
Be sure you and your passengers always
wear seat belts and wear them properly.
WARNING: Seat belts are designed to bear upon the
bony structure of the body, and should be worn low
across the front of the pelvis or the pelvis, chest and
shoulders, as applicable; wearing the lap section of
the belt across the abdominal area must be avoided.
WARNING: Seat belts should be adjusted as firmly as
possible, consistent with comfort, to provide the
protection for which they have been designed. A
slack belt will greatly reduce the protection afforded
to the wearer.
WARNING: Belts should not be worn with straps
twisted.
WARNING: Each belt assembly must only be used by
one occupant; it is dangerous to put a belt around a
child being carried on the occupant’s lap.
38
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
39 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Lap/shoulder seat belts
1About Your Seat Belts
■ Proper use of seat belts
Follow these guidelines for proper use:
• All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position
for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduce the effectiveness of the
belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
• Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
• Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort
or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability
and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
Continued
Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your
risk of serious injury.
Most countries require you to wear seat belts. Take
time to familiarise with the legal requirements of the
countries in which you will drive.
Safe Driving
All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency
locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to
restrain your body.
If you extend the seat belt too quickly, it will lock in
place. If this happens, slightly retract the seat belt,
then extend it slowly.
39
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
40 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Seat Belt Reminder
1Seat Belt Reminder
■ Front seats
Safe Driving
Your vehicle monitors the driver and front
passenger seat belt use. If the ignition switch
is turned to ON (w *1 before the driver's seat
belt is fastened, the indicator will blink. If the
driver does not fasten the belt, the indicator
will remain on.
The beeper will also periodically sound and
the indicator will blink while driving until the
driver's seat belt is fastened.
The indicator will also come on if a front passenger
does not fasten their seat belt within six seconds after
the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1.
The beeper will also periodically sound and the
indicator will blink while driving until the front
passenger’s seat belt is fastened.
When no one is sitting in the front passenger's seat,
or a child or small adult is riding there, the indicator
will not come on.
If the indicator comes on or the beeper sounds with
no front passenger, or with a passenger wearing the
seat belt, something may be interfering with the
occupant detection sensor. Check if:
• Heavy items are on the seat.
• A cushion is placed on the seat.
• A rear passenger is pushing or pulling on the back
of the front passenger’s seat.
• The front passenger is not sitting properly.
If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
40
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
41 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
: Latched
Your vehicle monitors rear seat belt use. A
multi-information display notifies you if any of
the rear seat belts are used.
With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, the
display appears when:
• Either rear door is opened and closed.
• Any rear passenger latches or unlatches
their seat belt.
Safe Driving
: Unlatched
■ Rear seats
The display also appears and the beeper
sounds if any rear passenger’s seat belt is
unlatched while driving.
To see the display again, press the
button repeatedly.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
41
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
42 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
Safe Driving
42
The front and rear outer seats are equipped with automatic seat belt tensioners to
enhance safety.
The tensioners automatically tighten the front
and rear outer seat belts during a moderateto-severe frontal collision, sometimes even if
the collision is not severe enough to inflate the
front airbags.
1Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The seat belt tensioners can only operate once.
If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come
on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and
thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not
offer protection in a subsequent crash.
During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
43 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Fastening a Seat Belt
After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well
back in the seat:
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 197
Pull out slowly.
No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat
belt or one that does not appear to be working
correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working
properly may not protect the occupant in a crash.
Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.
Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or
retractor mechanism.
Safe Driving
■ Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
1Fastening a Seat Belt
Correct
Seated
Posture
2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then
tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is
secure.
u Make sure that the belt is not twisted or
caught on anything.
Latch
Plate
Buckle
Continued
43
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
44 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Safe Driving
44
Lap belt
as low as
possible
3. Position the lap part of the belt as low as
possible across your hips, then pull up on
the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part
fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic
bones take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
4. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to
remove any slack, then check that the belt
rests across the centre of your chest and
over your shoulder. This spreads the forces
of a crash over the strongest bones in your
upper body.
1Fastening a Seat Belt
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning the seat belts can
cause serious injury or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are properly
positioned before driving.
To release the belt, push the red PRESS button and
then guide the belt by hand until it has retracted
completely.
When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is properly
stowed so that it will not get caught in the closing
door.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
45 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
1Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
Continued
The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four
levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height
one level at a time.
After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder
anchor position is secure.
Safe Driving
The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter
occupants.
1. Move the anchor up and down while
pulling the release outward.
2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests
across the centre of your chest and over
your shoulder.
Pull outward
45
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
46 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
1. Pull out the seat belt’s small latch plate and
the latch plate from each holding slot in the
ceiling.
Latch Plate
1Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
3 WARNING
Safe Driving
Using the seat belt with the detachable
anchor unlatched increases the chance of
serious injury or death in a crash.
Before using the seat belt, make sure the
detachable anchor is correctly latched.
Small Latch
Plate
Small Latch Plate
2. Line up the triangle marks on the small
latch plate and anchor buckle. Make sure
the seat belt is not twisted. Attach the belt
to the anchor buckle.
To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch
plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
Buckle
46
3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle.
Properly fasten the seat belt the same way
you fasten the lap/shoulder seat belt.
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
47 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Advice for Pregnant Women
Wear the shoulder belt
across the chest avoiding
the abdomen.
Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is
okay for you to drive.
To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your
unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front
airbag:
• When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle.
• When sitting in the front passenger's seat, adjust
the seat as far back as possible.
Safe Driving
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when
driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the
belt as low as possible across the hips.
1Advice for Pregnant Women
Wear the lap part of the
belt as low as possible
across the hips.
47
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
48 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuSeat Belt Inspection
Seat Belt Inspection
Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:
Safe Driving
• Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
• Check that the latches work smoothly and the belts retract easily.
u If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only
use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make
sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.
Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper
protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of
protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after
any collision.
1Seat Belt Inspection
3 WARNING
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can
result in serious injury or death if the seat
belts do not work properly when needed.
Check your seat belts regularly and have
any problem corrected as soon as possible.
WARNING: No modifications or additions should be
made by the user which will either prevent the seat
belt adjusting devices from operating to remove
slack, or prevent the seat belt assembly from being
adjusted to remove slack.
WARNING: It is essential to replace the entire
assembly after it has been worn in a severe impact
even if damage to the assembly is not obvious.
WARNING: Care should be taken to avoid
contamination of the webbing with polishes, oils and
chemicals, and particularly battery acid. Cleaning
may safely be carried out using mild soap and water.
The belt should be replaced if webbing becomes
frayed, contaminated or damaged.
48
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
49 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuSeat BeltsuSeat Belt Inspection
■ Anchorage points
Rear Seat
Safe Driving
When replacing the seat belts, use the
anchorage points shown in the images.
The front seat has a lap/shoulder belt.
Front Seat
The rear seat has three lap/shoulder belts.
49
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
50 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Airbags
Airbag System Components
Safe Driving
The front, front side, and side curtain
airbags are deployed according to the
direction and severity of impact. The airbag
system includes:
• Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
front airbags. The driver's airbag is stored
in the centre of the steering wheel; the
front passenger's airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked SRS
AIRBAG.
• Two side airbags, one for the driver and
one for a front passenger. The airbags are
stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
• Two side curtain airbags, one for each
side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored
in the ceiling, above the side windows.
The front and rear pillars are marked
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.
• An electronic control unit that continually
monitors and records information about
the sensors, the airbag activators, the
seat belt tensioners, and driver and front
passenger seat belt use when the ignition
switch is in ON (w *1.
• Automatic front and rear outer seat belt
tensioners.
• Impact sensors that can detect a
moderate-to-severe front or side impact.
• An indicator on the instrument panel that
alerts you to a possible problem with your
airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
• An indicator near the shift lever that
alerts you that the passenger’s front
airbag has been turned off.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have
an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
50
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
51 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
■ Important Facts About Your Airbags
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as
far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as
possible.
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together,
airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.
When driving, keep hands and arms out of the
deployment path of the front airbag by holding each
side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over
the airbag cover.
Safe Driving
Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So, while airbags help to save lives, they can cause burns, bruises,
and other minor injuries, sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing
their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.
1Important Facts About Your Airbags
Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that
can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags
deploy.
Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag.
Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp
object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the
covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags
or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.
51
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
52 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuTypes of Airbags
Types of Airbags
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:
• Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver's and front passenger's seats.
• Side airbags: Airbags in the driver's and front passenger's seat-backs.
• Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.
Each is discussed in the following pages.
1Types of Airbags
Front Airbags (SRS)
1Front Airbags (SRS)
The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help to
protect the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant's primary
restraint system.
■ Housing Locations
The front airbags are housed in the centre of the steering wheel for the driver, and
in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
52
The airbags can inflate whenever the ignition switch
is in ON (w *1.
After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a
small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion
process of the inflator material and is not harmful.
People with respiratory problems may experience
some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
Frontal airbags are designed to supplement the seat
belts to help to reduce the likelihood of head and
chest injuries in frontal crashes.
During a frontal crash severe enough to cause one or
both front airbags to deploy, only the driver’s front
airbag can inflate at different rates, depending on the
severity of the crash and/or other factors.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
53 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Operation
A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a
vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.
Safe Driving
Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions.
When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control
unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.
■ How the Front Airbags Work
While your seat belt restrains your torso, the
front airbag provides supplemental protection
for your head and chest.
The front airbags deflate immediately so that
they won't interfere with the driver's visibility
or the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.
Continued
53
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
54 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ When front airbags should not deploy
Safe Driving
54
Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and
help to save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might
occur during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.
Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration
causes a driver or front passenger to move towards the front of the vehicle. Side
airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help to reduce
the severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which
can cause the driver or passenger to move towards the side of the vehicle.
Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear
impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed
to deploy in such collisions.
Rollovers: Seat belts, side airbags, and side curtain airbags offer the best protection
in a rollover. Because front airbags could provide little if any protection, they are not
designed to deploy during a rollover.
■ When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the
vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy.
Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object
that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is
underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.
■ When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage
appears severe
Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of
visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some
collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags
would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they
had deployed.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
55 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Passenger Front Airbag Off System
1Passenger Front Airbag Off System
■ Passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch
When the passenger front airbag ON/OFF
switch is in:
OFF: The passenger front airbag is
deactivated. The passenger front airbag does
not inflate during a severe frontal crash that
inflates driver front airbag.
The passenger front airbag off indicator stays
on as a reminder.
ON: The passenger front airbag is activated. The
ON/OFF Switch
passenger front airbag on indicator is comes on
System Warning Label
and remain on for about 60 seconds.
■ To deactivate the passenger front airbag system
1. Set the parking brake, and turn the ignition
switch to LOCK (0 *1. Remove the key.
2. Open the front passenger’s door.
3. Insert the ignition key to the passenger
front airbag ON/OFF switch.
u The switch is located at the side panel of
the front passenger side instrument panel.
Passenger Front
Airbag ON/OFF
4. Turn the key to OFF, and remove it from
Switch
the switch.
Passenger Front
Airbag ON/OFF
Indicator
3 WARNING
The passenger front airbag system must be
turned off, if it is not avoidable to put a
rear-facing child restraint system in the
front passenger seat.
Safe Driving
If it is unavoidable to install a rear-facing child restraint system in the front passenger seat,
you must manually deactivate the passenger front airbag system, using the ignition key.
If the front passenger airbag inflates, it can
hit the rear-facing child restraint system
with enough force to kill or cause a very
serious injury to the infant.
3 WARNING
Make sure to turn on the passenger front
airbag system when a rear-facing child
restraint system is not used on the front
passenger seat.
Leaving the passenger front airbag system
deactivated can result in serious injury or
death in a crash.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
55
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
56 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Passenger front airbag off indicator
When the passenger front airbag system is activated, the indicator goes off after a
few seconds when you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
Safe Driving
When the passenger front airbag system is deactivated, the indicator stays on, or
goes off momentarily and comes back on.
■ Passenger front airbag off system label
The label is located at the side panel of the front passenger side instrument panel.
Infant in a rear-facing child restraint system:
May ride in front if it is unavoidable
Cannot ride in the front
Front passenger front airbag is: Active
Inactive
1Passenger Front Airbag Off System
NOTICE
• Use your vehicle’s ignition key to turn the
passenger front airbag ON/OFF switch. If you use a
different key, the switch can be damaged, or the
passenger front airbag system may not work
properly.
• Do not close the door or apply excessive load on
the ignition key while the key is in the passenger
front airbag ON/OFF switch. The switch or the key
can be damaged.
We strongly recommend that you must not install a
rear-facing child restraint system in the front
passenger seat.
2 Protecting Infants P. 66
It is your responsibility to change the setting of the
passenger front airbag system to OFF when you put
a rear-facing child restraint system on the front
passenger seat.
When a rear-facing child restraint system is not in use
in the front passenger seat, turn the system back on.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
56
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
57 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Side Airbags
The side airbags help to protect the upper torso of the driver or a front passenger
during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
■ Housing Locations
The side airbags are housed in the outside edge
of the driver’s and passenger’s seat-backs.
Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags.
They can interfere with the proper operation of the
airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.
Do not let the front passenger lean sideways with
their head in the deployment path of the side airbag.
An inflating side airbag can strike with strong force
and seriously injure the passenger.
Safe Driving
Your vehicle has the safety label on the front doorjambs to remind you of the side
airbag hazards.
The side airbags are especially hazardous if a child is sitting in the front seat.
1Side Airbags
If the impact is on the passenger’s side, the airbag
may not deploy when there is no passenger in the
front passenger seat.
Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
Housing
Location
■ Side Airbag Label
Follows
Owner’s
Manual
Instruction
Carefully
This label is attached to each front doorjamb.
Side Airbag
Safety Alert Symbol
Continued
57
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
58 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
■ Operation
1Side Airbags
Safe Driving
When
inflated
When the sensors detect a moderate-tosevere side impact, the control unit signals the
side airbag on the impact side to immediately
inflate.
Side
Airbag
■ When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side
of the vehicle's framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there
may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough
impact to deploy the airbag.
■ When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears
severe
It is possible for a side airbag to not deploy during an impact that results in
apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was towards
the far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle's crushable body parts
absorbed most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have
been needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.
58
Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers
without consulting a dealer.
Improperly replacing or covering front seat-back
covers can prevent your side airbags from properly
deploying during a side impact.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
59 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
The side curtain airbags to help to protect the heads of the driver and passengers in
outer seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
The side curtain airbags are located in the
ceiling above the side windows on both sides
of the vehicle.
The side curtain airbags are most effective when an
occupant is wearing their seat belt properly and
sitting upright, well back in their seat.
Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof
pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation
of the side curtain airbags.
Safe Driving
■ Housing Locations
1Side Curtain Airbags
Do not put a coat hanger or hard objects on a coat
hook. This could result in injuries if your side curtain
airbag inflates.
Side Curtain Airbag Storage
■ Operation
The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy
in a moderate-to-severe side impact.
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag
■ When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision
One or both side curtain airbags may inflate in a moderate-to-severe angled frontal
collision.
In this case, the side curtain airbags will deploy slightly after the front airbags.
59
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
60 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
Airbag System Indicators
If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator will come on and a
message appears on the multi-information display.
Safe Driving
■ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
■ When the ignition switch is turned to
ON (w *1
The indicator comes on for a few seconds,
then goes off. This tells you the system is
working properly.
If the indicator comes on at any other time, or
does not come on at all, have the system
checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you
don't, your airbags and seat belt tensioners
may not work properly when they are needed.
1Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
3 WARNING
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in
serious injury or death if the airbag systems
or tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as
soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts
you to a possible problem.
3 WARNING
Remove the rear-facing child restraint
system immediately from the front
passenger seat if the SRS indicator comes
on. Even if the passenger front airbag has
been deactivated, do not ignore the SRS
indicator.
The SRS system may have a fault which
could cause the passenger front airbag to
be activated, causing serious injury or
death.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
60
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
61 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator
■ When the passenger airbag off
When a rear-facing child restraint system is
not in use in the front passenger seat,
manually turn the system back on. The
indicator should go off.
Safe Driving
indicator comes on
The indicator stays on while the passenger’s
front airbag system is deactivated.
61
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
62 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuAirbagsuAirbag Care
Airbag Care
You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any
airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer in the following situations:
Safe Driving
■ When the airbags have deployed
If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced.
Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be
replaced.
■ When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision
Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: front and
rear outer seat belt tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.
62
1Airbag Care
The removal of airbag components from the vehicle is
prohibited.
In case of malfunction, or shutdown, or after the
airbag inflation/seat belt tensioner operation, ask a
qualified personnel for handling.
We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag
system components, including the airbag, tensioners,
sensors, and control unit.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
63 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are
either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle accidents are the
number one cause of death of children ages 12 and under.
3 WARNING
Children who are unrestrained or
improperly restrained can be seriously
injured or killed in a crash.
Any child too small for a seat belt should be
properly restrained in an approved child
restraint system. A larger child should be
properly restrained with a seat belt, using a
booster seat if necessary.
Safe Driving
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, infants and children should be
properly restrained when they ride in a vehicle.
1Protecting Child Passengers
In many countries, the law requires all children aged
12 and under, and whose height are shorter than
150 cm (60 inches) be properly restrained in a rear
seat.
In many countries, it is required to use an officially
approved and suitable child restraint system for
transporting a child on any passenger seat. Check
your local legal requirements.
European models
Child restraint systems must meet the UN-ECE R44 or
the regulations of the subject countries.
2 Selecting a Child Restraint System P. 69
Except European models
We recommend that child restraint systems meet the
UN-ECE R44 or the regulations of the subject
countries.
Continued
63
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
64 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:
• An inflating front or side airbag can injure
or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
Front Passenger’s Sun Visor
Safe Driving
3 WARNING
• A child in the front seat is more likely to
interfere with the driver's ability to safely
control the vehicle.
• Statistics show that children of all sizes and
ages are safer when they are properly
restrained in a rear seat.
• Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt must be properly restrained in an
approved child restraint system that is properly secured to the vehicle using the
lap belt portion of the lap/shoulder belt.
• Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the
event of a collision.
• Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would
likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
• Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
64
1Protecting Child Passengers
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG
in front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to
the CHILD can occur.
To remind you of the passenger’s front airbag
hazards and child safety, your vehicle has the
warning label on the sun visor.
Please read and follow the instructions on the label.
2 Safety Labels P. 83
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
65 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
• Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
WARNING: Use the power window lock button to
prevent children from opening the windows. Using
this feature will prevent children from playing with
the windows, which could expose them to hazards or
distract the driver.
2 Opening/Closing the Power Windows
P. 167
Safe Driving
• Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when
the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate
vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.
1Protecting Child Passengers
WARNING: Always take the ignition key with you
whenever you leave the vehicle alone (with other
occupants).
65
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
66 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Infants
Safe Driving
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child restraint system
until the infant reaches the child restraint system manufacturer’s weight or height
limit for the seat, and the infant is at least one year old.
■ Positioning a rear-facing child restraint
system
Child restraint system must be placed and
secured in a rear seating position.
1Protecting Infants
3 WARNING
Placing a rear-facing child restraint system
in the front seat can result in serious injury
or death if the passenger’s front airbag
inflates.
Always place a rear-facing child restraint
system in the back seat, not the front.
As required by UN-ECE R94 Regulation:
3 WARNING
NEVER use a rearward facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an ACTIVE AIRBAG
in front of it, DEATH or SERIOUS INJURY to
the CHILD can occur.
66
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
67 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
When properly installed, a rear-facing child restraint system may prevent the driver
or a front passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their
seat-back in the desired position.
1Protecting Infants
Rear-facing child restraint systems should never be
installed in a front facing position.
Safe Driving
If the passenger’s front airbag inflates, it can hit the
rear-facing child restraint system with great force,
which can dislodge or strike the system, and seriously
injure the child.
Always refer to the child restraint system
manufacturer’s instructions before installation.
If it is absolutely unavoidable to install a rear-facing
child restraint system in the front passenger seat,
manually turn off the passenger front airbag system.
2 Passenger Front Airbag Off System P. 55
Continued
67
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
68 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Smaller Children
Safe Driving
If a child is at least one year old and within the weight range indicated by the child
restraint system manufacturer, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly
secured front facing child restraint system.
■ Front facing child restraint system
placement
We strongly recommend placing a front
facing child restraint system in a rear seating
position.
Placing a front facing child restraint system in the front seat can be hazardous. A
rear seat is the safest place for a child.
1Protecting Smaller Children
3 WARNING
Placing a front facing child restraint system
in the front seat can result in serious injury
or death if the front airbag inflates.
If you must place a front facing child
restraint system in front, move the vehicle
seat as far back as possible, and properly
restrain the child.
Educate yourself about the laws and regulations
regarding child restraint system use where you are
driving, and follow the child restraint system
manufacturer's instructions.
Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing child
restraint system for a child up to two years old, if the
child’s height and weight are appropriate for a rearfacing child restraint system.
68
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
69 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Selecting a Child Restraint System
1Selecting a Child Restraint System
Installation of a lower anchorage-compatible child
restraint system is simple.
Lower anchorage-compatible child restraint systems
have been developed to simplify the installation
process and reduce the likelihood of injuries caused
by incorrect installation.
Safe Driving
Some child restraint systems are lower anchorage compatible. Some have a rigidtype connector while others have a flexible-type connector. Both are equally easy to
use. Some existing and previously owned child restraint systems can only be installed
using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child restraint system
manufacturer’s use and care instructions as well as the instructions in this manual.
Proper installation is key to maximising your child’s safety.
The flexible type may not be available in your country.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with lower anchorages, install a child
restraint system using the seat belt and a top tether for added security. This is
because all child restraint systems must be secured with a lap belt or the lap part of
a lap/shoulder belt when not using the lower anchorage system. In addition, the
child restraint system manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach an
ISO FIX restraint system once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child
restraint system owner’s manual for proper installation instructions.
■ Important consideration when selecting a child restraint system
Make sure the child restraint system meets the following three requirements:
• The child restraint system is the correct type and size for the child.
• The child restraint system is the correct type for the seating position.
• Child restraint system is compliant with safety standard. We recommend the child
restraint system with the UN-ECE R44 or the regulations of the subject countries.
Look for the approval mark on the system and the manufacturer’s statement of
compliance on the box.
Continued
69
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
70 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ The Recommended Child Restraint Systems for EU Countries
Safe Driving
Various types of child restraint systems are available. Not all types are suitable for your vehicle. Please refer to the table below to select
which category of child restraint system can be used on each seating position.
Seating position
Mass group
group 0
group 0+
group I
group II
group III
IL:
IUF:
U:
UF:
X:
*1:
*2:
Up to 10 kg
Up to 13 kg
9 kg to 18 kg
15 kg to 25 kg
22 kg to 36 kg
Front passenger
Passenger front airbag ON/OFF
switch position
ON
OFF
X
U*1, *2
X
U*1, *2
*1,
*2
UF
U*1, *2
*1,
*2
UF
U*1, *2
*1,
*2
UF
U*1, *2
Rear passenger
Rear outboard
U*1
*1
U or IL (Honda Baby Safe ISOFIX)
U*1 or IUF (Size class A, B1, B)
U*1 or IL (Honda KIDFIX XP SICT)
U*1 or IL (Honda KIDFIX XP SICT)
Rear centre
U*1
U*1
U*1
U*1
U*1
Suitable for particular ISOFIX child restraint systems (CRS) given in this table.
Suitable for front facing ISOFIX child restraints system of universal category approved for use in this mass group.
For Group I, the front facing genuine Honda ISO FIX child restraint system is available from a dealer.
Suitable for “universal” category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
Suitable for front facing “universal” category restraints approved for use in this mass group.
Seat position not suitable for children in this mass group.
Adjust the seat-back angle to the upright position (front most lock position).
Move the front seat to its rearmost position.
A size class is specified for some child restraint systems. Make sure to check the size class as indicated on the manufacturer’s instructions,
package, and labels of the child restraint.
The particular child restraints in the table are Honda Genuine Parts. They are available from your dealer.
For a correct installation, please refer to the Child Restraint Instruction Manual.
If you cannot fix the Child Restraint System stably when you install booster seats on the front passenger seat, adjust the seat-back angle
to be parallel with the back side of the Child Restraint System, still keeping it forward of the seat belt shoulder anchor.
70
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
71 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Front passenger
X
Safe Driving
i-Size Child Restraint Systems
Seating position
Rear passenger
Rear outboard
Rear centre
i-U
X
Description
X:
Seating position not suitable for i-Size “universal” Child Restraint Systems.
i-U:
Suitable for i-Size “universal” Child Restraint Systems forward and rearward facing.
Continued
71
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
72 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint
System
Safe Driving
A lower anchorage-compatible child restraint system can be installed in either of the
two rear outer seats. A child restraint system is attached to the lower anchorages
with either the rigid or flexible type of connectors.
1. Locate the lower anchorages under the
Marks
marks.
2. Make sure to lock the seat-back in the
upright position.
3. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
1 Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint System
Some child restraint systems come with optional
guide-cups, which avoid possible damage to the seat
surface. Follow the manufacturer’s instructions when
using the guide-cups, and attach them to the lower
anchorages as shown in the image.
Lower
Anchorage
Guide-cup
72
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
73 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Lower Anchorages
1 Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint System
For your child's safety, when using a child restraint
system installed using the lower anchorage system,
make sure that the child restraint system is properly
secured to the vehicle. A child restraint system that is
not properly secured will not adequately protect a
child in a crash and may cause injury to the child or
other vehicle occupants.
Safe Driving
Rigid Type
4. Place the child restraint system on the
vehicle seat then attach the child restraint
system to the lower anchorages according
to the instructions that came with the
child restraint system.
u When installing the child restraint
system, make sure that the lower
anchorages are not obstructed by the
seat belt or any other object.
The flexible type may not be available in your country.
Flexible Type
Lower Anchorages
Continued
73
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
74 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Child restraint system with tether strap
Cover
Safe Driving
5. Open the tether anchorage cover.
6. Route the tether strap over the seat-back.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
7. Secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchorage.
8. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by
the child restraint system manufacturer.
Top Tether Anchor Symbol
FR
Anchorage
9. Make sure the child restraint system is
firmly secured by rocking it forward and
back and side to side; little movement
should be felt.
10. Make sure any unused seat belt that a
child can reach is buckled.
Tether
Strap
Hook
Child restraint system with support leg
5. Stretch the support leg until it touches the
floor as instructed by the child restraint
system manufacturer.
Support Leg
74
1 Installing a Lower Anchorage-Compatible Child Restraint System
WARNING: Never use a hook that does not come
with a Top Tether anchor symbol when securing an
installed child restraint system.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
75 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat
Belt
Continued
A child restraint system that is not properly secured
will not adequately protect a child in a crash and may
cause injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.
Safe Driving
1. Make sure to lock the seat-back in the
upright position.
2. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
3. Place the child restraint system on the
vehicle seat.
4. Route the seat belt through the child
restraint system according to the child
restraint system manufacturer's
instructions, and insert the latch plate into
the buckle.
u Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.
1Installing a Child Restraint System with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
75
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
76 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
76
Tab
5. Push down the tab. Route the shoulder
part of the belt into the slit at the side of
the restraint.
6. Grab the shoulder part of the belt near the
buckle, and pull up to remove any slack
from the lap part of the belt.
u When doing this, place your weight on
child restraint system and push it into
the vehicle seat.
7. Position the belt properly. Make sure the
belt is not twisted.
u When pulling down the tab, pull up the
upper shoulder part of the belt to
remove any slack from the belt.
8. Make sure the child restraint system is
firmly secured by rocking it forward and
back and side to side; little movement
should be felt.
9. Make sure any unused seat belt that a
child can reach is buckled.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
77 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Locking Clip
Except European models
After going through the step 1 and 4, pull up
the shoulder part of the belt and make sure
there is no slack in the lap portion.
5. Tightly grasp the belt near the latch plate.
Pinch both parts of the belt together so
they do not slip through the latch plate.
Unbuckle the seat belt.
6. Install the locking clip as shown in the
image. Position the clip as close as possible
to the latch plate.
7. Insert the latch plate into the buckle. Go to
step 8 and 9.
Continued
Safe Driving
If your child restraint system does not come
with a mechanism that secures the belt, install
a locking clip on the seat belt.
77
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
78 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Adding Security with a Tether
Two tether anchorage points are provided on
the ceiling for rear outer seating positions. A
child restraint system that is installed with a
seat belt and comes with a tether can use the
tether for additional security.
Tether Anchorage Points
Safe Driving
Cover
FR
Anchorage
78
Tether
Strap
Hook
1. Locate the appropriate tether anchorage
point and lift the cover.
2. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
3. Open the anchorage cover.
4. Route the tether strap over the seat-back.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
5. Secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchorage.
6. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child restraint system manufacturer.
1Adding Security with a Tether
WARNING: Child restraint anchorages are designed
to withstand only those loads imposed by correctly
fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used for adult seat belts, harnesses or for
attaching other items or equipment to the vehicle.
Since a tether can provide additional security to the
lap/shoulder seat belt installation, we recommend
using a tether whenever one is available.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
79 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safety of Larger Children
■ Protecting Larger Children
1Safety of Larger Children
■ Checking Seat Belt Fit
When a child is too big for a child restraint system, secure the child in a rear seat
using the lap/shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then
answer the following questions.
■ Checklist
• Do the child's knees bend comfortably over
the edge of the seat?
• Does the shoulder belt cross between the
child's neck and arm?
• Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as
possible, touching the child's thighs?
• Will the child be able to stay seated like this
for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder
seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a
booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.
Continued
3 WARNING
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in
front can result in injury or death if the
passenger's front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must ride in front, move the
vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible,
have the child sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly, using a booster seat if
needed.
Safe Driving
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind
of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who
must sit in front.
79
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
80 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
■ Booster Seats
1Booster Seats
Safe Driving
If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used
properly, position the child in a booster seat in
a rear seating position. For the child's safety,
check that the child meets the booster seat
manufacturer's recommendations.
When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the
instructions that came with it, and install the seat
accordingly.
There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a
booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat
belt correctly.
We recommend a booster seat with a backrest as it is
easier to adjust the shoulder belt.
Guide
80
A back-rest is available for a specific booster
seat. Install the back-rest to the booster seat
and adjust it to the vehicle seat according to
the booster seat manufacturer's instructions.
Make sure the seat belt is properly routed
through the guide at the shoulder of the backrest and the belt does not touch and cross the
child’s neck.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
81 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
■ Protecting Larger Children - Final Checks
Safe Driving
Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever
have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:
• Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information
in this manual.
• Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
• Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
• Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the
seat.
■ Monitoring child passengers
We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more
mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up
properly.
81
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
82 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas
The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colourless,
odourless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle,
carbon monoxide gas will not get into the interior.
Safe Driving
■ Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever
• The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
• The exhaust system may have been damaged.
• The vehicle is raised for an oil change.
When you operate a vehicle with the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into
the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate
open, open all the windows and set the climate control system as shown below.
1. Select the fresh air mode.
2. Select the
mode.
3. Set the fan speed to high.
4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
Adjust the climate control system in the same manner if you sit in your parked
vehicle with the engine running.
82
1Carbon Monoxide Gas
3 WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic. Breathing it
can cause unconsciousness and even kill
you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that
expose you to carbon monoxide.
An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up
with carbon monoxide gas.
Do not run the engine with the garage door closed.
Even when the garage door is open, drive out of the
garage immediately after starting the engine.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
83 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Safety Labels
Label Locations
These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels
carefully.
Sun Visor
Child Safety/SRS Airbag
(Right-hand drive type)
P. 64
Sun Visor
Child Safety/SRS Airbag
(Left-hand drive type)
P. 64
Doorjambs
Side Airbag
Passenger Front Airbag
Off System Label
(Left-hand drive type)
Air Conditioner Label
Radiator Cap
Radiator Cap Danger Label
Safe Driving
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read, contact a dealer for a replacement.
Passenger Front Airbag
Off System Label
(Right-hand drive type)
Battery Danger Label
83
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
84
84 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
85 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Instrument Panel
This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.
Indicators ............................................ 86
Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages.................... 110
Gauges and Displays
Gauges............................................ 128
Multi-Information Display ................ 129
85
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
86 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
Indicators
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
86
Brake System
Indicator (Red)
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on when the brake fluid level is
low.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
brake system.
Explanation
●
Comes on while driving - Check the
brake fluid level.
2 What to do when the indicator
comes on while driving P. 586
●
Comes on along with the ABS
indicator - Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
2 If the Brake System Indicator
(Red) Comes On P. 586
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Message
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
87 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Explanation
●
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
City-Brake Active system.
●
Comes on along with the CTBA
indicator - The City-Brake Active
system does not activate. Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Instrument Panel
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with a
component related to braking or the
automatic brake hold system.
Message
Brake System
Indicator (Amber)
●
2 City-Brake Active system P. 466
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
87
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
88 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Low Oil Pressure
Indicator
●
Instrument Panel
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off when
the engine starts.
Comes on when the engine oil pressure
is low.
Explanation
●
Comes on while driving Immediately stop in a safe place.
2 If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator
Comes On P. 585
Diesel models
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
●
●
Electric Parking
Brake Indicator
●
●
●
Electric Parking
Brake System
Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off if the parking brake has been
released.
Comes on when the parking brake is
applied, and goes off when it is released.
Comes on for about 15 seconds when
you pull the electric parking brake switch
while the ignition switch is in LOCK (0 *1.
Stays on for about 15 seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1
while the electric parking brake is set.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, then
goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
electric parking brake system.
●
Blinks and the electric parking brake
system indicator comes on at the
same time - There is a problem with
the electric parking brake system. The
parking brake may not be set.
(Amber)
Comes on while driving - Avoid using
the parking brake and have your vehicle
checked by a dealer immediately.
2 If the Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator Comes On P. 588
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
88
Message
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
89 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Automatic Brake
Hold System
Indicator
●
Automatic Brake
Hold Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
Comes on when the automatic brake
hold system is on.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 461
Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
Comes on when the automatic brake
hold is activated.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 461
Message
—
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
89
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
90 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
●
●
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off either
when the engine starts or, after several
seconds if the engine did not start.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
emissions control systems.
Blinks when a misfire in the engine's
cylinders is detected.
Explanation
●
●
Comes on while driving - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe
place where there are no flammable
objects. Stop the engine for 10
minutes or more, and wait for it to
cool down. Then, take your vehicle to
a dealer.
2 If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Comes On or Blinks P. 586
●
Charging System
Indicator
●
●
Shift Lever Position
Indicator *
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off when
the engine starts.
Comes on when the battery is not
charging.
●
Comes on while driving - Turn off
the climate control system and rear
demister to reduce electricity
consumption.
2 If the Charging System Indicator
Comes On P. 585
Indicates the current shift lever
position.
2 Shifting P. 405, 407
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
90
Message
* Not available on all models
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
91 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Blinks if the transmission system has a
problem.
●
Comes on when 7-speed manual shift
mode is applied.
Transmission
Indicator *
M (7-speed manual
shift mode)
Indicator/Shift
Indicator *
●
*2
*3
Shift Up Indicator *
●
●
*2
*3
Shift Down
Indicator *
●
●
Message
Blinks while driving - Avoid sudden
starts and acceleration and have your
vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
2 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode
P. 409
—
Comes on briefly when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, then goes
off.
Comes on when shifting up is
recommended.
2 Shift Up/Down Indicators P. 411,
413
—
Comes on briefly when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, then goes
off.
Comes on when shifting down is
recommended.
2 Shift Up/Down Indicators P. 411,
413
—
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2:Continuously variable transmission models
*3:Manual transmission models
* Not available on all models
Continued
91
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
92 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Instrument Panel
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
●
●
Comes on if you are not wearing a seat
belt when you turn the ignition switch
to ON (w *1.
Blinks while driving if you have not
fastened the seat belt. The beeper
sounds and the indicator blinks at
regular intervals.
If the front passenger is not wearing a
seat belt, the indicator comes on about
a few seconds later.
Blinks while driving if the front
passenger has not fastened a seat belt.
The beeper sounds and the indicator
blinks at regular intervals.
Explanation
●
●
●
●
Message
The beeper stops and the indicator
goes off when you fasten the seat belt.
Stays on after you have fastened
the seat belt - A detection error may
have occurred in the sensor. Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
The beeper stops and the indicator
goes off when the front passenger
fastens their seat belt.
Stays on after the front passenger
has fastened the seat belt - A
detection error may have occurred in
the sensor. Have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 40
●
Diesel models
Glow Plugs Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on for a while when you turn
the ignition switch to ON (w *1 under
the extremely low engine coolant
temperature condition, then goes off.
●
Stays on - The engine is cold. Do not
start the engine until the indicator
goes off.
●
If you still find it hard to start the
engine, have your vehicle inspected by
your dealer.
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
92
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
93 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Diesel models
●
Appears when the Range on the multiinformation display reaches to 0.
●
●
●
●
Message
Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as
soon as possible.
Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by
a dealer.
Instrument Panel
Low Fuel Indicator
Comes on when the fuel reserve is
running low (approximately 7.0 Litres/
1.54 Imp gal left).
Blinks if there is a problem with the fuel
gauge.
Explanation
Maximum speed is restricted.
Refuel your vehicle as soon as possible.
The vehicle speed limit will be released
when refueling 10 Litres (2.2 Imp gal)
or more.
2 Refueling P. 479
Diesel models
●
Appears when the remaining fuel is
nearly-empty.
●
●
The vehicle stops soon.
You cannot restart the engine.
Immediately refuel your vehicle.
2 Refueling P. 479
Continued
93
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
94 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Anti-lock Brake
System (ABS)
Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
If it comes on at any other time, there is
a problem with the ABS.
Explanation
●
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer. With this
indicator on, your vehicle still has
normal braking ability but no anti-lock
function.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
P. 464
●
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on if a problem with any of the
following is detected:
- Supplemental restraint system
- Side airbag system
- Side curtain airbag system
- Seat belt tensioner
●
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
94
Message
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
95 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Message
2 Passenger Front Airbag Off
System P. 55
—
Instrument Panel
Passenger Front
Airbag On/Off
Indicators
Both indicators come on for a few
seconds when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, then goes off after
a system check up.
When the passenger front airbag is
active: The on indicator comes back on
and remains on for about 60 seconds.
When the passenger front airbag is
inactive: The off indicator comes back
on and stays on. This is a reminder that
the passenger front airbag is
deactivated.
Explanation
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
95
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
96 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA) System
Indicator
Vehicle Stability
Assist (VSA) OFF
Indicator
●
●
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Blinks when VSA is active.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
VSA or hill start assist system.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on when you deactivate VSA.
Explanation
●
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA)
System P. 453
2 Hill start assist system P. 399, 402
2 VSA OFF Button P. 454
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
96
Message
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
97 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
●
●
Message
Goes off, then comes on blue when
the engine coolant temperature is low.
Blinks while driving - Drive slowly to
prevent overheating.
Stays on while driving Immediately stop in a safe place and
allow the engine to cool.
Instrument Panel
High Temperature
Indicator (Red)
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Blinks when the engine coolant
temperature goes up, and stays on if
the temperature continues to rise.
Explanation
2 Overheating P. 583
●
Low Temperature
Indicator (Blue)
●
Door and Tailgate
Open Indicator
●
●
Comes on when the engine coolant
temperature is low.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on if any door or the tailgate is
not completely closed.
The beeper sounds and the indicator
comes on if any door or the tailgate is
opened while driving.
●
●
If the indicator stays on after the
engine has reached normal operating
temperature, there may be a problem
with the temperature sensors. Have
your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
—
Goes off when all doors and the
tailgate are closed.
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
97
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
98 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
System Indicator
●
●
●
System Message
Indicator
Explanation
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and goes off when
the engine starts.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
EPS system.
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on along with a beep when a
problem is detected. A system message
on the multi-information display
appears at the same time.
●
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 If the Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator Comes On
P. 587
●
●
While the indicator is on, press the
(information) button to see
the message again.
Refer to the Indicators information in
this chapter when a system message
appears on the multi-information
display. Take appropriate action for
the message.
The multi-information display does not
return to the normal screen unless the
warning is cancelled, or the
button is pressed.
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
98
Message
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
99 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日
午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
May come on briefly if the ignition
switch is turned to ON (w *1 and the
vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds,
to indicate the calibration process is not
yet complete.
Comes on and stays on when:
- One or more tyres’ pressures are
determined to be significantly low.
- The system has not been calibrated.
●
Blinks for about one minute, and then
stays on if there is a problem with the
deflation warning system, or when a
compact spare tyre is temporarily
installed.
●
●
Message
Comes on while driving - Stop in a
safe place, check tyre pressures, and
inflate the tyre(s) if necessary.
Stays on after the tyres are inflated
to the recommended pressures The system needs to be calibrated.
Instrument Panel
Low Tyre
Pressure/
Deflation
Warning System
Indicator
Explanation
2 Deflation Warning System
Calibration P. 455
Blinks and remains on - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer. If the
vehicle is fitted with a compact spare,
get your regular tyre repaired or
replaced and put back on your vehicle
as soon as you can.
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
99
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
100 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
100
Auto Idle Stop
Indicator (Green)
Comes on when Auto Idle Stop is in
operation. The engine automatically
shuts off.
Manual transmission models
●
●
Explanation
Blinks when the ambient conditions
may cause the windows to fog up.
Blinks when the ambient conditions
may become different from the
climate control settings you have
selected.
Message
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 415, 419
●
Depress the clutch pedal. The engine
automatically restarts.
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 419
(White)
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
101 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
Message
Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer.
*2
*2
Auto Idle Stop
System Indicator
(Amber)
Instrument Panel
Comes on for a few seconds when
you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1, then goes off.
Blinks if there is a problem with the
Auto Idle Stop system.
Explanation
*3
●
Comes on when the Auto Idle Stop
system has been turned off by the
Auto Idle Stop system OFF button.
2 Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF P. 415,
419
—
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2:Petrol models
*3:Diesel models
Continued
101
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
102 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Instrument Panel
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
●
●
High Beam Indicator
●
Comes on when the front fog lights are
on.
●
102
* Not available on all models
Message
Does not blink or blinks rapidly - A
turn signal light bulb has blown.
Change the bulb immediately.
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 523, 524,
525
—
2 Emergency Stop Signal P. 471
Comes on when the high beam
headlights are on.
Comes on whenever the light switch is
on, or in AUTO when the exterior lights
are on.
Front Fog Light
Indicator *
●
Blink along with all turn signals when
you depress the brake pedal while the
high speed driving.
●
Lights On Indicator
Rear Fog Light
Indicator
Blinks when you operate the turn signal
lever.
Blink if you press the hazard warning
button.
Explanation
—
●
—
If you remove the key from the ignition
switch *, or set the power mode * to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) while the exterior
lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver's door is opened.
—
—
—
—
Comes on when the rear fog light is on.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
103 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
●
Message
Blinks Models without keyless access system
You cannot start the engine. Turn the
ignition switch to LOCK (0 , pull the
key out, and then insert the key and
turn it to ON (w again.
Models with keyless access system
Immobilizer System
Indicator
●
●
You cannot start the engine. Set the
power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK),
then select the ON mode again.
Repeatedly blinks - The system may
be malfunctioning. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it. Electrical
problems can occur.
—
Instrument Panel
Comes on briefly when you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1, then goes
off.
Comes on if the immobilizer system
cannot recognize the key information.
Explanation
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
103
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
104 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
ECON Mode
Indicator
●
Instrument Panel
●
Keyless Access
System Indicator *
●
*2
Indicator
*3
●
Security System
Alarm Indicator *
Explanation
Comes on when you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, then goes off.
Comes on when ECON mode is on.
Comes on for a few seconds when you
set the power mode to ON, then goes
off.
Comes on as soon as a problem is
detected in the keyless access system or
keyless starting system.
2 ECON Button P. 423
●
Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Blinks when the security system alarm
has been set.
2 Security System Alarm * P. 163
Indicator
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2:Left-hand drive type
*3:Right-hand drive type
104
* Not available on all models
Message
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
105 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Message
2 High Beam Support System *
P. 184
—
Instrument Panel
High Beam
Support System
Indicator *
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on when all the operating
conditions of the high beam support
system are met.
Explanation
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
105
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
106 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Instrument Panel
●
●
Forward
Collision
Warning
Indicator *
Explanation
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on when you have customized
forward collision warning system to
turn off.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
system.
●
Stays on constantly without the
system off - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Comes on when the system shuts itself
off.
●
Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high.
Use the climate control system to cool
down the camera.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
2 Automatic shutoff P. 440
●
●
Stays on - The area around the camera
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the indicator and message come back
on after you cleaned the area around
the camera.
2 Automatic shutoff P. 440
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
106
* Not available on all models
Message
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
107 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem with the
lane departure warning system.
●
Stays on constantly - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Comes on when the system shuts itself
off.
●
Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high.
Use the climate control system to cool
down the camera.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
Lane Departure
Warning
Indicator *
Message
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
2 Lane Departure Warning Camera
P. 443
●
●
Stays on - The area around the camera
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the indicator and message come back
on after you cleaned the area around
the camera.
2 Lane Departure Warning Camera
P. 443
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
107
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
108 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Instrument Panel
●
●
City-Brake Active
System (CTBA)
Indicator
●
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when you
turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
then goes off.
Goes off when you have customized
the City-Brake Active system to turn on.
Comes on when you have customized
the City-Brake Active system to turn
off.
Comes on when the area around the
laser sensor, which is located in the
upper part of the windscreen, is
covered with obstacles, such as dirt, ice
and frost.
May come on when driving in bad
weather (rain, fog, snow).
Comes on when snow is accumulated
on the bonnet.
Explanation
Message
—
—
2 City-Brake Active system P. 466
2 Customized Features P. 136
●
●
Remove dirt or any obstacles using the
washer and wipers.
Stop your vehicle in a safe place and
wipe away dirt or any obstacles
covering the area around the laser
sensor on the windscreen.
2 City-Brake Active system P. 466
●
The system resumes when obstacles are
removed.
●
Stop your vehicle in a safe place and
remove snow from the bonnet.
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
108
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
109 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
●
May come on when the temperatures
of the area around the laser sensor are
high.
●
Comes on along with the brake system
indicator (amber) if there is a problem
with the system.
●
●
Use the climate control system to cool
down the area around the laser sensor.
The system resumes when the
temperatures of the area around the
laser sensor go down.
The system does not activate. Have
your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Message
Instrument Panel
City-Brake Active
System (CTBA)
Indicator
Explanation
109
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
110 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
The following messages appear only on the multi-information display. Press the
with the system message indicator on.
Message
Condition
(information) button to see the message again
Explanation
Continuously variable transmission models
●
Instrument Panel
Appears while you are customizing the settings and the
shift lever is moved out of (P .
2 Customized Features P. 136
Manual transmission models
●
Appears while you are customizing the settings and the
parking brake is released.
●
Appears once if the outside temperature is below 3°C
while the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
●
Appears when any of the rear seat belts are latched or
unlatched, or either rear door is opened and closed.
●
There is a possibility that the road surface is icy and
slippery.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 40
●
Appears when the vehicle speed reaches the set speed.
You can set two different speeds for the alarm.
2 Speed Alarm Setting P. 134
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
110
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
111 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
*1
●
Appears if the automatic brake hold is automatically
cancelled while it is in operation.
Explanation
●
Immediately depress the brake pedal.
Instrument Panel
(Amber)
*2
*1:Continuously variable transmission models
*2:Manual transmission models
Continued
111
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
112 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
Explanation
Appears when the automatic brake hold system is
turned off.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 461
Instrument Panel
●
*1
●
Appears when the automatic brake hold button is
pressed without wearing the driver’s seat belt.
●
Appears when the automatic brake hold button is
pressed without depressing the brake pedal while the
automatic brake hold is in operation.
●
Fasten the driver’s seat belt.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 461
Press the automatic brake hold button with the brake
pedal depressed.
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 461
*2
●
Appears when the parking brake is applied
automatically while the automatic brake hold is in
operation.
(White)
*1:Continuously variable transmission models
*2:Manual transmission models
112
2 Automatic Brake Hold P. 461
2 Parking Brake P. 458
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
113 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
Appears if there is a problem with the automatic
lighting control system.
Models with LED low beam headlights
Appears if there is a problem with the low beam
headlights.
●
Appears if the starter system has a problem.
●
Appears while driving - Manually turn the lights on,
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer
Models without keyless access system
●
As a temporary measure, hold the turn the ignition
switch to START (e for up to 15 seconds while pressing
the brake pedal and clutch pedal (manual transmission
only), and manually start the engine. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
Models with keyless access system
●
As a temporary measure, press and hold the ENGINE
START/STOP button for 15 seconds while pressing the
brake pedal and clutch pedal (manual transmission
only), manually start the engine. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
Continued
113
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
114 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
Appears when the engine oil level is low while the
engine is running.
Explanation
●
Appears while driving - Immediately stop in a safe
place.
2 If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears P. 590
Instrument Panel
114
●
Appears when the engine is running, there is a system
problem in the engine oil level sensor.
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
115 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
●
●
Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate for
some reason.
Appears when the engine restarts automatically.
Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the battery charge level is low.
Appears when the battery is low performance.
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 415, 419
●
●
Comes on even though the battery is fully charged
- The system may not read the battery amount correctly.
Drive for a few minutes.
Comes on after charging the battery or jump
starting - Disconnect the negative - cable once and
reconnect it again to the battery. Drive a few minutes.
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 415, 419
●
Appears when the system is under the following
conditions while Auto Idle Stop activates:
- The battery charge level is low.
●
Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the engine coolant temperature is low or
high.
●
The engine restarts automatically in a few seconds.
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 415, 419
Continued
115
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
116 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the climate control system is in use, and the
difference between the set temperature and actual
interior temperature becomes significant.
Instrument Panel
Continuously variable transmission models
*1
●
Appears when the system is under the following
conditions while Auto Idle Stop activates:
- The climate control system is in use, and the
difference between the set temperature and actual
interior temperature becomes significant.
- The humidity in the interior is high.
●
Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the pressure to the brake pedal is not
enough.
(White)
*1:Continuously variable transmission models
116
Explanation
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 415, 419
●
The engine restarts automatically in a few seconds.
●
Depress the brake pedal firmly.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
117 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
*2
Explanation
Appears when the electric parking brake switch is
pressed without depressing the brake pedal while the
electric parking brake is in operation.
●
Appears in white when you turn the ignition switch to
START (e *1 before fully depressing the clutch pedal.
Appears in white when the ambient conditions may
cause the windows to fog up or may become different
from the climate control settings you have selected
while Auto Idle Stop is in operation.
●
Depress the clutch pedal.
●
Appears in amber when the following conditions are
kept while Auto Idle Stop is in operation:
- You are not wearing a seat belt.
- The shift lever is in any position except (N .
●
Depress the clutch pedal. Wear the seat belt
immediately, and continue to keep the shift lever in (N
next time Auto Idle Stop activates.
●
Comes on when you move the shift lever from (N to
any other position without depressing the clutch pedal
while Auto Idle Stop is in operation.
●
The engine will not start even when the battery charge
becomes low. Shift to (N to avoid the battery charge
becomes low.
●
Appears while driving - Press the electric parking
brake switch with the brake pedal depressed.
2 Parking Brake P. 458
Instrument Panel
*3
●
●
*3
*3
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 419
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2:Continuously variable transmission models
*3:Manual transmission models
Continued
117
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
118 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Instrument Panel
●
Appears when the bonnet is opened.
●
Appears when the ECON mode is turned off by pressing
the ECON button.
Explanation
●
2 ECON Button P. 423
●
Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with a
vehicle in front of you. The beeper sounds.
●
●
●
118
Close the bonnet.
Changes the display when your vehicle is stopped by the
system. The beeper stops.
Depress the brake pedal, and keep an appropriate
distance from the vehicle ahead. The alert will
disappear.
The system automatically applies the brake if a possible
collision becomes likely unavoidable.
2 City-Brake Active system P. 466
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
119 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with service reminder system
Message
Condition
●
●
Appears when any of the service items is required in less
than 30 days. The remaining days are estimated based
on your driving conditions.
●
Appears when any of the service items is required in less
than 10 days. The remaining days are estimated based
on your driving conditions.
●
Appears when the indicated maintenance service is still
not done after the remaining days reach 0.
●
The remaining days will be counted down per day.
2 Service Reminder System * P. 489
Have the indicated service performed as soon as
possible.
2 Service Reminder System * P. 489
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
Your vehicle has passed the service required point.
Immediately have the service performed and make sure
to reset the service reminder.
2 Service Reminder System * P. 489
* Not available on all models
Continued
119
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
120 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models without keyless access system
Message
Condition
●
Instrument Panel
*1
*2
Appears when the ignition key is turned to ACCESSORY
(q from ON (w . (The driver’s door is closed.)
—
●
Appears when you open the driver’s door while the
ignition key is in ACCESSORY (q .
●
Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 , then remove the
key.
●
Appears when you open the driver’s door while the
ignition key is in LOCK (0 .
●
Remove the key from the ignition switch.
●
Appears in white when you turn the ignition switch to
START (e before fully depressing the clutch pedal.
●
Turn the ignition switch after fully depressing the clutch
pedal.
●
Appears in amber when the engine does not restart
automatically due to the following reasons:
- The bonnet is open.
- There is a problem in the system that disables Auto Idle
Stop.
●
Follow the normal procedure to start the engine.
*1:Manual transmission models
*2:Continuously variable transmission models
120
Explanation
2 Starting the Engine P. 397
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
121 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with keyless access system
Message
Condition
*1
●
●
●
Appears in white after you unlock and open the driver’s
door.
Appears in white when you set the power mode to
ACCESSORY or ON.
Appears in amber when the engine does not restart
automatically due to the following reasons:
- The bonnet is open.
- There is a problem in the system that disables Auto Idle
Stop.
2 Starting the Engine P. 400
●
Follow the normal procedure to start the engine.
2 Starting the Engine P. 400
●
Appears in white when the power mode is in
ACCESSORY.
●
Appears in amber after the driver’s door is opened
when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
●
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice with your
foot off the brake pedal (continuously variable
transmission) or the clutch pedal (manual transmission)
to change the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
●
Appears when you close the door with the power mode
in ON without the keyless remote inside the vehicle.
●
Disappears when you bring the keyless remote back
inside the vehicle and close the door.
Instrument Panel
*2
Explanation
—
2 Keyless Remote Reminder P. 175
*1:Continuously variable transmission models
*2:Manual transmission models
Continued
121
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
122 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
Instrument Panel
●
Appears when the keyless remote battery becomes
weak.
Explanation
●
Replace the battery as soon as possible.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 544
Appears if the keyless remote battery is too weak to
start the engine or the key is not within operating range
to start the engine. A beeper sounds six times.
2 If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak P. 577
●
Appears if you press the ENGINE START/STOP button
to turn the engine off without the shift lever in (P .
●
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice with your
foot off the brake pedal, after moving the shift lever to
(P .
●
Appears when the engine stops without the shift lever
in (P , and does not restart automatically.
Appears if you open the bonnet while Auto Idle Stop
activates.
●
If you want to set the power mode to ON, move the
shift lever to (P .
If you want to start the engine, follow the normal
procedure.
*1
●
●
2 Starting the Engine P. 400
●
Appears when the steering wheel is locked.
*1:Continuously variable transmission models
122
●
Move the steering wheel left and right while pressing
the ENGINE START/STOP button.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
123 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with parking sensor system
Message
Condition
Appears if there is a problem with the parking sensor
system.
●
If there is a problem with any of the sensors, the
appropriate sensor indicator(s) comes on.
●
Check if the area around the sensor(s) is covered with
mud, ice, snow, etc. If the indicator(s) stays on even
after you clean the area, have the system checked by a
dealer.
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
Models with high beam support system
Message
Condition
●
Appears when there is a problem with the high beam
support system.
Explanation
●
●
Manually operate the headlight switch.
If you are driving with the high beam headlights when
this happens, the headlights are changed to low beams.
2 High Beam Support System * P. 184
* Not available on all models
Continued
123
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
124 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with forward collision warning
Message
Condition
●
Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with a
vehicle in front of you. The beeper sounds.
Explanation
●
Take the appropriate means to prevent a collision (apply
the brakes, change lanes, etc.)
2 Forward Collision Warning * P. 438
Instrument Panel
Models with lane departure warning
Message
Condition
●
Appears when your vehicle is too close to the traffic lane
lines. The beeper sounds.
Explanation
●
Take appropriate action to keep your vehicle within the
lane lines.
2 Lane Departure Warning * P. 442
124
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
125 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Models with high beam support system
Models with traffic sign recognition system
Message
Condition
●
Appears when the system shuts itself off.
Explanation
●
2 Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 446
2 High Beam Support System * P. 184
●
Appears when the system shuts itself off.
●
●
Instrument Panel
Appears while driving - The temperature inside the
camera is too high.
Use the climate control system to cool down the
camera.
The system activates when the temperature inside the
camera cools down.
Appears while driving - The area around the camera
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe
place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
appears again after you cleaned the area around the
camera.
2 Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 446
2 High Beam Support System * P. 184
Petrol models
Message
Condition
●
Appears when there is a problem related to the battery
charging system.
* Not available on all models
Explanation
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
Turn off the climate control system and rear demister to
reduce electricity consumption.
2 Checking the Battery P. 540
Continued
125
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
126 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Diesel models
Message
Condition
●
Explanation
Appears when you need to regenerate the diesel
particulate filter (DPF). This is not a DPF failure.
2 Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Regeneration * P. 517
Instrument Panel
●
Appears when you ignore
. Particulate matter has
started clogging the DPF system. This is a problem.
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
Appears when water has accumulated in the fuel
system.
Appears if you have parked your vehicle for an extended
period.
●
Have a dealer drain off the water from the system as
soon as possible. Accumulated water may cause
damage to the fuel system.
Appears if the engine is cold when you turn the ignition
switch*1.
●
The engine automatically starts when the symbol
disappears.
If the clutch pedal is not depressed, the engine cannot
start.
●
●
●
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
*1:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
126
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
127 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicatorsuMulti-Information Display Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
●
Appears during driving if there is a problem with the
engine control system.
●
Appears when you cannot restart the engine after the
fuel tank has been run dry. Air may have entered the
fuel system.
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
Appears if you do not use the proper fuel for the climate
or regional conditions.
●
Use of inadequate fuel may reduce engine power.
2 If the PGM-FI Symbol Appears P. 590
Instrument Panel
2 Fuel recommendation P. 480
127
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
128 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Gauges and Displays
Gauges
Gauges include the speedometer, tachometer, and related indicators. They are
displayed when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Speedometer
Displays your driving speed in km/h or mph.
Instrument Panel
■ Tachometer
Shows the number of engine revolutions per minute.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
128
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
129 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
Multi-Information Display
The multi-information display shows the odometer, trip meter, outside temperature,
and other gauges.
It also displays important messages such as warnings and other helpful information.
■ Switching the Display
Press the
(information) button to change the display.
Instant Fuel
Economy
Blank Screen
Average Fuel
Economy
Customizable
Setting Entry
Range
Service Reminder
System *
Rear Seat Belt
Use Monitor
Elapsed Time
Speed Alarm
Setting
Average Speed
Instrument Panel
■ Main displays
Traffic Sign
Recognition
System *
Button
* Not available on all models
Continued
129
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
130 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Lower displays
Press the SEL/RESET button to change the display.
Odometer
Outside
Temperature
Trip A
Outside
Temperature
Instrument Panel
SEL/RESET
Button
130
Trip B
Outside
Temperature
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
131 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Odometer
Shows the total number of kilometres or miles that your vehicle has accumulated.
■ Trip Meter
1Trip Meter
Switch between trip A and B by pressing the SEL/
RESET button.
■ Resetting a trip meter
To reset a trip meter, display it, then press and hold the SEL/RESET button. The trip
meter is reset to 0.0.
■ Average Fuel Economy
Instrument Panel
Shows the total number of kilometres or miles driven since the last reset. Trip A and
B can be used to measure two separate trips.
1Average Fuel Economy
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each trip meter in l/100 km or mpg.
The display is updated at set intervals. When a trip meter is reset, the average fuel
economy is also reset.
You can change when to reset the average fuel
economy.
2 Customized Features P. 136
■ Range
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This distance is
estimated from the fuel economy of your previous trips.
■ Elapsed Time
1Elapsed Time
You can change when to reset the elapsed time.
2 Customized Features P. 136
Shows the time elapsed since trip A or trip B was reset.
Continued
131
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
132 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Average Speed
Shows the average speed in km/h or mph since trip A or trip B was reset.
1Average Speed
You can change when to reset the average speed.
2 Customized Features P. 136
■ Instant Fuel Economy
Instrument Panel
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in l/100 km or mpg.
■ Outside Temperature
1Outside Temperature
Shows the outside temperature in Celsius.
If the outside temperature has been below 3°C at the time you turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, the outside temperature indicator blinks for 10 seconds.
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 30 km/h (19 mph).
■ Adjusting the outside temperature display
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
Adjust the temperature reading up to ±3°C if the temperature reading seems
incorrect.
■ Rear Seat Belt Use Monitor
Use the multi-information display's customized
features to correct the temperature.
2 Customized Features P. 136
Shows the rear seat belt use.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 40
1Fuel Gauge
■ Fuel Gauge
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
132
NOTICE
You should refuel when the reading approaches (0 .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
133 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Traffic Sign Recognition System *
Shows the traffic sign recognition system.
2 Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 446
■ Service Reminder System *
Instrument Panel
Shows the service reminder system.
2 Service Reminder System * P. 489
* Not available on all models
Continued
133
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
134 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Speed Alarm Setting
1Speed Alarm Setting
Sets the speed alarm on and changes the speed alarm setting.
■ To set the speed alarm
Instrument Panel
1. Press the
button until the speed
alarm setting screen appears on the display,
then press the SEL/RESET button.
2. Press the
button and select
(speed alarm 1) or
(speed alarm 2), then
press the SEL/RESET button.
u
(off) switches to
(on), then the
display returns to the normal screen.
u If the speed alarm is
(on), it switches
to
(off).
134
The default settings for
(speed alarm 1) and
(speed alarm 2) are
(off).
You can also return to the normal screen by selecting
(exit).
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
135 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ To change the speed setting
1Speed Alarm Setting
3. Press the
button and select the
speed, then press the SEL/RESET button.
u The speed setting is set, then the display
returns to the normal screen.
u You can set the speed setting over 5 km/h
(mph) with 1 km/h (mph) steps.
Continued
You cannot change the speed setting while driving.
Instrument Panel
1. Press the
button until the speed
alarm setting menu appears on the display,
then press the SEL/RESET button.
2. Press the
button and select the
speed alarm 1 speed setting or speed alarm
2 speed setting, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
135
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
136 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Customized Features
1Customized Features
Use the multi-information display to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
Instrument Panel
Select the
(customize settings) screen by pressing the
button while the
ignition switch is in ON (w *1, the vehicle is at a complete stop, and the shift lever is
in (P (continuously variable transmission), and the parking brake is set (manual
transmission). Press the SEL/RESET button to enter the customizing mode.
When you customize settings:
Continuously variable transmission models
Shift to (P .
Manual transmission models
Set the parking brake.
Multi-Information Display:
Goes to customize settings.
Button:
Changes the customize
menus and items.
SEL/RESET button:
Enters the selected item.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
136
To customize other features, press the
button.
2 List of customizable options P. 139
2 Example of customization settings P. 142
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
137 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Customization flow
Press the
button.
(customize settings)
SEL/RESET
Deflation Warning System
Instrument Panel
4
Driver Assist System Setup
SEL/RESET
City-Brake Active System
4
Forward Collision Warning Distance*
Traffic Sign Recognition System *
4
4
* Not available on all models
Continued
137
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
138 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
4
Meter Setup
SEL/RESET
Language
Warning Message
Instrument Panel
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
“Trip A” Reset Timing
“Trip B” Reset Timing
4
4
Fuel Efficiency Backlight Colour
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
4
Auto Idle Stop Display
Speed Display Unit *
Distance Display Units *
Maintenance Info. *
4
Default All
4
SEL/RESET
138
* Not available on all models
(exit)
SEL/RESET
Maintenance Reset
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
139 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ List of customizable options
Setup Group
Customizable Features
Deflation
Warning
System
Selectable Settings
Initialises the deflation warning system.
Cancel/Initialise
City-Brake Active System
Turns the City-Brake Active system feature on
and off.
ON*1/OFF
Forward Collision
Warning Distance *
Changes at which distance forward collision
warning alerts, or turns the system on and off.
Far/Normal*1/Near/OFF
Traffic Sign Recognition
System *
Selects whether the traffic sign small icons
come on the multi-information display.
Small Icon ON*1/Small Icon OFF
Instrument Panel
Driver Assist
System
Setup
—
Description
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
139
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
140 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Customizable Features
Selectable Settings
Instrument Panel
Language
Changes the displayed language.
English*1/German/Italian/
French/Spanish/Polish/
Portuguese/Dutch/Danish/
Swedish/Norwegian/Finnish/
Russian
Warning Message
Switches warning message to be displayed or not.
ON/OFF*1
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
-3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A,
average fuel economy A, average speed A, and
elapsed time A.
When Refueled/When
Ignition Is Turned Off/
Manual Reset*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B,
average fuel economy B, average speed B, and
elapsed time B.
When Refueled/When
Ignition Is Turned Off/
Manual Reset*1
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Colour
Changes the ambient meter colour.
Random/Blue/Violet/Pink/
Red/Amber/Yellow/White*1
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Turns the ambient meter feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Auto Idle Stop Display
Selects whether the Auto Idle Stop display comes on or not.
ON*1/OFF
Speed Display Unit*2
Changes the displayed measurement of the set
vehicle speed on the multi-information display.
km/h, mph*1
Distance Display Units*2
Changes the displayed measurement on the multiinformation display.
km/miles*1
Meter Setup
*1:Default Setting
*2:Right-hand drive type
140
Description
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
141 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
Setup Group
Maintenance Reset
Default All
* Not available on all models
—
Description
Selectable Settings
Resets the service reminder.
The items of selectable settings depend on models.
Cancel/All Due Items/Item A
Only/Item B Only/Item 0
Only/Item 1 Only/Item 2
Only/Item 3 Only/Item 4
Only/Item 5 Only/Item 6
Only/Item 7 Only/Item 8
Only/Item 9 Only
Cancels/Resets all the customized settings as
default.
Cancel/OK
Continued
Instrument Panel
Maintenance
Info. *
Customizable Features
141
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
142 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
■ Example of customization settings
The steps for changing the “Trip A” Reset Timing setting to When Refueled are
shown below. The default setting for “Trip A” Reset Timing is Manual Reset.
1. Press the
button until
(customize settings) appears on the display,
then press the SEL/RESET button.
Instrument Panel
2. Press the
button until Meter
Setup appears on the display.
3. Press the SEL/RESET button.
142
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
143 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGauges and DisplaysuMulti-Information Display
5. Press the
button and select When
Refueled, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
u The When Refueled Setup screen
appears, then the display returns to the
customization menu screen.
Instrument Panel
4. Press the
button until “Trip A”
Reset Timing appears on the display, then
press the SEL/RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select When Refueled, When
Ignition Is Turned Off, Manual Reset,
or
(exit).
6. Press the
button until
(exit)
appears on the display, then press the SEL/
RESET button.
7. Repeat Step 6 until you return to the
normal screen.
143
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
144
144 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
145 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Controls
This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.
Clock....................................................... 146
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions ...................... 148
Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength * ...... 151
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside .....152
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside ... 158
Childproof Door Locks ......................... 160
Opening and Closing the Tailgate ....... 161
Security System
Immobilizer System .............................. 163
Security System Alarm * ........................ 163
Ultrasonic Sensors * .......................... 165
Super Locking * ................................ 166
Opening and Closing the Windows..... 167
* Not available on all models
Opening and Closing the Panoramic Glass
Roof and Sunshade * ........................... 170
Operating the Switches Around the
Steering Wheel
Models without keyless access system
Ignition Switch..................................... 172
Models with keyless access system
ENGINE START/STOP Button ................ 173
Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison.... 176
Turn Signals......................................... 177
Light Switches ..................................... 178
Fog Lights............................................ 181
Headlight Adjuster * ............................. 183
High Beam Support System * ................ 184
Daytime Running Lights ....................... 186
Wipers and Washers.............................187
Brightness Control................................190
Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror Icon ...191
Adjusting the Steering Wheel ...............192
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror........................193
Power Door Mirrors ..............................194
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions..................197
Rear Seats ............................................203
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items...... 207
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control .........219
Synchronized Mode * ............................226
Automatic Climate Control Sensors ......227
145
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
146 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Clock
Adjusting the Clock
Models without navigation system
1Adjusting the Clock
You can adjust the time in the clock display with the ignition switch in ON (w *1.
Models with navigation system
The clock is automatically updated through the
navigation system, so the time does not need to be
adjusted.
You should customize the time zone and daylight
saving.
2 Customized Features P. 322
Controls
■ Adjusting the Time
1Adjusting the Time
Models with colour audio system
Models with colour audio system
■ Using the MENU/CLOCK button
1. Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button.
u Adjust clock is selected.
2. Rotate
to change hour, then press .
3. Rotate
to change minute, then press
.
4. To enter the selection, rotate
and select
Set, then press .
These indications are used to show how to operate
the LIST/SELECT (Selector) knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 322
You can turn the clock display on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 322
You can also select Adjust clock by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Adjust clock, then press .
The clock in the multi-information display is
automatically adjusted along with the audio system’s
clock display.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
146
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
147 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClockuAdjusting the Clock
Models with display audio system
■ Using the settings menu on the audio/information screen
Models with display audio system
The clock in the multi-information display is
automatically adjusted along with the audio system’s
clock display.
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 322
You can turn the clock display on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 322
Controls
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Info.
4. Select the Clock tab.
5. Select Clock Adjustment.
6. Select 3 or 4 to change hour.
7. Select 3 or 4 to change minute, then
select OK.
1Adjusting the Time
147
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
148 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions
This vehicle comes with the following keys:
1Key Types and Functions
■ Keys
Use the key to start and stop the engine, and to lock all the doors and tailgate.
Keyless Remote *
Controls
148
* Not available on all models
Retractable Key *
Ignition Key *
All the keys have an immobilizer system. The
immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle
theft.
2 Immobilizer System P. 163
The keys contain precision electronics.
Adhere to the following advice to prevent damage to
the electronics:
• Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in
locations with high temperature or high humidity.
• Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
• Keep the keys away from liquids.
• Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the
battery.
If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the engine
may not start, and the remote transmitter/keyless
access system * may not work.
If the keys do not work properly, have them
inspected by a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
149 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey Types and Functions
■ Keyless remote *
Release Knob
To remove the built-in key, pull it out while
sliding the release knob. To reinstall the builtin key, push the built-in key into the keyless
remote until it clicks.
■ Retractable keys *
Release Button
Push
* Not available on all models
1Retractable keys *
The key folds up inside the remote
transmitter.
1. Press the release button to release the key
out from the transmitter.
u Make sure to fully extend the key.
2. To close the key, press the release button
then push the key inside the transmitter
until you hear a click.
Continued
Controls
Built-in Key
The built-in key can be used to lock the doors
when the keyless remote battery becomes
weak and the power door lock/unlock
operation is disabled.
If the key is not fully extended, the immobilizer
system may not work properly, and the engine may
not start.
Avoid contact with the key whenever it extends or
retracts.
149
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
150 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey Types and Functions
■ Key Number Tag
1Key Number Tag
Contains a number that you will need if you
purchase a replacement key.
Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a
safe place outside of your vehicle.
If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a
dealer.
If you lose your key and you cannot start the engine,
contact a dealer.
Controls
150
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
151 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLow Keyless Remote Signal Strength *
Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength *
The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the keyless remote when locking/
unlocking the doors and tailgate, or to start the engine.
In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors and tailgate, or starting the
engine may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:
• Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
• You are carrying the keyless remote together with telecommunications
equipment, laptop computers, mobile phones, or wireless devices.
• A metallic object is touching or covering the keyless remote.
1Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength *
Communication between the keyless remote and the
vehicle consumes the keyless remote’s battery.
The keyless remote battery lasts about two years. This
changes by how often you use the remote.
The battery is consumed whenever the keyless
remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing
it near electrical appliances such as televisions and
personal computers.
Controls
* Not available on all models
151
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
152 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Keyless Access System *
Controls
When you carry the keyless remote, you can
lock/unlock the doors and tailgate.
You can lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate within a radius of about 80 cm (32
inches) of the outside door handle. You can
open the tailgate within about 80 cm (32
inches) radius from the tailgate release
button.
Door Lock
Button
■ Locking the vehicle
Press the door lock button on the front door
or the tailgate.
u Some exterior lights flash three times; all
the doors and tailgate lock; and the
security system sets.
1Using the Keyless Access System *
• Do not leave the keyless remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the keyless remote, you
•
•
•
•
•
•
can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate while
someone else with the remote is within range.
The door may be unlocked if the door handle is
covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if
the keyless remote is within range.
If you grip a front door handle wearing gloves, the
door sensor may be slow to respond or may not
respond by unlocking the doors.
You cannot unlock the door by gripping the handle
after two seconds of locking it.
The door may not open if you pull it immediately
after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle
again and confirm that the door is unlocked before
pulling the handle.
Even within the 80 cm (32 inches) radius, you may
not be able to lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate with the keyless remote if it is above or
below the outside handle.
The keyless remote may not operate if it is too close
to the door and door glass.
If the distance at which the remote transmitter works
varies, the battery is probably low. Replace the
button battery as soon as possible.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 544
Lock Button
152
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
153 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the vehicle
1Using the Keyless Access System *
Grab the front door handle:
u All the doors and tailgate unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash once.
Controls
Press the tailgate release button:
u All the doors and tailgate unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash once.
If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30
seconds of unlocking the vehicle, the doors and
tailgate will automatically relock.
2 Using the Tailgate Release Button P. 162
Tailgate Release
Button
* Not available on all models
Continued
153
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
154 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
■ Locking the doors
LED
Lock
Button
Unlock
Button
Controls
Lock
Button
LED
Unlock
Button
Press the lock button.
u Some exterior lights flash three times, all
the doors and tailgate lock, and the
security system sets.
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Models with keyless access system
Right-hand drive type
You cannot lock any doors from the outside when
the keyless remote is inside the vehicle, and the
beeper sounds. If you want to lock a door while the
remote is still in the vehicle, do any of the following
four times:
• Press the lock button on the keyless remote.
• Turn the key in the cylinder to lock.
• Press the door lock button on the door handle or
the tailgate.
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30
seconds of unlocking the vehicle with the remote
transmitter, the doors and tailgate will automatically
relock.
If the interior light switch is in the door activated
position, the interior lights come on when you press
the unlock button.
No doors opened: The lights fade out after 30
seconds.
Doors relocked with the remote transmitter: The
lights go off immediately.
2 Interior Lights P. 207
154
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
155 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the doors
1Using the Remote Transmitter
Press the unlock button.
u Some exterior lights flash once, and all doors and the tailgate unlock.
The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so
the operating range may vary depending on the
surroundings.
Models without keyless access system
The remote transmitter will not work when the key is
in the ignition switch.
Models with keyless access system
The remote transmitter will not lock the vehicle when
a door or the tailgate is open.
Controls
You can lock or unlock doors using the remote
transmitter or keyless access system only when the
power mode is in VEHICLE OFF.
If the distance at which the remote transmitter works
varies, the battery is probably low. Replace the
button battery as soon as possible.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 544
Continued
155
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
156 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
Fully insert the key and turn it.
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
When you lock/unlock * the driver’s door with the
key, all the other doors and the tailgate lock/unlock *
at the same time.
Lock
Models with security system
Unlock *
Controls
156
Unlocking the doors with the key causes the security
system to alarm. Always unlock the doors with the
remote transmitter.
Models with retractable key
If you are using the retractable key, make sure it is
fully extended.
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
157 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking a Door Without Using a Key
■ Locking the driver's door
Push the lock tab forward a or push the
master door lock switch in the lock direction
b, then pull and hold the outside door handle
c. Close the door, then release the handle.
1Locking a Door Without Using a Key
When you lock the driver's door, all the other doors
and tailgate lock at the same time.
Make sure you have the key in your hand before
locking the door to prevent it from being locked in
the vehicle.
■ Locking the passengers’ doors
Push the lock tab forward and close the door.
Controls
■ Lockout prevention system
Models without keyless access system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the key is in the ignition switch.
Models with keyless access system
The doors and the tailgate cannot be locked when the keyless remote is inside the
vehicle.
157
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
158 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Lock Tab
To Lock
1Using the Lock Tab
■ Locking a door
Lock Tab
Push the lock tab forward.
■ Unlocking a door
To Unlock
Pull the lock tab rearward.
Controls
■ Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
Pull the front door inner handle.
u The door unlocks and opens in one
motion.
Left-hand drive type
Inner Handle
158
Unlocking and opening the driver’s door from
the inner handle unlocks all the other doors
and the tailgate.
Left-hand drive type
When you lock/unlock the door using the lock tab on
the driver’s door, all the other doors and the tailgate
lock/unlock at the same time.
Right-hand drive type
When you lock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, all the other doors and tailgate lock at
the same time.
When you unlock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, only the driver's door will unlock.
1Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
The front door inner handles are designed to allow
front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.
However, this feature requires that front seat
occupants never pull a front door inner handle while
the vehicle is in motion.
Children should always ride in a rear seat where
childproof door locks are provided.
2 Childproof Door Locks P. 160
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
159 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Master Door Lock Switch
Press the master door lock switch in as shown
to lock or unlock all doors and the tailgate.
1Using the Master Door Lock Switch
When you lock/unlock the driver's door using the
master lock switch, all the other doors and the
tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.
To Lock
Master Door
Lock Switch
Controls
To Unlock
159
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
160 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuChildproof Door Locks
Childproof Door Locks
The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock tab.
■ Setting the Childproof Door Locks
Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock
position, and close the door.
Unlock
Controls
160
■ When opening the door
Open the door using the outside door handle.
Lock
1Childproof Door Locks
To open the door from the inside when the
childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the
unlock position, lower the rear window, put your
hand out of the window, and pull the outside door
handle.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
161 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Opening and Closing the Tailgate
Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Always make sure individuals and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or
closing it.
■ Opening the tailgate
1Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Be careful not to hit your head on the tailgate or to
put your hands between the tailgate and the luggage
area when closing the tailgate.
When you are storing or picking up luggage from the
luggage area while the engine is idling, do not stand
in front of the exhaust pipe. You may get burned.
■ Closing the tailgate
Do not allow any passenger in the luggage space.
They may get hurt during hard braking, a sudden
acceleration, or a crash.
Keep the tailgate closed while driving to:
u Avoid possible damage.
u Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
Controls
• Open the tailgate all the way.
u If it is not fully opened, the tailgate may come down accidentally by its own
weight.
• Be careful when it is windy. The wind may cause the tailgate to close.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 82
161
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
162 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuUsing the Tailgate Release Button
Using the Tailgate Release Button
When all the doors are unlocked, the tailgate
is unlocked. Press the tailgate release button
and lift open the tailgate.
1Using the Tailgate Release Button
Models with keyless access system
• Do not leave the keyless remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
Tailgate
Release
Button
Even if the tailgate is locked, you can open the
tailgate if you carry the keyless remote.
Controls
All models
Inner
Handle
162
Models with keyless access system
To close the tailgate, grab the inner handle,
pull the tailgate down, and push it closed
from outside.
• A person who is not carrying the keyless remote
can unlock the tailgate if a person who is carrying
it is within range.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
163 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Security System
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from
starting the engine. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic
signals to verify the key.
NOTICE
Leaving the key in the vehicle can result in theft or
accidental movement of the vehicle.
Always take the key with you whenever you leave the
vehicle unattended.
If the system repeatedly does not recognize the
coding of your key, contact your dealer. If you have
lost your key and cannot start your engine, contact a
dealer.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
Security System Alarm *
Controls
Pay attention to the following when inserting the key into the ignition switch or
pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button:
• Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the ignition switch or the
ENGINE START/STOP button.
• Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
• Do not bring a key from another vehicle's immobilizer system near the ignition
switch or with the keyless remote.
1Immobilizer System
1Security System Alarm *
The security system alarm activates when the tailgate, bonnet, or doors are opened
without the remote transmitter or keyless access system. It also activates if you
unlock the door with the key.
The security alarm continues for 30 seconds, then the
system resets. If the cause of the alarm continues,
alarming will repeat several times at about five
second intervals.
■ When the security system alarm activates
The horn sounds intermittently and some exterior lights flash.
■ To deactivate the security system alarm
Unlock the vehicle using the remote transmitter or keyless access system, or the
ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1. The system, along with the horn and flashing
lights, is deactivated.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
163
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
164 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm *
■ Setting the security system alarm
The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have
been met:
• The ignition switch is in LOCK (0 *1.
• The bonnet and tailgate are closed.
• All doors and the tailgate are locked from outside with the key, the remote
transmitter, or keyless access system.
Models without keyless access system
• The key has been removed from the ignition switch.
Controls
■ When the security system alarm sets
The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks. When the
blinking interval changes after about 15 seconds, the security system alarm is set.
■ To cancel the security system alarm
The security system alarm is cancelled when the vehicle is unlocked using the remote
transmitter, keyless access system or the ignition switch is turned to ON (w *1. The
security system alarm indicator goes off at the same time.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
164
* Not available on all models
1Security System Alarm *
Do not set the security system alarm when someone
is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can
accidentally activate when the door is unlocked with
the lock tab.
If the battery goes dead after you have set the
security system alarm, the security alarm may go off
once the battery is recharged or replaced.
If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by
unlocking a door using the remote transmitter or
keyless access system.
Do not attempt to alter this system or add another
device to it.
Do not unlock the door using the key. The security
system alarm goes off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
165 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSecurity SystemuUltrasonic Sensors *
Ultrasonic Sensors *
The ultrasonic sensors activate only when the security system alarm sets. The sensors
detect if someone intrudes into the passenger compartment through a window or
moves in the compartment, and activate the alarm.
■ To set the security system alarm without activating the ultrasonic sensors
Do not set the security system alarm while someone
is in the vehicle, or if a window is open. The system
may accidentally activate when the ultrasonic sensor
detects vibrations or loud sounds.
Do not unlock the door using the key. The security
system alarm goes off.
Controls
You can set the security system alarm without activating the ultrasonic sensor.
To turn off the ultrasonic sensor system, press
the ultrasonic sensor OFF button after you
remove the key from the ignition switch, or
with the key in the ACCESSORY (q or LOCK
(0 *1.
1Ultrasonic Sensors *
Ultrasonic Sensor OFF Button
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
165
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
166 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSecurity SystemuSuper Locking *
Super Locking *
The super locking function disables the lock tabs on all doors.
■ To activate the super locking function
• Turn the key in the driver's door towards the vehicle front twice within five
seconds.
• Press the lock button on the remote transmitter twice within five seconds.
Models with keyless access system
Controls
• Press the door lock button on the door handle or the tailgate twice within five
seconds.
■ To cancel the super locking function
166
* Not available on all models
Unlock the driver's door with the remote transmitter or keyless access system.
1Super Locking *
3 WARNING
No one must be inside the vehicle with the
super locking set. Persons locked in can get
seriously sick or die from the heat built
inside the vehicle if left in the sun.
Make sure there is no one inside the vehicle
before setting the super locking function.
Do not unlock the door using the key. The security
system alarm goes off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
167 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Opening and Closing the Windows
Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be opened and closed when the ignition switch is in ON
(w *1, using the switches on the doors. The driver's side switches can be used to
open and close all the windows.
The power window lock button on the driver's side must be switched off (not
pushed in, indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than
the driver's seat.
■ Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function *
Power Window
Lock Button
On
Off
■ Automatic operation
To open: Push the switch down firmly.
To close: Pull the switch up firmly.
3 WARNING
Closing a power window on someone's
hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers are away from
the windows before closing them.
WARNING: Always take the ignition key with you
whenever you leave the vehicle alone with other
occupants.
Controls
When the power window lock button is pushed in, you can only operate the driver's
window. Turn the power window lock button on if a child is in the vehicle.
1Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you turn the ignition switch off*1.
Auto-open/close function on front windows
Opening either front door cancels this function.
Auto-open/close function on all windows
Indicator
The window opens or closes completely. To
stop the window at any time, push or pull the
switch briefly.
■ Manual operation
Driver’s Window Switch
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
Closing the driver's door cancels this function.
Auto Reverse
If a power window senses resistance when closing
automatically, it stops closing and reverse direction.
The driver’s window auto reverse function is disabled
when you continuously pull up the switch.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
167
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
168 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing Windows without Auto-Open/Close
Function
Close
Open
Controls
168
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
169 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing Windows, and Panoramic Glass Roof and
Sunshade * with the Remote *
Lock Button
If the windows stop midway, repeat the
procedure.
■ Closing Windows, and Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade *
with the Key *
Close
Controls
Unlock Button
To open: Press the unlock button twice
within 10 seconds and hold it down for the
second time.
To close: Press the lock button twice within
10 seconds and hold it down for the second
time.
To close: Lock the driver’s door with the key.
Within 10 seconds of returning the key to the
central position, turn the key in the lock
direction and hold it there.
1Closing Windows, and Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade *
with the Key *
Unlocking the doors with the key causes the security
system to alarm. Always unlock the doors with the
remote transmitter.
Release the key to stop the windows and
panoramic glass roof at the desired position. If
you want further adjustment, repeat the same
operation.
* Not available on all models
169
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
170 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Opening and Closing the Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade *
You can only operate the panoramic glass roof and sunshade switches when the
power mode is in ON. Use the switch in the front of the ceiling to open and close
the panoramic glass roof and sunshade.
■ Opening/Closing the Panoramic Glass Roof
■ Automatic operation
Open
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
Controls
The panoramic glass roof automatically opens
or closes all the way. To stop the panoramic
glass roof midway, touch the switch briefly.
Close
Tilt
■ Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
■ Tilting the panoramic glass roof up
To tilt: Push on the centre of the panoramic
glass roof switch.
u The sunshade will open automatically
and the panoramic glass roof will start to
tilt up.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
170
* Not available on all models
1Opening and Closing the Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade *
3 WARNING
Opening or closing the panoramic glass
roof and sunshade on someone’s hands or
fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of
the panoramic glass roof and sunshade
before opening or closing it.
WARNING: Always take the ignition key with you
whenever you leave the vehicle alone with other
occupants.
NOTICE
Opening the panoramic glass roof in below freezing
temperature or when it is covered with snow or ice
can damage the panoramic glass roof panel or
motor.
The panoramic glass roof and sunshade can be
operated for up to 10 minutes after you set the
power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
Closing the driver's door cancels this function.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
171 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOpening and Closing the Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade * u
■ Opening/Closing the Sunshade
■ Automatic operation
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
Open
The sunshade automatically opens or closes all
the way. To stop the sunshade midway, touch
the switch briefly.
■ Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
* Not available on all models
The sunshade can be opened or closed to adjust the
amount of light that enters the cabin.
When resistance is detected, the auto reverse
function causes the panoramic glass roof and
sunshade to change directions, then stop. Auto
reverse stops sensing when the panoramic glass roof
and sunshade are almost closed to ensure that they
fully close.
Controls
Close
1Opening and Closing the Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade *
171
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
172 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel
Models without keyless access system
Ignition Switch
1Ignition Switch
Manual transmission models
(0 LOCK: Insert and remove the key in this
position.
(q ACCESSORY: Operate the audio system and
other accessories in this position.
(w ON: This is the position when driving.
Controls
(e START: This position is for starting the engine.
The switch returns to ON (w when you let go of
the key.
3 WARNING
Removing the key from the ignition switch
while driving locks the steering. This can
cause you to lose control of the vehicle.
Remove the key from the ignition switch
only when parked.
Continuously variable transmission models
You cannot take the key out unless the shift lever is
in (P .
All models
If you open the driver’s door when the key is in LOCK
(0 or ACCESSORY (q , the following messages
appear on the multi-information display:
• In LOCK (0 :
• In ACCESSORY (q :
If the key won’t turn from LOCK (0 to ACCESSORY
(q , turn the key while moving the steering wheel left
and right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing
the key to turn.
172
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
173 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
Models with keyless access system
ENGINE START/STOP Button
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Changing the Power Mode
ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range
Continuously Variable Transmission
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
Indicator
Indicator in the button is off.
The steering wheel is locked. The
power to all electrical components
is turned off.
Manual Transmission
Operating Range
Controls
ACCESSORY
Indicator in the button is on.
Indicator in the button blinks (from
ON to ACCESSORY). Operate the
audio system and other accessories
in this position.
You can start the engine when the keyless remote is
inside the vehicle.
The engine may also run if the keyless remote is close
to a door or window, even if it is outside the vehicle.
ON mode:
Indicator in the button is off, if the engine is running.
ON
Indicator in the button is on.
All electrical components can be
used.
Without depressing
the brake pedal
Press the button without the
shift lever in (P .
Without pressing
the clutch pedal
If the keyless remote battery is weak, the beeper
sounds and
appears on the multi-information
display.
2 If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak
P. 577
Press the button.
Shift to (P then press the button.
Continued
173
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
174 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Automatic Power Off
If you leave the vehicle for 30 to 60 minutes with the shift lever in (P *1 and the
power mode in ACCESSORY, the vehicle automatically goes into the mode similar to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to avoid the battery drain.
Controls
When in this mode:
The steering wheel does not lock.
You cannot lock or unlock doors with the remote transmitter or the keyless access
system.
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button to switch the mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
2 Changing the Power Mode P. 173
*1: Continuously variable transmission models
174
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
Do not leave the power mode in ACCESSORY or ON
when you get out.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
175 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Power Mode Reminder
If you open the driver’s door when the power mode is set to ACCESSORY, a warning
buzzer sounds.
■ Keyless Remote Reminder
■ When the power mode is in ON
If the keyless remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and the driver’s door is closed,
warning buzzers sound from both inside and
outside the vehicle. A warning message on
the multi-information display notifies the
driver inside that the remote is out.
■ When the power mode is in
ACCESSORY
If the keyless remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and all the doors are closed, a
warning buzzer sounds from outside the
vehicle.
When the keyless remote is within the system’s
operational range, and the driver’s door is closed, the
warning function cancels.
If the keyless remote is taken out of the vehicle after
the engine has been started, you can no longer
change the ENGINE START/STOP button mode or
restart the engine. Always make sure if the remote is
in your vehicle when you operate the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
Controls
Warning buzzers may sound from inside or/
and outside the vehicle to remind you that the
keyless remote is out of the vehicle. If the
buzzer continues even after the remote is put
back inside, place it to be within its
operational range.
1Keyless Remote Reminder
Removing the keyless remote from the vehicle
through a window does not activate the warning
buzzer.
Do not put the keyless remote on the dashboard or in
the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer to go
off. Under some other conditions that can prevent
the vehicle from locating the remote, the warning
buzzer may also go off even if the remote is within
the system’s operational range.
175
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
176 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluIgnition Switch and Power Mode Comparison
Ignition Switch and Power Mode Comparison
Ignition Switch
Position
LOCK (0
(with/without
the key)
Without Keyless
Access System
●
●
●
Controls
Power Mode
Engine is turned off and
power is shut down.
The steering wheel is
locked.
No electrical
components can be
used.
VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK)
ACCESSORY (q
●
●
Engine is turned off.
Some electrical
components such as the
audio system and the
accessory power socket
can be operated.
ACCESSORY
ON (w
●
●
START (e
Normal key position
while driving.
All electrical components
can be used.
ON
Indicator is: On
●
●
Use this position to start
the engine.
The ignition switch
returns to ON (w
position when you
release the key.
START
Off
With Keyless Access Indicator-Off
Indicator-On or blinking
IndicatorIndicator-Off
● The mode automatically
System and ENGINE ● Engine is turned off and ● Engine is turned off.
On (engine is turned off)
●
Some electrical
START/STOP
power is shut down.
Off (engine is running)
returns to ON after the
● The steering wheel is
components such as the ● All electrical components
Button
engine starts.
locked.
audio system and the
can be used.
● No electrical
accessory power socket
components can be
can be operated.
used.
176
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
177 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluTurn Signals
Turn Signals
Right Turn
The turn signals can be used when the ignition
switch is in ON (w *1.
■ One-push turn signal
Left Turn
When you lightly push up or down and release
the turn signal lever, the exterior turn signals
and turn signal indicator blink three times.
Controls
This feature can be used when signalling for a
lane change.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
177
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
178 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
Light Switches
■ Manual Operation
High Beams
1Light Switches
Models without keyless access system
Rotating the light switch turns the lights on
and off, regardless of the position of the
ignition switch*1.
If you remove the key from the ignition switch while
the lights are on, a chime sounds when the driver’s
door is opened.
■ High beams
If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
Models with keyless access system
Push the lever forward until you hear a click.
Controls
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
Turns on position, tail, and rear
licence plate lights
Turns on headlights, position,
tail, and rear licence plate lights
■ Low beams
When in high beams, pull the lever back to
return to low beams.
■ Flashing the high beams
Pull the lever back, and release it.
■ Lights off
Turn the lever to OFF either when:
• The shift lever is in (P *2.
• The parking brake is applied.
To turn the lights on again, turn the lever to
OFF to cancel the lights off mode. Even if you
do not cancel the lights off mode, the lights
come on automatically when:
• The shift lever is moved out of (P *2.
• The parking brake is released.
• The vehicle starts to move.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
*2: Continuously variable transmission models
178
If you sense that the level of the headlights is
abnormal, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Do not leave the lights on when the engine is off
because it will cause the battery to discharge.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
179 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Automatic Lighting Control
1Automatic Lighting Control
Automatic lighting control can be used when
the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
We recommend that you turn on the lights manually
when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas
such as long tunnels or parking facilities.
When the light switch is in AUTO, the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
The light sensor is in the location shown below.
Do not cover this light sensor with anything;
otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not
work properly.
Light Sensor
Controls
Models with automatic intermittent wipers
Models without automatic intermittent
wipers
Light Sensor
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
179
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
180 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Automatic Lighting Off Feature
The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15
seconds after you remove the key or set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK),
take the remote with you, and close the driver's door. However, when the switch is
in
, the parking lights remain on.
Controls
If you turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 with the headlight switch on, but do
not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (three minutes, if the switch
is in the AUTO position).
The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver's door. If you unlock
the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the
driver's door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
180
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
181 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluFog Lights
Fog Lights
■ Front fog lights *
Can be used when the position lights or the headlights are on.
■ Rear fog light
Can be used when the headlights or the front fog lights * are on.
■ Front and Rear Fog Lights Switch *
■ To turn the front fog lights on
■ To turn the front and rear fog lights on
Controls
Rotate the switch up from the OFF position to
the
position. The
indicator comes on.
Rotate the switch one position up from the
position. The
and
indicator comes on.
Front and Rear
Fog Lights Switch
■ To turn the rear fog light on
Rotate the switch down from the OFF
position. The
indicator comes on.
* Not available on all models
Continued
181
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
182 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluFog Lights
■ Rear Fog Light Switch *
■ To turn the rear fog light on
Rotate the switch to
comes on.
Controls
182
Rear Fog Light Switch
* Not available on all models
. The
indicator
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
183 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluHeadlight Adjuster *
Headlight Adjuster *
You can adjust the vertical angle of the low
beam headlights when the ignition switch is in
ON (w *1.
The larger dial number indicates the lower
angle.
1Headlight Adjuster *
Models with LED low beam headlights
Your vehicle is equipped with the automatic
headlight adjusting system that automatically adjusts
the vertical angle of the low beam headlights. If you
find a significant change in the vertical angle of the
headlights, there may be a problem with the system.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Models with LED low beam headlights
Refer to the below table for the appropriate dial position for your vehicle’s riding
and loading conditions.
Controls
■ To select the adjusting dial position
The headlights are suitable for left hand drive and
right hand drive, without the need to make any
adjustments or masking, as per UN-ECE R48 Dover
Regulation.
Models with halogen low beam headlights
Condition
A driver
A driver and a front passenger
Five persons in the front and rear seats
Five persons in the front and rear seats and luggage in
the luggage area, within the limit of maximum
permissible axle weight and maximum permissible
vehicle weight
A driver and luggage in the luggage area, within the
limits of maximum permissible axle weight and
maximum permissible vehicle weight
Dial position
0
You may need to alter the headlight beam
distribution.
2 Adjusting Headlight Distribution P. 457
1
2
3
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
183
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
184 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluHigh Beam Support System *
High Beam Support System *
Uses the camera attached, monitors the space ahead of your vehicle, and
automatically changes the low beam headlights to high beam headlights when
necessary.
The system operates when:
■ The headlight switch is in
AUTO.
■ The lever is in the low beam
position.
■ The system recognises that you
Controls
are driving at night and the
low beam headlights come on.
■ The vehicle speed is above 40
km/h (25 mph).
The system changes between high and low beam headlights when:
The camera is not detecting any lights coming from preceding or oncoming
vehicles: The headlights change to high beams.
The camera detects lights coming from a preceding or oncoming vehicle: The
headlights are returned to low beams.
The camera monitors the range within the 38-degree view angle. The distance that
the camera can detect lights ahead differs depending on conditions, such as the
brightness of the lights and the weather.
19-degree
184
* Not available on all models
1High Beam Support System *
The high beam support system determines when to
change the headlight beams by responding to the
brightness of the lights ahead of your vehicle. In the
following cases, the system may not respond to the
lights properly:
• The brightness of the lights from the preceding or
oncoming vehicle is intense or poor.
• Visibility is poor due to the weather (rain, snow,
fog, windscreen frost, etc.).
• Other light sources, such as streetlights and electric
billboards are illuminating the road ahead.
• The brightness level of the road ahead constantly
changes.
• The road is bumpy or with many curves.
• A vehicle cuts in front of you, or a vehicle in front
of you is not in the preceding or oncoming
direction.
• Your vehicle is tilted with a heavy load in the rear.
If you find the timing of beam changes inconvenient
for driving, change the headlight beams manually.
If you do not want the system to be activated at any
time when the headlight switch is in AUTO, consult a
dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
185 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluHigh Beam Support System *
■ To Operate the System
1To Operate the System
Turn the headlight switch in AUTO and pull
the headlight lever to low beam.
2 Light Switches P. 178
The high beam support system indicator
comes on.
If the camera receives a strong impact, or repairing of
the area near the camera is required, consult a dealer.
■ Temporary cancellation
The high beam support system operation is temporarily cancelled while:
• You are continuously driving at a speed below 24 km/h (15 mph).
• The vehicle speed is below 10 km/h (6 mph).
• The windscreen wipers run at high speed for more than a few seconds.
The system operation resumes once the condition that caused it to cancel improves.
Controls
Headlight
Switch
For the high beam support system to work properly:
• Do not place an object that reflects light on the
dashboard.
• Keep the windscreen around the camera clean.
When cleaning the windscreen, be careful not to
apply the windscreen cleanser to the camera lens.
• Do not attach an object, sticker or film in the area
around the camera.
• Do not touch the camera lens.
To help to reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut
off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front
of the vehicle away from the sun.
If you use a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to
cover the camera housing. Covering the camera can
concentrate heat on the camera.
If the
message appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the demister mode when
windows are fogged.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
Continued
185
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
186 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDaytime Running Lights
■ To manually cancel the system temporarily
You can cancel the operation when you manually change the headlights to high
beams. Push the lever forward until you hear a click, or lightly pull the lever towards
you to flash high beams. The high beam support system indicator goes off.
If you want the high beam support system operation to resume at once, pull and
hold the lever towards you for a few seconds.
Controls
Daytime Running Lights
The daytime running lights come on when the following conditions have been met:
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
• The position lights or the headlights are off.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
186
1To Operate the System
If the
message appears:
Park your vehicle in a safe place. Wipe away debris
blocking the windscreen, then start driving again. If
the message remains on even after driving for a while
with the clean windscreen, have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
187 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
Wipers and Washers
■ Front Wiper/Washer
1Wipers and Washers
a
b
c
Pull to
use
washer.
d
Intermittent Time
Adjustment Ring
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT , LO, HI)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
*
■ AUTO *
2 Automatic Intermittent Wipers * P. 188
a MIST
■ Adjusting wiper operation *
b OFF
Turn the adjustment ring to adjust wiper operation.
c INT *: Low speed with
intermittent
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
NOTICE
Do not use the wipers when the windscreen is dry.
The windscreen will get scratched, or the rubber
blades will get damaged.
NOTICE
In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the
windscreen, becoming stuck.
Operating the wipers in this condition may damage
the wipers. Use the demister to warm the
windscreen, then turn the wipers on.
Models without automatic intermittent wipers
If the vehicle speeds up while the wipers are
operating intermittently, the length of the wipe
interval shortens. When the vehicle starts moving, the
wipers make a single sweep.
When the vehicle speeds up, the wiper operation’s
shortest delay setting (
the same.
d LO: Low speed wipe
e HI: High speed wipe
Higher speed, more sweeps
Controls
e
The windscreen wipers and washers can be
used when the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ MIST
The wipers run at high speed until you release
the lever.
) and the LO setting become
Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out.
The pump may get damaged.
■ Washer
Sprays while you pull the lever towards you.
When you release the lever for more than one
second, the spray stops, the wipers sweep two
or three more times to clear the windscreen,
then stop.
The wiper motor is equipped with a breaker that may
stop motor operation temporarily to prevent an
overload. Wiper operation resumes within a few
minutes once the circuit has returned to normal.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
187
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
188 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
When you push the lever down to AUTO, the
windscreen wipers sweep once, and go into
the automatic mode.
1Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
The rainfall sensor is in the location shown below.
Rainfall Sensor
Controls
The wipers operate intermittently, at low
speed, or at high speed and stops in
accordance with the amount of rainfall the
rainfall sensor detects.
■ AUTO sensitivity adjustment
When in AUTO, you can also adjust the rainfall sensor sensitivity using the
intermittent time adjustment ring.
Sensor sensitivity
Low sensitivity:
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
High sensitivity:
Higher speed, more sweeps
Do not put the wiper lever in AUTO when cleaning
the windscreen or driving through a car wash. If the
wiper lever is in AUTO, and the ignition switch is in
ON (w *1, the rainfall sensor may respond to your
hand or car wash liquids, and the wipers may operate
automatically.
If the wiper stops operating due to any obstacle such
as the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe
place.
Rotate the wiper switch to OFF, and turn the ignition
switch to ACCESSORY (q or LOCK (0 *1, then
remove the obstacle.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE
START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
188
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
189 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Rear Wiper/Washer
b
d
a
The rear wiper and washer can be used when
the ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT, ON)
c
d
b ON
c OFF
d Washer
■ Washer (
)
Sprays while you rotate the switch to this
position.
Hold it to activate the wiper and to spray the
washer. Once released, it stops operating
after a few more sweeps.
Controls
a INT: Intermittent
The wiper operates intermittently after
completing a few sweeps.
■ Operating in reverse
When you shift the transmission to (R with the windscreen wipers activated, the
rear wiper operates automatically as follows even if its switch is off.
Front Wiper Position
INT (Intermittent)
LO (Low speed wipe)
HI (High speed wipe)
Rear Wiper Operation
Intermittent
Continuous
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
189
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
190 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Brightness Control
When the ignition switch is in ON (w *1, you
can use the
(Select/Reset) knob to adjust
instrument panel brightness.
Brighten: Turn the knob to the right.
Dim: Turn the knob to the left.
The multi-information display will return to its
original state several seconds after you adjust
the brightness.
Controls
(Select/Reset) Knob
■ Brightness level indicator
The brightness level is shown on the multiinformation display while you are adjusting it.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
190
1Brightness Control
Instrument panel brightness varies, depending on
whether the exterior lights are on or off. The
instrument panel dims to reduce glare when they are
on.
Pressing the
knob switches the display.
Turn the knob to the right until the brightness display
is up to max. This cancels the reduced instrument
panel brightness when the lights are on.
The brightness can be set differently for when the
lights are on, and when they are off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
191 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluRear Demister/Heated Door Mirror Icon
Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror Icon
Touch the icon to defog the rear window and door mirrors when the ignition switch
is in ON (w *1.
The rear demister and heated door mirrors
automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes
depending on the outside temperature.
However, if the outside temperature is 0°C or
below, they do not automatically switch off.
1Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror Icon
NOTICE
When cleaning the inside of the rear window, be
careful not to damage the heating wires.
It is critical to wipe the window from side to side
along the demister heating wires.
Controls
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged.
Also, do not use the system for a long period when
the engine is idling. This may weaken the battery,
making it difficult to start the engine.
When the outside temperature is below 5°C, the
heated door mirror may activate automatically for 10
minutes when you turn the ignition switch to ON
(w *1.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
191
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
192 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAdjusting the Steering Wheel
Adjusting the Steering Wheel
Controls
192
The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you
can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.
1. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up.
To adjust
u The steering wheel adjustment lever is
under the steering column.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and
in or out.
u Make sure you can see the instrument
panel gauges and indicators.
3. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever
Lever
down to lock the steering wheel in position.
To lock
u After adjusting the position, make sure
you have securely locked the steering
wheel in place by trying to move it up,
down, in, and out.
1Adjusting the Steering Wheel
3 WARNING
Adjusting the steering wheel position while
driving may cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel only when the
vehicle is stopped.
Make any steering wheel adjustments before you
start driving.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
193 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror
Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving
position.
■ Rearview Mirror with Day and Night Positions *
Up
Tab
Flip the tab to switch the position.
The night position helps to reduce the glare
from headlights behind you when driving
after dark.
1Adjusting the Mirrors
Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and
adjusted for best visibility.
Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
2 Adjusting the Seat Positions P. 197
Controls
Daytime
Position
Down
Night Position
■ Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror *
When driving after dark, the automatic
dimming rearview mirror reduces the glare
from headlights behind you. Press the auto
button to turn this function on and off. When
activated, the auto indicator comes on.
1Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror *
The auto dimming function cancels when the shift
lever is in (R .
Sensor
Indicator
Auto Button
* Not available on all models
193
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
194 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
Power Door Mirrors
You can adjust the door mirrors when the
ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
Selector Switch
Folding Button
■ Mirror position adjustment
Adjustment Switch
Controls
L/R selector switch: Select the left or right
mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the
switch to the centre position.
Mirror position adjustment switch: Press
the switch left, right, up, or down to move the
mirror.
■ Folding door mirrors
Press the folding button to fold in and out the
door mirrors.
■ Reverse Tilt Door Mirror *
Selector
Switch
If activated, passenger side door mirror
automatically tilts downward when you put
the shift lever in (R ; this improves close-in
visibility on the passenger side of the vehicle
when reversing. The mirror automatically
returns to its original position when you shift
out of (R .
To activate this feature, turn the ignition
switch to ON (w *1, and slide the selector
switch to the passenger side.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
194
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
195 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
■ Automatic Folding Door Mirror Function *
■ Folding in the door mirrors
Press the lock button on the remote transmitter or keyless remote twice within 10
seconds, and hold it.
u You can release the button once the mirrors start folding in automatically.
Models with keyless access system
1Folding out the door mirrors
The door mirrors do not fold out automatically if they
have been folded in using the folding button.
Controls
Press the door lock button on either front outside door handle or the tailgate twice
within 10 seconds, and hold it.
u You can release the button once the mirrors start folding in automatically.
■ Folding out the door mirrors
Unlock all doors and the tailgate using the remote transmitter. Open the driver’s
door.
u The mirrors start folding out automatically.
Models with keyless access system
Grab either front outside door handle or press the tailgate release button and unlock
all doors and the tailgate. Open the driver’s door.
u The mirrors start folding out automatically.
* Not available on all models
Continued
195
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
196 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
■ Expanded View Driver’s Mirror
Outer Segment
Controls
196
Inner Segment
The driver’s side door mirror has outer and
inner segments.
The outer segment is slightly curved to provide
a wider angle view than a standard flat mirror.
This wider view may help you check areas that
are not visible using a standard door mirror.
1Expanded View Driver’s Mirror
Objects visible in the outer segment of the driver’s
side door mirror appear smaller than objects in the
rest of the mirror. But in fact, they are closer than
they appear.
Do not rely on your mirrors. Always look to the side
and behind your vehicle before changing lanes.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
197 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Adjusting the Seats
Adjusting the Seat Positions
Allow sufficient
space.
Move back.
■ Adjusting the front seat
1Adjusting the Seats
3 WARNING
Sitting too close to a front airbag can result
in serious injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the front
airbags as possible while maintaining
control of the vehicle.
In addition to the seat adjustment, you can adjust the
steering wheel up and down, in and out. Allow at
least 25 cm (10 inches) between the centre of the
steering wheel and the chest.
Height Adjustment *
Pull up or push down the lever
to raise or lower the seat.
Controls
Adjust the driver's seat as far back as possible
while allowing you to maintain full control of
the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright,
well back in the seat and be able to
adequately press the pedals without leaning
forward, and grip the steering wheel
comfortably. The passenger's seat should be
adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far
back from the front airbag in the dashboard
as possible.
Always make seat adjustments before driving.
Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and
forth to make sure it is locked in position.
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
Pull up on the bar to
move the seat, then
release the bar.
Pull up the lever to
change the angle.
Driver’s seat is shown.
* Not available on all models
Continued
197
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
198 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the Seat-Backs
1Adjusting the Seat-Backs
Adjust the driver's seat-back to a comfortable,
upright position, leaving ample space
between your chest and the airbag cover in
the centre of the steering wheel.
Controls
198
The front seat passenger should also adjust
their seat-back to a comfortable, upright
position.
Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the
occupant's chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the
chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a
seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.
3 WARNING
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in
serious injury or death in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an upright position,
and sit well back in the seat.
Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the
seat-back and your back.
Doing so may interfere with proper seat belt or airbag
operation.
If you cannot get far enough away from the steering
wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some type of adaptive
equipment may help.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
199 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the Head Restraints
1Adjusting the Head Restraints
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints
in all seating positions.
Continued
Improperly positioning head restraints
reduces their effectiveness and increases
the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.
Make sure head restraints are in place and
positioned properly before driving.
In order for the head restraint system to work
properly.
• Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or
from the restraint legs.
• Do not place any objects between an occupant and
the seat-back.
• Install each restraint in its proper location.
Controls
Position head in the centre
of the head restraint.
Head restraints are most effective for
protection against whiplash and other rearimpact crash injuries when the centre of the
back of the occupant’s head rests against the
centre of the restraint. The tops of the
occupant’s ears should be level with the
centre height of the restraint.
3 WARNING
199
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
200 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Adjusting the front head restraint positions
To raise the head restraint: Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint: Push it down
while pressing the release button.
Controls
To tilt the head restraint forward: Push
the back of it forward.
To tilt the head restraint backward: Push
it backward while pressing the release button
on the side of the head restraint.
Release
Button
200
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
201 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Changing the Rear Seat Head Restraint Positions
A passenger sitting in the outer or centre back
seating position should adjust the height of
their head restraint to an appropriate position
before the vehicle begins moving.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button.
■ Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
When you use the head restraint in a rear seating
position, pull up the head restraint to its highest
position. Do not use it in any lower position.
Controls
Release
Button
1Changing the Rear Seat Head Restraint Positions
1Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
3 WARNING
Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.
To remove a head restraint:
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the
restraint up and out.
To reinstall a head restraint:
Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height
while pressing the release button. Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked
in position.
Continued
Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the
head restraints can result in severe injury
during a crash.
Always replace the head restraints before
driving.
To remove and install the rear outer head restraint,
recline the seat-back slightly forward as the space
between the ceiling and the seat-back is limited.
201
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
202 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuAdjusting the Seat Positions
■ Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their
seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their
seats, with their feet on the floor until the vehicle is safely parked and the engine is
off.
Controls
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if
an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or
sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly
increased.
In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or
fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.
202
1Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
3 WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position can
result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat,
with your feet on the floor.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
203 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
Rear Seats
■ Adjusting the Rear Seat-Backs
Pull the lever on the right to change the angle
of the right half of the seat-back, and left for
the left half.
Controls
Release Lever
Continued
203
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
204 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding Down the Rear Seats
1Folding Down the Rear Seats
The rear seats can be folded down separately to allow for additional storage space.
■ To fold down the seat
1. Store the centre seat belt first. Insert the
latch plate into the slot on the side of the
anchor buckle.
Retract the seat belt into the holder on the
ceiling.
Controls
2 Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 46
Anchor
Buckle
Latch Plate
2. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
3. Pull the release lever and fold down the
seat-back.
To return the seat to the original position, pull
up the seat-back in the upright position.
Release Lever
204
Make sure all items in the luggage area or items
extending to the rear seats are properly
secured. Loose items can fly forward if you have
to brake hard.
Remove any items from the rear seat cushion and
floor before you fold down the rear seat.
To lock a seat-back upright, push it backwards until it
locks.
Make sure the seat-back, head restraints and seat
cushion are securely latched back into place before
driving. Also, make sure all rear shoulder belts are
positioned in front of the seat-back, and the centre
shoulder belt is re-positioned in the holding slot.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
205 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding the Rear Seat Up
1Folding the Rear Seat Up
Separately lift up the left and right halves of
the rear seat cushions to make room for
luggage area.
Loop
■ Lifting up the seat cushion
1. Make sure the seat belt buckles are in their
loops on the seat.
Check if there are any items on the seat before you
pull the seat cushion up. Check if there are any
obstacles around the floor guide before you put the
seat back in the original position.
Controls
2. Pull up the rear seat cushion.
3. Fold the seat leg down while pushing the
seat cushion firmly against the seat-back to
lock it.
After you fold the seat up, or put it back in the
original position, make sure the seat is firmly secured
by rocking it forward and back.
Seat Leg
Seat Leg
Latch
Floor Guide
■ Putting the seat in the original position
1. Hold the seat cushion in the upright
position, and pull up the seat leg fully.
u The seat cushion can abruptly fall down
once you pull up the seat leg.
2. Slowly put down the seat cushion and set
the seat leg in the floor guide.
u A latch comes out when the leg is set
properly.
205
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
206 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuArmrest
Armrest
■ Using the Front Seat Armrest
The console lid can be used as an armrest.
To adjust:
Slide the armrest to a desired position.
Controls
■ Using the Rear Seat Armrest *
Pull down the armrest in the centre seat-back.
206
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
207 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights
■ Interior Light Switch
Front
Door Activated Position
1Interior Light Switch
■ ON
The interior lights come on regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
■ Door activated
On
Models without keyless access system
Models without keyless access system
• When you remove the key from the ignition switch
but do not open a door.
Models with keyless access system
• When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
• You remove the key from the ignition
switch.
(LOCK), but do not open a door.
• When the power mode is set to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
The interior lights go off immediately in the following
situations:
• When you lock the driver’s door.
• When you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
■ OFF
• When you close the driver’s door with the key in
Models with keyless access system
Controls
Off
The interior lights come on in the following
situations:
• When any of the doors are opened.
• You unlock the driver’s door.
In the door activated position, the interior lights fade
out and go off about 30 seconds after the doors are
closed.
The lights go off after 30 seconds in the following
situations:
• When you unlock the driver’s door but do not open
it.
Models without keyless access system
The interior lights remain off regardless of
whether the doors are open or closed.
the ignition switch.
Models with keyless access system
• When you close the driver’s door in ACCESSORY
mode.
If you leave any of the doors open in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) mode, or without the key in the ignition
switch, the interior lights go off after about 15
minutes.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
207
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
208 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Map Lights
Front
Controls
208
Rear
1Map Lights
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the
(map light) button.
When the interior light switch is in the door activated
position and any door is open, the rear map light will
not go off when you press the
button.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
209 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Luggage Area Light
■ ON
On
Off
The light comes on when you open the
tailgate, and goes off when closed.
■ OFF
The light stays off with or without opening the
tailgate.
Controls
209
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
210 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Interior Convenience Items
■ Glove Box
1Glove Box
Pull the handle to open the glove box.
3 WARNING
An open glove box can cause serious injury
to your passenger in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat belt.
Always keep the glove box closed while
driving.
Controls
■ Console Compartment
Pull the handle to open the console
compartment.
210
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
211 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Beverage Holders
1Beverage Holders
NOTICE
■ Front seat beverage holders
Front Door
Spilled liquids can damage the upholstery, carpeting,
and electrical components in the interior.
Be careful when you are using the beverage holders.
Hot liquid can scald you.
Arms
Controls
■ Centre console beverage holders
Centre Console
To put a short-size beverage:
Pressing a button inside the console raises the
bottom plate. Arms come out to hold a
beverage.
Buttons
Bottom Plate
To put a tall-size beverage:
Close the arms and push down the bottom
plate.
Continued
211
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
212 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Rear Door
Controls
212
Rearward of the Centre Console
■ Rear seat beverage holders
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
213 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Under-Floor Storage Area
Models with tyre repair kit
Pull up the luggage area floor lid.
Models with front fog lights
Controls
Models with tyre repair kit
Models without front fog lights
Luggage Floor Box
Models with a compact spare tyre
Luggage Floor Box
Continued
213
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
214 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory Power Sockets
The accessory power socket can be used when the ignition switch is in ACCESSORY
(q or ON (w *1.
■ Accessory power socket (console panel)
Open the cover to use it.
1Accessory Power Sockets
NOTICE
Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter
element.
This can overheat the power socket.
The accessory power socket is designed to supply
power for 12 volt DC accessories that are rated 180
watts (15 amps) or less.
Controls
When each socket is being used simultaneously, the
combined power rating of the accessories should not
exceed 180 watts (15 amps).
To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket
with the engine running.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
214
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
215 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory power socket (rearward of
the centre console) *
Open the cover to use it.
Open the cover to use it.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Controls
■ Accessory power socket (luggage area)
215
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
216 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Coat Hooks
1Coat Hooks
There are coat hooks on the rear left and right
grab handles. Pull them down to use them.
Controls
There are coat hooks on the left and right
door pillars.
■ Tie-down Anchors
1Tie-down Anchors
The tie-down anchors on the luggage area
floor can be used to install a net for securing
items.
Anchors
216
The coat hooks are not designed for large or heavy
items.
Do not let anyone access items in the luggage area
while driving. Loose items can cause injury if you have
to brake hard.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
217 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Tonneau Cover *
1Tonneau Cover *
The tonneau cover can be used to conceal
your items and protect them from direct
sunlight.
■ To remove:
Pull out the tonneau cover rearwards and
remove it.
The tonneau cover is collapsible.
1. Take the opposite sides, fold the cover
halfway, then twist into opposite ways.
2. Curl to narrow the cover as shown.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Do not stack objects higher than the top of the seat
in the luggage area. They could block your view and
be thrown about the vehicle during a sudden stop.
To prevent tonneau cover damage, do not:
• Place items on the tonneau cover.
• Put weight on the tonneau cover.
When reinstalling the tonneau cover, put the tagged
side first.
Controls
■ To fold:
Do not let anyone access items in the luggage area
while driving. Loose items can cause injury if you have
to brake hard.
Tag
217
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
218 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Seat Heaters *
1Seat Heaters *
The ignition switch must be in ON (w *1 to use
the seat heaters. The HI setting heats the seats
faster than the LO setting.
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Controls
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lowerlimb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Touch the seat heater icon.
Once - The HI setting (two indicators on)
Twice - The LO setting
Three times - The OFF setting (no indicator on)
When a comfortable temperature is reached
while using the seat heater in HI, select LO to
keep the seat warm.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
218
3 WARNING
* Not available on all models
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
In the LO setting, the heater runs continuously and
does not automatically turn off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
219 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control
The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select.
The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that raises or lowers
the interior temperature to your preference as quickly as possible.
Models with SYNC icon
Dashboard
vents
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor vents
Floor and
demister
vents
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows,
turning the system on auto, and setting the
temperature to low. Change the fresh air mode to
recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.
Controls
Passenger’s Side
Temperature
Control Icons*1
Fan Control
Icons*1
When you set the temperature to the lower or upper
limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.
AUTO Icon*1
(On/Off) Icon*1
You can raise or lower the temperature or fan speed
setting flicking either control icon.
SYNC Icon*1
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
If any icons are selected while using the climate
control system in auto, the function of the icon that
was selected will take priority.
The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions
unrelated to the icon that was selected will be
controlled automatically.
To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the
fan may not start immediately when the AUTO icon
is selected.
Mode Control Icon*1
Driver’s Side
Temperature
Control Icons*1
1Using Automatic Climate Control
(Recirculation) Icon*1
*1: Left-hand drive type shown. For the right-hand drive type, these icons are located at the symmetrically
opposite to the left-hand drive type.
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Select the AUTO icon.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the driver’s side or passenger’s side
temperature control icons.
3. Select the
icon to cancel.
Continued
219
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
220 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
1Using Automatic Climate Control
Models without SYNC icon
Selecting the
icon switches the climate control
system between on and off. When turned on, the
system returns to your last selection.
Dashboard
vents
Dashboard
and floor
vents
Floor vents
Floor and
demister
vents
During the Auto Idle Stop, the air conditioning
system will be turned off.
Mode Control Icon
Controls
Temperature
Control Icons*1
Fan Control
Icons*1
AUTO Icon*1
(On/Off) Icon*1
A/C (Air Conditioning) Icon
(Fresh Air) Icon
*1
(Recirculation) Icon
*1 : Left-hand drive type shown. For the right-hand drive type, these icons are located at the symmetrically
opposite to the left-hand drive type.
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Select the AUTO icon.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the temperature control icons.
3. Select the
icon to cancel.
220
While in the ECON mode, the system has greater
temperature fluctuations.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
221 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes
Models with SYNC icon
Select the
(recirculation) icon and switch the mode depending on
environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator off): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in
fresh air mode in normal situations.
Models without SYNC icon
Continued
Controls
Select the
(recirculation) or
(fresh air) icon to switch the mode
depending on environmental conditions.
Recirculation mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh air mode (indicator on): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in fresh
air mode in normal situations.
221
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
222 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows
Models with SYNC icon
Select the
icon to turn the air conditioning
system on and automatically switch the
system to fresh air mode.
Select the
icon again to turn off, the
system returns to the previous settings.
1Defrosting the Windscreen and Windows
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windscreen, the outside of the
windscreen may fog up.
Controls
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
Continuously variable transmission models
Models without SYNC icon
Selecting the
icon restarts the engine
automatically during the Auto Idle Stop.
Manual transmission models
To defog during the Auto Idle Stop, restart the
engine as follows.
1. Make sure the shift lever is in (N .
2. Depress the clutch pedal fully.
3. Select the
icon.
222
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
223 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1To rapidly defrost the windows
Models with SYNC icon
1. Select the
2. Select the
icon.
icon (indicator on).
Controls
Models without SYNC icon
1. Select the
2. Select the
After defrosting the windows, switch over to fresh air
mode. If you keep the system in recirculation mode,
the windows may fog up from humidity. This
impedes visibility.
icon.
icon.
Continued
223
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
224 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep
Controls
You hear the beep when operating the climate control system on the touch screen.
This can be turned on and off.
To turn off the beep:
Models with SYNC icon
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Touch the
of the temperature control
icon five times while pressing and holding
the
.
3. Release the
, after -- blinks five times
and OF is displayed.
Models without SYNC icon
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
224
1Turning On and Off the Touch Screen Beep
If you touch any other icons during this procedure,
the setting may fail. In this case, once you turn the
ignition switch to OFF (0 *1, then follow this
procedure again.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
225 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
Models with SYNC icon
To turn on the beep:
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Touch the
of the temperature control
icon five times while pressing and holding
the
.
3. Release the
, after OF blinks five times
and -- is displayed.
Controls
Models without SYNC icon
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
225
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
226 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuSynchronized Mode *
Synchronized Mode *
1Synchronized Mode *
When you select the
synchronized mode.
icon, the system changes to
When the system is in dual mode, the driver’s side
temperature and the passenger’s side temperature
can be set separately.
Driver’s Side
Temperature
Control Icons
Passenger’s Side
Temperature
Control Icons
Controls
SYNC
(Synchronized)
Icon
You can set the temperature synchronously for the driver’s side and the passenger’s
side in synchronized mode.
1. Select the SYNC icon.
u The system switches to synchronized mode.
2. Adjust the temperature using the driver’s side temperature control icon.
Select the SYNC icon or change the passenger’s side temperature setting to return
to dual mode.
226
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
227 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control SystemuAutomatic Climate Control Sensors
Automatic Climate Control Sensors
Sensor
The automatic climate control system is
equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill
any liquid on them.
Controls
Sensor
227
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
228
228 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
229 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Features
This chapter describes how to operate technology features.
Audio System
About Your Audio System................ 230
USB Port(s) ....................................... 231
HDMITM Port * ................................... 232
Auxiliary Input Jack * ........................ 233
Audio Remote Controls.................... 234
Audio System Theft Protection ......... 236
Models with colour audio system
Audio System Basic Operation ........ 237
Audio/Information Screen ................ 238
Adjusting the Sound ........................ 242
Display Setup ................................... 243
Playing AM/FM Radio ....................... 244
* Not available on all models
Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *... 252
Playing a CD .................................... 256
Playing an iPod ................................ 259
Playing a USB Flash Drive ................. 262
Playing Bluetooth® Audio................. 265
Models with display audio system
Audio System Basic Operation ........ 268
Audio/Information Screen ................ 269
Adjusting the Sound ........................ 284
Display Setup ................................... 285
Playing AM/FM Radio....................... 287
Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *... 291
Playing a CD .................................... 294
Playing an iPod ................................ 297
Playing a USB Flash Drive ................. 300
Playing Bluetooth® Audio ................ 303
Playing a Video Using the HDMITM.... 305
On Board Apps ................................ 307
Smartphone Connection.................. 308
Wi-Fi Connection............................. 311
Siri Eyes Free.................................... 313
Audio Error Messages ...................... 314
General Information on the Audio
System ............................................. 317
Customized Features........................ 322
Hands-Free Telephone System ........ 348
229
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
230 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Audio System
About Your Audio System
Models with navigation system
1About Your Audio System
See the Navigation System Manual for operation of the navigation system features.
Models without navigation system
The audio system features AM/FM radio. It can also play audio CDs, WMA/MP3/AAC
files, USB flash drives, and iPod, iPhone and Bluetooth devices.
Video CDs, DVDs, and 8-cm (3-inch) mini CDs are not
supported.
iPod, iPhone and iTunes are trademarks of Apple Inc.
Place your phone where you can get good reception.
You can operate the audio system from the buttons and switches on the panel, the
remote controls on the steering wheel, or the icons on the touchscreen interface *.
USB Flash Drive
Features
iPod
HDMI
TM*
HDMITM Port *
USB Port(s)
Remote Controls
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
230
* Not available on all models
Models with display audio system
After you turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1, you
can use the audio system for up to 30 minutes per
driving cycle. However, whether you can continue
using the audio system depends on the battery
condition. Repeatedly using this feature may drain
the battery.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
231 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio SystemuUSB Port(s)
USB Port(s)
Models with colour audio system
1. Open the cover.
2. Install the iPod dock connector or the USB
flash drive to the USB port.
1USB Port(s)
• Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the
•
•
USB Port
Models with display audio system
•
•
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a
hub.
Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard
disk drive, as the device or your files may be
damaged.
We recommend your data backed up before using
the device in your vehicle.
Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
Features
If the audio system does not recognise the iPod, try
reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To
reboot, follow the manufacturer's instructions
provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.
USB Port
231
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
232 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio SystemuHDMITM Port *
HDMITM Port *
1. Open the cover.
2. Install the HDMITM cable to the HDMITM
port.
HDMITM Port
Features
232
* Not available on all models
1HDMITM Port *
• Do not leave the HDMITM connected device in the
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
• We recommend your data backed up before using
the device in your vehicle.
• Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition
Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are
trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI
Licensing LLC in the United States and other
countries.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
233 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio SystemuAuxiliary Input Jack *
Auxiliary Input Jack *
Use the jack to connect standard audio
devices.
1. Open the AUX cover.
2. Connect a standard audio device to the
input jack using a 3.5 mm (1/8 inch) stereo
miniplug.
u The audio system automatically switches
to the AUX mode.
1Auxiliary Input Jack *
To switch mode, press any of the audio mode
buttons. You can return to AUX mode by pressing
the CD/AUX button.
Features
* Not available on all models
233
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
234 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Audio Remote Controls
Allow you to operate the audio system while driving.
SOURCE Button
(Display)
Button *
Cycles through the audio modes as follows:
(+ Button
Button
SOURCE
Button
(- Button
Features
234
Models with colour audio system
Button
FM1 FM2 DAB1 * DAB2 * LW MW
CD USB iPod Bluetooth® Audio AUX
Models with display audio system
(Menu)
Button *
FM LW MW DAB * CD USB iPod
Apps Bluetooth® Audio AUX HDMITM
(+ (- (Volume) Buttons
Press (+ : To increase the volume.
Press (- : To decrease the volume.
Buttons
• When listening to the radio
Press : To select the next preset radio station.
Press : To select the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold : To select the next strong station.
To select the next service (DAB). *
Press and hold : To select the previous strong station.
To select the previous service (DAB). *
• When listening to a CD, iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press : To skip to the next song.
Press : To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
• When listening to a CD (MP3/WMA/AAC *), USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press and hold : To skip to the next folder.
Press and hold : To go back to the previous folder.
* Not available on all models
1Audio Remote Controls
Some mode appears only when an appropriate
device or medium is used.
Models with display audio system
While the SOURCE or (+ / (- (volume) button is
pressed, the selected audio mode or volume is
displayed on the upper area of the screen.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
235 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Models with display audio system
The
button is available only when the audio
mode is FM, DAB *, LW, MW, CD, USB, iPod, or
Bluetooth® Audio.
Features
Steering Wheel
(Menu) Button
• When listening to the radio
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Save Preset, or
Seek.
• When listening to a CD or USB flash drive
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Repeat, or Random.
• When listening to an iPod
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Repeat or Shuffle.
• When listening to a Bluetooth® Audio
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Pause or Play.
• When watching a video
Press
: To display the menu items. You can select Scan, Repeat, Random or
Play/Pause.
1Audio Remote Controls
Models with display audio system
(Display) Button
Cycles through the displays as follows:
Navigation * Phone Audio
* Not available on all models
235
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
236 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio SystemuAudio System Theft Protection
Audio System Theft Protection
The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as
when the battery is disconnected or goes dead. In certain conditions, the system
may display a passcode input mode. If this occurs, reactivate the audio system.
■ Reactivating the audio system
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Turn on the audio system.
3. Press and hold the audio system power button for more than two seconds.
u The audio system is reactivated when the audio control unit establishes a
connection with the vehicle control unit. If the control unit fails to recognize
the audio unit, you must go to a dealer and have the audio unit checked.
Features
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
236
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
237 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with colour audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w *1.
Use the selector knob or MENU/CLOCK
Button
button to access some audio functions.
Press
to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
(Back)
Button
MENU/
CLOCK
Button
Selector Knob
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press
to set
your selection.
MENU/CLOCK button: Press to select any
mode.
The available mode includes the wallpaper,
display, clock, language setup, and play
modes. Play modes can be also selected from
scan, random, repeat, and so on.
(Back) button: Press to go back to the previous display.
button: Press to change the audio/information screen brightness.
Press
, then adjust the brightness using
.
u Each time you press
, the mode switches between the daytime mode and
nighttime mode.
Rotate
Press
to select.
to enter.
Menu items
2 Adjusting the Clock P. 146
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 240
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 242
2 Display Setup P. 243
2 Scan P. 251, 255, 258,264
2 Play Mode P. 258, 261, 264
2 Bluetooth P. 265
One of the operating systems used in this unit is
eCos.
For software license terms and conditions, visit their
website (eCos license URL:
http://ecos.sourceware.org/license-overview.html)
For source code disclosure and other details
regarding eCos, visit:
http://www.hondaopensource2.com
Features
Menu Display
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
or
button on the
Press the SOURCE, (+ , (- ,
steering wheel to change any audio setting.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 234
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
237
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
238 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Audio/Information Screen
Audio
Features
Clock/Wallpaper
238
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
239 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Audio
Shows the current audio information.
■ Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
■ Change display
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Display change, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
u If you want to return to the audio display, select Audio.
Features
Continued
239
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
240 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
•
•
•
•
2 USB Port(s) P. 231
Features
240
2. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
3. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press
.
5. Rotate
to select Import, then press .
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Rotate
to select a desired picture, then
press .
u The selected picture is displayed.
7. Press
to save the picture.
8. Press
to select OK.
9. Rotate
to select a location to save the
picture, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper
setting screen.
•
in the USB flash drive’s root directory. Images in a
folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,920 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 480 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
241 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Select, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a desired wallpaper, then press
1Wallpaper Setup
To go back to the previous screen, press the
(Back) button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
.
■ Delete wallpaper
.
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Delete, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press
6. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper setting screen.
241
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
242 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Sound, then press .
3. Rotate
to scroll through the following
choices:
MENU/CLOCK Button
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
TRE is selectable.
Features
BAS
Bass
TRE
Treble
FAD
Fader
BAL
Balance
SVC
Speed-sensitive
Volume
Compensation
Rotate
to adjust the sound setting, then
press .
242
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
243 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or colour theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
■ Changing the Screen’s Colour Theme
You can change the Contrast and Black level
settings in the same manner.
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Display adjustment,
then press .
4. Rotate
to select Brightness, then press
.
5. Rotate
to adjust the setting, then press
.
1Changing the Screen Brightness
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Colour theme, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select the setting you want,
then press .
243
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
244 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Playing AM/FM Radio
Audio/Information Screen
RADIO Button
Press to select a band.
Features
TA Button
Press to activate the TA stand by
function.
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to search up
and down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
Turn to tune the radio frequency.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the
preset button.
244
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
245 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
FM mode
1Playing AM/FM Radio
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
Provides convenient automated services related to your selected RDS-capable FM
station.
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
To switch the audio mode, press the SOURCE button
on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 234
You can store 12 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
the preset button memory. AM has two types of
frequencies LW and MW, and each lets you store six
stations. FM1 and FM2 let you store six stations each.
When you select an RDS capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
Continued
Features
1Radio Data System (RDS)
245
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
246 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ To find an RDS station from Station list
1Radio Data System (RDS)
1. Press while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select the station, then press
.
■ Manual update
Features
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select Update list, then press
.
■ Available RDS functions
Alternative Frequency (AF):
Automatically changes the frequency of the same programme as you enter different
regions.
Regional Programme (REG):
Keeps the same frequency of the stations within that region even if the signal gets
weak.
Except AM/FM/DAB * mode
News Programme (News):
Automatically tunes to the news programme.
246
* Not available on all models
While listening to an FM station on Station list,
pressing
/
(Seek/Skip) button changes the
station.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
247 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Selecting the RDS functions
1Radio Data System (RDS)
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the
FM selected.
2. Rotate
to select RDS settings and press
.
Continued
Pressing
off.
switches the function between on and
Features
3. Each RDS function is displayed every time
you rotate
.
4. Press to select a function.
Turning the Alternative Frequency (AF) function on
and off turns the RDS on and off.
247
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
248 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Traffic announcement (TA) button
TA standby function allows the system to stand by for traffic announcements in any
mode. The last tuned station must be an RDS-capable traffic programme station.
To turn the function on: Press the TA button. When a traffic announcement
begins on your last tuned station, the system automatically switches to the FM
mode. TA-INFO appears on the display. The system returns to your last selected
mode after the traffic announcement is finished.
If you want to go back to your last selected mode during the traffic announcement,
press the TA button again.
Features
248
To cancel the function: Press the TA button.
1Radio Data System (RDS)
TA
When you press the TA button, the TA indicator
appears on the display.
If you select Scan while the TA standby function is
on, the system searches TP station only.
Pressing the TA button while the traffic
announcement is on does not cancel the TA standby
function.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
249 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Except AM/FM/DAB * mode
■ Programme type (PTY)/News interrupt function
Allows the system to interrupt with a newscast in any mode. The last tuned station
must be the NEWS PTY coded station.
To activate the function: Select News from RDS settings and display the NEWS
PTY before changing to other modes. When a newscast begins on your last tuned
station, the system automatically switches to the FM mode.
2 Selecting the RDS functions P. 247
The system returns to your last selected mode if changed to another programme, or
signal gets weak.
The PTY code, ALARM is used for emergency announcements, such as natural
disasters. When this code is received, ALARM appears on the display and the system
interrupts your audio operation.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Features
■ PTY alarm
249
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
250 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Radio text
1Radio text
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the
FM selected.
2. Rotate
to select Radio text and press
.
Features
250
The TEXT indicator appears on the display indicating
radio text information.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
251 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
AM (LW/MW) mode
1Station List
■ Station List
Lists the strongest stations on the selected band.
1. Press the RADIO button to switch to a mode.
2. Press
to switch to the station list mode.
3. Rotate
to select the station, then press .
If the system cannot find any station on Station list,
a confirmation message for updating the list appears.
Rotate
to select Yes, then press to
update the
list.
■ Manual update
■ Scan
Features
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press the RADIO button to switch to a mode.
2. Press
to switch to the station list mode.
3. Rotate
to select Update list, then press .
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press
.
251
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
252 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
Audio/Information Screen
The DAB indicator appears on the
display when the DAB band is
selected.
Features
RADIO Button
Press to select a band.
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
Turn to tune the station.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
252
* Not available on all models
VOL/ (Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it
until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a
band, then press the preset button.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to tune a DAB
ensemble.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
253 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
■ To find an DAB station from Service List or Ensemble List
1. Press
while selecting the DAB mode.
2. Rotate
to select the station, then press
.
u If you select Update list, the system
update the station list.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the
DAB selected.
2. Rotate
to select DAB settings and
press .
If the system cannot find a station, a confirmation
message for updating the list appears. Rotate
to
select Yes, then press
to update the list.
Features
■ Setting the DAB functions
1To find an DAB station from Service List or Ensemble List
3. Each DAB function is displayed every time
you rotate
.
4. Press to select a function.
Continued
253
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
254 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
■ DAB Settings
■ DAB-Link:
Automatically searches for the same station from Ensembles, and switches to it.
■ FM-Link:
If the system finds the same station from an FM band, it automatically switches the
band.
■ Band select:
You can select specific bands. This can reduces the time to update the lists, and
search for a station.
Features
254
■ Radio Text
1Radio Text
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button with the
DAB selected.
2. Rotate
to select Radio text and press
.
The TEXT indicator appears on the display indicating
radio text information.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
255 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press
.
Features
255
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
256 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs in either MP3 or WMA,
or AAC*1 format. With the CD loaded, press the CD/AUX button.
Audio/Information Screen
CD Slot
Insert a CD about halfway into the CD slot.
(CD Eject) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Features
CD/AUX Button
Press to play a CD.
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
Turn to change tracks/files. Press to
display a track/folder list.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change tracks
(files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a track/file.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous display
or cancel a setting.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
*1 : Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
256
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
257 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
1Playing a CD
(MP3/WMA/AAC)
NOTICE
1. Press
to switch the display to a folder list.
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable file, then
skips to the next file.
Folder
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
3. Press
to display a list of tracks in that
folder.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Features
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
• When you select a new folder, file, or track.
• When you change the audio mode to CD.
• When you insert a CD.
Track
Selection
4. Rotate
to select a track, then press
.
Continued
257
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
258 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a track or file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play mode menu items
Repeat
Repeat one folder (MP3/WMA/AAC):
Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat one track: Repeats the current track/
file.
Random
Random in folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays
all files in the current folder in random order.
Random all: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
Scan
Scan folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides
10-second sampling of the first file in each of the
main folders.
Scan tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in
MP3, WMA, or AAC).
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal play, then
press
.
258
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
259 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then press the CD/
AUX button.
2 USB Port(s) P. 231
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is
connected.
Audio/Information Screen
Features
CD/AUX Button
Press to select iPod (if connected).
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
/
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
Turn to change songs.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
or
to change
Press
songs.
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
Album Art
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
Play Mode Buttons
Press to select a play mode.
Continued
259
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
260 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the iPod Music List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
to display the iPod music list.
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 315
Features
Category
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a category.
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
Item
Selection
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
260
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
261 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a song.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Press the selected button.
Play mode menu items
Shuffle albums: Plays all available albums in
a selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
genres, or composers) in random order.
Shuffle: Plays all available songs in a selected
category (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres, or
composers) in random order.
Repeat one track: Repeats the current song.
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal play, then
press
.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
261
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
262 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the CD/AUX button.
2 USB Port(s) P. 231
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive
is connected.
Features
CD/AUX Button
Press to select USB flash drive
(if connected).
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change files.
Press and hold to move rapidly
within a file.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
*1 : Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
262
Audio/Information Screen
LIST/SELECT (Selector) Knob
Turn to change files.
Press and turn to select an item,
then press to set your selection.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
263 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
1. Press
to display a folder list.
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 317
Files in WMA format protected by digital rights
management (DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable file, and then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 315
Folder
Selection
Features
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
3. Press
to display a list of files in that
folder.
Track
Selection
4. Rotate
to select a file, then press
.
Continued
263
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
264 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play mode menu items
Repeat
Repeat one folder: Repeats all files in the
current folder.
Repeat one track: Repeats the current file.
Random
Random in folder: Plays all files in the
current folder in random order.
Random all: Plays all files in random order.
Scan
Scan folders: Provides 10-second sampling
of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all files in the current folder.
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal play, then
press
.
264
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
265 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 354
CD/AUX Button
Press to select
Bluetooth® Audio.
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone is
connected to HFT.
Audio/Information Screen
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
To check if your phone is compatible, ask a dealer.
It may be illegal to perform some data device
functions while driving.
Only one phone can be used with HFT at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
VOL/
(Volume/
Power) Knob
Press to turn the
audio system on and
off.
Turn to adjust the
volume.
/
Press
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
or
to change files.
Features
If more than one phone is paired to the HFT system,
there will be a delay before the system begins to play.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the
menu items.
Pause Button (Preset 2)
Press to pause playing a file.
Play Button (Preset 1)
Press to resume playing a file.
Continued
265
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
266 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
CD/AUX Button
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to the system.
2. Press the CD/AUX button until the
Bluetooth Audio Source is selected.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFTcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
Features
266
Pause Button
Play Button
■ To pause or resume a file
Press the play or pause button to select a mode.
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker’s operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input
jack or USB port, you may need to press the CD/AUX
button repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio
system.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
267 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
to display the music search list.
2. Rotate
to select a category.
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the categories may not be displayed.
Features
Category
Selection
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector
Knob
Item
Selection
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
267
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
268 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with display audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system function, the ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or
ON (w *1.
(Home) Icon: Select to go to the home
(Menu) Icon
screen.
(Home) Icon
Button
Features
(Back) Icon
2 Switching the Display P. 269
(Menu) Icon: Select to select any mode.
The available mode includes Change Source,
Station List, Save Preset, Radio Text,
Music Search, and play modes. Play modes
can be also selected from Scan, Random/
Repeat, and so on.
(Back) Icon: Select to go back to the
previous display when it is displayed.
button:
Press to change the audio/information screen
brightness.
Press
once and select (- or (+ to make
an adjustment.
u Each time you press
, the mode
switches among the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and off mode.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
268
Audio Menu Items
2 Station List P. 288
2 How to Select a File from the Music Search
List (MP3/WMA/AAC) P. 295, 301
2 Scan P. 289, 292, 296, 302
2 How to Select a Play Mode P. 296, 299, 302
When the battery has been reconnected or replaced,
the next start-up may take a few minutes for the
audio system to start. Wait a few moments while the
system is starting up.
Press and hold the
(power) button for
approximately 10 seconds to reset the system.
When the system is reset and started up, you are
required to input the password.
2 Audio System Theft Protection P. 236
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
269 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this display, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Home Screen
Models without
navigation system
Features
Models with
navigation system
Select the
icon to go to the home screen.
Select Phone, Info, Audio, Settings, or Navigation *.
■ Phone
Displays the HFT information.
2 Hands-Free Telephone System P. 348
* Not available on all models
Continued
269
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
270 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Info
To see all available information, Trip Computer, Clock/Wallpaper, or System/
Device Information, select the
icon.
Trip Computer:
• Current Drive tab: Displays the current trip information.
• History of Trip A tab: Displays information for the three previous drives. The
information is stored every time you reset Trip A.
Clock/Wallpaper:
Displays the clock and wallpaper.
Features
System/Device Information:
• Version Information: Displays the software version of the audio system.
• USB Device Information: Displays the memory usage of the USB device.
• USB Device Change: Connects or disconnects USB device to this audio system.
■ Audio
Displays the current status.
■ Settings
Enters the customizing menu screen.
2 Customized Features P. 322
■ Navigation *
Displays the navigation screen.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
270
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
271 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Changing the Home Screen Icon Layout
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the HOME tab.
5. Select Home icon position.
6. Select and hold the icon then, drag it to the
desired position.
Features
Continued
271
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
272 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to five images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
•
•
•
•
2 USB Port(s) P. 231
Features
272
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Info.
4. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then open
the Wallpaper tab.
5. Select Add New.
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Select a desired picture.
u The preview is displayed on the left side
on the screen.
7. Select Start Import to save the data.
u The display will return to the wallpaper
list.
•
in the USB flash drive’s root directory.
Images in a folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 5 MB.
The maximum image size is 4,096 × 4,096 pixels. If
the image size is less than 800 × 480 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
273 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1Wallpaper Setup
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Info.
3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then open the Wallpaper tab.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Select a desired wallpaper.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Set.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
From the pop-up menu, select Preview to see a
preview at full-size screen.
■ Delete wallpaper
Features
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Info.
3. Select Clock/Wallpaper Type, then open the Wallpaper tab.
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
4. Select a wallpaper that you want to delete.
u The preview is displayed on the left side on the screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
5. Select Delete.
u A confirmation message appears on the screen.
6. Select Yes to delete completely.
u The display will return to the wallpaper list.
To go back to the previous screen, select OK, or
select the
(Back) icon.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
To delete all wallpapers you add, select Delete All,
then Yes.
Continued
273
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
274 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Home Screen
1Home Screen
The home screen has 5 pages (fixed). You cannot add
any more pages.
■ To change to a next screen
Swipe
Icon
Features
274
Selecting
or
Icon
Current page position
, or swiping the screen left or right changes to the next screen.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
275 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To use apps or widgets
1To use apps or widgets
1. Select .
u The App/Widget List screen appears.
2. Select the app or widget you want to use.
Icon
Continued
If preinstall apps do not startup normally, try Factory
Data Reset.In case those apps still do not startup
normally even after Factory Data Reset, contact
your dealer.
If you perform Factory Data Reset, it may reset all
the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 347
Features
Preinstall app list:
• Aha Radio: Starts up Aha Radio app.
• Browser: Displays the web browser utilized
by smartphone and Wi-Fi connection.
• Calculator: Displays Calculator.
• Calendar: Displays Calender.
• Clock: Displays Clock.
• Downloads: Displays the data downloaded
from the web browser and so on.
• Gallery: Displays the image list stored in
the audio system.
• Germin Navigator: Starts up navigation
app.
• Honda App Center: Displays Honda App
Center.
• Install App: Installs and updates app
stored in the USB flash drive. However, you
can install and update app only through
Honda App Center.
• Music: Displays the music list stored in the
audio system.
• Search: Displays various retrieval screens.
• Settings: Displays the Android setting
screen.
Select and hold a selected app or widget to add that
app’s or widget’s shortcut on the home screen.
275
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
276 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To add app or widget icons on the home screen
App or widget icons can be added on the home screen.
1. Select and hold empty space on the home
screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
2. Select Add App or Add Widget.
u The Add App/Widget screen appears.
Select and hold.
Features
276
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
277 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Select and hold.
3. Select and hold an app or widget icon you
want to add.
u The screen switches to the Home
customize screen.
4. Drag and drop the icon to where you want
it to be.
5. Select OK.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
Features
Drag and drop.
Continued
277
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
278 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To move icons on the home screen
You can change location on the home screen.
1. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the Home
customize screen.
2. Drag and drop the icon to where you want
it to be.
3.
Select OK.
Select and hold.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
Features
Drag and drop.
278
* Not available on all models
1To move icons on the home screen
You can also move the Phone, Info, Audio,
Settings, and Navigation * icons in the same
manner.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
279 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To delete icons on the home screen
1To delete icons on the home screen
You can delete the icons on the home screen.
1. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the Home
customize screen.
2. Drag and drop the icon you want to delete
to waste basket icon.
Select and hold.
u The icon is deleted.
3. Select OK.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
You cannot delete the Phone, Info, Audio,
Settings, and Navigation * icons.
Apps or widgets will not be deleted by deleting the
icon on the home screen.
Features
Drag and drop.
* Not available on all models
Continued
279
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
280 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To change a wallpaper of the home screen
You can change a wallpaper of the home screen.
1. Select and hold empty space on the home
screen.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
2. Select Select Wallpaper.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
Features
280
3. Select an app for selecting wallpapers.
4. Select the wallpaper you want to change.
5. Select Set wallpaper.
u The wallpaper is changed, then the
screen will return to the home screen.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
281 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Status Area
Swipe the upper area of the screen.
u The status area appears.
Swipe
Select an item to see the details.
Select
area.
or swipe up the
icon to close the
Features
Status Area
Icon
Continued
281
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
282 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Changing the Screen Interface
You can change the screen interface design.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Others tab.
5. Select Skin Change.
6. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
Features
282
1Changing the Screen Interface
You need to reboot the system after changing the
interface design. Wait a few moments while the
system is starting up.
You can change the wallpaper on the audio/
information screen.
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 272
If you change the screen interface, some of the
setting items will change.
2 Customized Features P. 322
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
283 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Closing Apps
You can close apps running in the background on the system.
1. Select and hold the
icon.
2. Select the Active tab.
u If you select the Active/History tab, you
can close the apps that are currently
running and delete the app activity
history simultaneously.
3. Select an app you want to close.
4. Select Clear.
u The display will return to the app list.
1Closing Apps
If you leave the apps used open in the background,
some apps may stop operating properly next time
using them.
If this happens close unused apps.
To close all apps on the system, select Clear All, then
Yes.
Features
283
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
284 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select Sound.
Select a tab from the following choices:
BASS, TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE, Speed
Volume Compensation (SVC)
Features
284
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
285 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or colour theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Display tab.
5. Select Display Settings.
6. Select the setting you want.
7. Select OK.
1Changing the Screen’s Colour Theme
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Display tab.
5. Select Background Colour.
6. Select the setting you want and select it
again.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes to reboot the system.
Continued
Reboot may take a few minutes.
If you default the System settings when the colour
theme is changed from its default colour, the system
reboots.
2 Customized Features P. 322
Features
■ Changing the Screen’s Colour Theme
285
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
286 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
■ Selecting an Audio Source
Select the source icon.
1Selecting an Audio Source
Source Select Screen
Source List Icons
Features
Select the current source icon, then select an icon on the source list to switch the
audio source.
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a greyed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
286
If you startup preinstalled audio apps,
is
displayed on the upper left of the screen.
These preinstalled apps cannot be displayed on the
source select screen.
You can startup those audio apps from App/Widget
List.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
287 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Playing AM/FM Radio
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
Audio/Information Screen
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Tune Icons
Select
or
to tune the radio frequency.
Seek Icons
Select
or
to search up
and down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
Features
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
Continued
287
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
288 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Preset Memory
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Select the
icon.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number for the station you want to store.
■ Station List
Features
Lists the strongest stations on the selected band.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Station List.
3. Select the station.
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Station List.
3. Select Update List.
288
1Preset Memory
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or
select SOURCE on the screen.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 234
You can also switch the mode by selecting Change
Source on the Audio menu screen.
You can store 12 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
preset memory. AM has two types of frequencies LW
and MW, and each lets you store six stations.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
289 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Scan.
To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Radio Data System (RDS)
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
Features
1. Select the
icon while listening to an FM station.
2. Select Station List.
3. Select the station.
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select the
icon while listening to an FM station.
2. Select Station List.
3. Select Update List.
Continued
289
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
290 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Radio Text.
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Scan.
To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.
Features
290
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
291 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
Audio/Information Screen
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Service Icons
Select
or
to search up
and down the selected band for a
station with a strong signal.
Features
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
Ensemble Icons
Select
or
to tune the frequency.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
* Not available on all models
Continued
291
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
292 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
■ Preset Memory
Stores a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Select the
icon.
3. Select Save Preset.
4. Select the preset number for the station you want to store.
■ Ensemble List
Features
Lists the strongest stations.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Ensemble List.
3. Select the station.
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Ensemble List.
3. Select Update List.
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Scan.
3. Select Scan Ensemble or Scan Service.
To turn off scan, select Cancel Scan.
292
* Not available on all models
1Playing DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel or
select SOURCE on the screen.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 234
You can also switch the mode by selecting Change
Source on the Audio menu screen.
You can store 12 DAB stations into preset memory.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
293 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying DAB (Digital Audio Broadcasting) *
■ Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected DAB station.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Radio Text.
Features
293
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
294 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
Playing a CD
Your audio system supports audio CDs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs in either MP3 or WMA,
or AAC*1 format. With the CD loaded, select the CD mode.
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
Audio/Information Screen
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
Open/Close Icon*2
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Folder Icons
Select
to skip to the next folder, and
to skip to the beginning
of the previous folder in MP3, WMA, or AAC.
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
*2:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
294
(Eject/Close) Button
Press to eject a CD.
Track Icons
Select
or
to change
tracks (files in MP3, WMA, or AAC).
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
295 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a File from the Music Search List (MP3/WMA/
AAC)
1Playing a CD
NOTICE
1. Select the
Search.
icon and select Music
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels. The label can
cause the CD to jam in the unit.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
Folder Selection
2. Select a folder.
If you eject the CD but do not remove it from the slot,
the system reloads the CD automatically after several
seconds.
Features
Text data appears on the display under the following
circumstances:
• When you select a new folder, file, or track.
• When you change the audio mode to CD.
• When you insert a CD.
Track Selection
3. Select a track.
Continued
295
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
296 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a CD
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a track or file.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Features
296
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folders (MP3/WMA/AAC): Provides 10-second
sampling of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of all
tracks on the CD (all files in the current folder in MP3,
WMA, or AAC).
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Repeats all files in
the current folder.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current track/file.
Random in Folder (MP3/WMA/AAC): Plays all files
in the current folder in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all tracks/files in random
order.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
297 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your dock connector to the USB port, then select the iPod
mode.
2 USB Port(s) P. 231
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is
connected.
Audio/Information Screen
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Cover Art
Song Icons
Select
or
to change
songs.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
*1:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
Continued
297
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
298 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1. Select the
Search.
icon and select Music
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle's audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 315
Category Selection
Features
2. Select the items on that menu.
Select USB device change in the Audio menu
screen to switch to another USB device.
Item Selection
298
If you operate the music app on your iPhone/iPod
while the phone is connected to the audio system,
you may no longer be able to operate the same app
on the audio/information screen.
Reconnect the device if necessary.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
299 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a file.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Shuffle/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in
random order.
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in
random order.
Repeat Song: Repeats the current track.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1How to Select a Play Mode
299
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
300 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound and video files on a USB flash drive in
either MP3, WMA, AAC*1, or WAV format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.
2 USB Port(s) P. 231
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive is
connected.
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
Audio/Information Screen
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
Open/Close Icon*2
Displays/hides the detailed
information.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Folder Icons
Select
to skip to the next folder, and
the previous folder.
to skip to the beginning of
*1:Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
*2:Some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
300
Track Icons
Select
or
to change files.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
301 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
1. Select the
icon and select Music
Search.
2. Select Music or Movie.
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 317
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, then
skips to the next file.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 315
Folder Selection
Select USB device change in the Audio menu
screen to switch to another USB device.
Features
3. Select a folder.
Track Selection
4. Select a track.
Continued
301
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
302 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select scan, repeat, and random modes when playing a file.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Scan or Random/Repeat.
3. Select a mode.
Random/Repeat is selected.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select the mode you want to turn off.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Scan
Scan Folder: Provides 10-second sampling of the
first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Track (Scan Movies*1): Provides 10-second
sampling of all files in the current folder.
Random/Repeat
Repeat Folder: Repeats all files in the current folder.
Repeat Tracks (Repeat Movies*1): Repeats the
current file.
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the current
folder in random order.
Random All Tracks (Random All Movies*1): Plays
all files in random order.
When playing a video file:
Play/Pause: Select to resume or play a file.
Stop: Select to stop a file.
*1: When playing a video file
302
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
303 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System.
2 Phone Setup P. 375
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio
system on and off.
Audio/Information Screen
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone is
connected to HFT.
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible.
To check if your phone is compatible, ask a dealer.
It may be illegal to perform some data device
functions while driving.
Only one phone can be used with HFT at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the
volume.
Open/Close Icon*1
Displays/hides the
detailed
information.
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the
menu items.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the
previous display.
Track Icons
Select
or
change tracks.
Play Icon
Pause Icon
Group Icons
Select
or
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
Features
If more than one phone is paired to the HFT system,
there may be a delay before the system begins to
play.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
to
to change group.
*1:Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect, some or all of the lists may not
be displayed.
Continued
303
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
304 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to the system.
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker’s operating
instructions.
2 Phone Setup P. 375
2. Select the Bluetooth® Audio mode.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
If the phone is not recognised, another HFTcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
Features
■ To pause or resume a file
Select the play icon or pause icon.
■ Searching for Music
1Searching for Music
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Music Search.
3. Select a search category (e.g., Albums).
4. Select an item.
u The selection begins playing.
304
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
305 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a Video Using the HDMITM
Playing a Video Using the HDMITM
Your audio system allows you to play videos from an HDMI-compatible device.
Connect the device, using an HDMTM cable, then select the HDMITM mode.
2 HDMITM Port * P. 232
(Power) Button
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Audio/Information Screen
Features
VOL (Volume) Icons
Select to adjust the volume.
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu items.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
* Not available on all models
Continued
305
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
306 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a Video Using the HDMITM
■ Changing the Screen Aspect
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Audio.
4. Select Aspect Adjustment.
5. Select the setting you want.
6. Select OK.
Features
306
1Playing a Video Using the HDMITM
This feature is limited while driving. To play videos,
stop your vehicle and apply the parking brake.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
307 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuOn Board Apps
On Board Apps
Honda Connect has the capability of On Board Apps which may be created by
Honda or by 3rd parties. Apps may be already installed or can be downloaded
through Honda App Center. Some apps require internet access which can be
established by Wi-Fi connection.
2 Wi-Fi Connection P. 311
Please visit the below web address for further information:
https://ivhs.os.ixonos.com/honda/help
1On Board Apps
Make sure the GPS setting is turned on before using
Honda App Center.
2 Customized Features P. 322
Even if you change Background Colour on the
System settings screen, it will not be reflected on
the Honda App Center screen.
Features
Honda App Center icon
Honda App Center provides
access to a variety of App
related services.
• Using the Display Audio system while driving can take your attention away from the road, causing a crash in which you could be
seriously injured or killed. Only operate system controls when the conditions permit you to safely do so. Please always adhere to the
laws of the territory when operating this device.
• Applications on the head unit are subject to change at anytime. This may mean that they are not available or operate differently. Honda
shall not be liable to you in such instances.
• Applications available on the device may be provided by parties other than Honda to which 3rd party software licences and charges may
apply.
• Data usage and roaming charges may result in using applications on the device in conjunction with your mobile phone and Honda is
not liable for any costs you might incur from such use. Honda recommends you consult your mobile phone network provider in advance.
• Downloading applications from the Honda App Center will be subject to Terms and Conditions which can be found at:
https://ivhs.os.ixonos.com/honda/help, and may also incur charges.
307
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
308 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSmartphone Connection
Smartphone Connection
Some of your smartphone apps can be displayed and operated on the audio/
information screen when the phone is connected to the audio system. You can
connect your phone using a cable, or wirelessly.
2 Connecting Your iPhone P. 310
2 Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time) P. 311
1Smartphone Connection
Park in a safe place before connecting your phone
and while operating the displayed apps.
Not all phones are compatible with the system. The
system does not display all the available apps on your
smartphone, and some apps need to be preinstalled.
Ask a dealer for details.
Features
You need to switch the Bluetooth® connection to
your smartphone if another electronic device is
connected.
2 To change the currently paired phone
P. 376
The following may vary by phone type:
• How to connect a smartphone to the system.
• Apps that can be operated on the screen.
• Display response time/update time
We do not support every app operation on the audio
system.
Ask the app provider for any queries on the app’s
features.
Do not get drawn into the display while operating a
vehicle.
308
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
309 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSmartphone Connection
To use smartphone connection, you need to first pair your smartphone to the audio
system via Bluetooth®.
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Microphone
Audio/Information Screen
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous display.
(Not available on all phones.)
(Menu) Icon
Select to display the menu on the app you selected.
(Not available on all apps.)
Features
(Home) Icon
Select to go back to
the home screen or
to a previous
display.
Arrow
Appears when the
phone is connected to
the system. Select to
display available apps.
Continued
309
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
310 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSmartphone Connection
■ Connecting Your iPhone
1Connecting Your iPhone
1. Connect your phone to the audio system
via Bluetooth®.
Make sure to plug in the digital AV adapter to the
HDMITM jack first. If not, smartphone connection may
not work properly.
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Features
USB Cable
HDMITM Cable
Digital AV Adapter
310
2. Plug in the digital AV adapter to the
HDMITM jack.
3. Connect the digital AV adapter to your
iPhone.
u Wait until an arrow appears on the home
screen.
4. Select the arrow to display the available
smartphone apps on the audio/information
screen.
u You may need to operate from the
phone.
5. Select an app you want to operate from the
audio/information screen.
u To go back to the previous screen, select
the
icon.
To recharge your phone, connect it to the USB jack,
too.
Contact a dealer for the digital AV adapter or HDMITM
cable purchasing information.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
311 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuWi-Fi Connection
Wi-Fi Connection
You can connect the display audio system to the Internet using Wi-Fi and browse
websites or use online services on the audio/information screen. If your phone has
mobile hotspot capabilities, the system can be tethered to the phone. Go through
the following steps for a setup.
■ Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
1Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
Continued
You cannot go through the setting procedure while a
vehicle is moving. Park in a safe place to set the audio
system in Wi-Fi mode.
Some telecom carriers charge for tethering. Check
your phone’s subscribed package.
Check your phone manual to find out if the phone
has Wi-Fi connectivity.
Features
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Bluetooth / Wi-Fi.
4. Select the Wi-Fi tab.
5. Select Wi-Fi On/Off Status, then On.
6. Select Wi-Fi Device List.
u Make sure your phone’s Wi-Fi setting is
in access point (tethering) mode.
u Select the phone you want to connect to
the system.
u If you do not find the phone you want to
connect in the list, select Scan.
You can confirm whether Wi-Fi connection is on or
off with the
icon on Wi-Fi Device list.
Transmission speed and others will not be displayed
on this screen.
311
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
312 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuWi-Fi Connection
7. Select Connect.
u Enter a password for your phone, and
select Done.
u If you cannot enter the password on the
displayed keyboard, change the
keyboard to the one in which you can
enter from the Android setting.
2 Customized Features P. 322
u When the connection is successful, the
icon is displayed on the list.
8. Select the
icon to go back to the home
screen.
Features
312
■ Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)
Make sure your phone's Wi-Fi setting is in access point (tethering) mode.
1Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
If you cannot enter the password on the displayed
keyboard, change the keyboard to the one in which
you can enter from the following order:
Settings Android Language & input select
next to Android keyboard Input
language uncheck the box next to Use system
language select the keyboard languages that you
can enter.
1Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)
iPhone users
You may need to go through an initial setup for WiFi connection again after you boot your phone.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
313 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSiri Eyes Free
Siri Eyes Free
You can talk to Siri using the
(Talk) button on the steering wheel when your
iPhone is paired to the Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System.
1Siri Eyes Free
Siri is a trademark of Apple Inc.
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Check Apple Inc. website for features available for
Siri.
We recommend against using Siri other than in Siri
Eyes Free while operating a vehicle.
■ Using Siri Eyes Free
1Using Siri Eyes Free
Some commands work only on specific phone
features or apps.
Appears
when Siri is
activated in
Siri Eyes Free
Features
(Hang-up/back) Button
Press to deactivate Siri.
While in Siri Eyes Free:
The display remains the same. No
feedback or commands appears.
(Talk) Button
Press and hold until the display changes as shown.
313
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
314 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Audio Error Messages
CD Player
If a disc error occurs, you may see the following error messages.
Error Message
Unplayable file
Unplayable File*2
Cause
*1
Track/file format not supported
Features
Bad disc
Please check owners manual
Push eject*1
Bad Disc
Please Check Owner’s
Mechanical error
Manual
Push Eject*2
Current track/file will be skipped. The next supported track/file
plays automatically.
●
Press the
(eject) button and remove the disc, and check that the
error message is cleared.
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed, and insert the
disc again.
●
2 Protecting CDs P. 318
●
●
Bad disc
Please check owners
manual*1
Bad Disc
Please Check Owner’s
Manual*2
Servo error
Check disc*1
Check Disc*2
Disc error
Heat error
Heat Error*2
High temperature
*1
314
●
●
Mechanical error*1
Mecha Error*2
*1:Colour audio system
*2:Display audio system
Solution
●
If the error message reappears, press the
button, and pull out
the disc.
Insert a different disc.
If the new disc plays, there is a problem with the first disc.
If the error message repeats, or the disc cannot be removed,
contact a dealer.
Do not try to force the disc out of the player.
Check that the disc is not damaged or deformed.
2 Protecting CDs P. 318
●
Turn the audio system off and allow the player to cool down until
the error message is cleared.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
315 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio Error MessagesuiPod/USB Flash Drive
iPod/USB Flash Drive
If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Solution
Appears when there is a problem with the USB adapter unit. Check if the device is compatible
with the USB adapter unit.
Incompatible USB device*1
Incompatible USB Device
Please Check Owner’s Manual*2
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn the
audio system off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the error.
Unsupported version*1
Unsupported Version*2
Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported iPod is
connected, update the iPod software to the newer version.
Retry connection*1
Connect Retry*2
Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable file*1
Unplayable File*2
Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This error
message appears for about three seconds, then plays the next song.
Features
USB error*1
USB Error*2
iPod and USB flash drive
Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
No data*1
No song*1
No Data*2
iPod
Appears when the iPod is empty.
USB flash drive
Appears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in the
USB flash drive.
Unsupported
Appears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported device is
connected, reconnect the device.
*1:Colour audio system
*2:Display audio system
315
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
316 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuAudio Error MessagesuAndroid/Apps
Models with display audio system
Android/Apps
If an error occurs while using the audio system or apps, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Unfortunately, **** has
stopped.*1
Solution
Error has occurred within app, select OK on the screen to close the app. Unless it is a fatal error, it would
return to normal if you startup the app.
If it does not return to normal even after starting up the app, press and hold the
(power) button to
perform the forced reset. If it still does not get back to normal, you need Factory Data Reset.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 347
Features
**** is not responding.
Would you like to close
it?*1
App is in a busy state.
Select Wait if you can wait for a response from app a little longer. If it does not respond even if you keep
waiting, select OK to close the app and start it up. When it does not return to normal, press and hold the
(power) button to perform the forced reset. You also need Factory Data Reset.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 347
Security warning
Occurs if you open the browser when the system date is older than the certificate date information. It also
occurs when you are in the area where GPS reception is unavailable or GPS setting of the Android setting
is turned off.
● Turn on GPS setting of the Android setting.
● Move to the area where GPS reception is available.
2 Customized Features P. 322
*1:****part is variable characters, and will change depending upon where an error
occurs.
316
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
317 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
General Information on the Audio System
Recommended CDs
• Use only high-quality CD-R or CD-RW discs labelled for audio use.
• Use only CD-R or CD-RW discs on which the recordings are closed.
• Play only standard round-shaped CDs.
1Recommended CDs
A Dual-disc cannot play on this audio unit. If recorded
under certain conditions, a CD-R or CD-RW may not
play either.
The CD packages or jackets should have one of these marks.
■ CDs with MP3, WMA, or AAC files
Features
• Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
• Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
Continued
317
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
318 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuRecommended CDs
■ Protecting CDs
Follow these precautions when handling or storing CDs:
• Store a CD in its case when it is not being played.
• When wiping a CD, use a soft clean cloth from the centre to the outside edge.
• Handle a CD by its edge. Never touch either surface.
• Never insert foreign objects into the CD player.
• Keep CDs out of direct sunlight and extreme heat.
• Do not place stabilizer rings or labels on the CD.
• Avoid fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tip pens on the CD.
1Protecting CDs
NOTICE
Do not insert a damaged CD. It may be stuck inside
and damage the audio unit.
Examples:
●
Bubbled, wrinkled, labelled, and
excessively thick CDs
Bubbled/
Wrinkled
Features
●
●
Using
Printer Label
Kit
Sealed
With Plastic Ring
● Poor quality
Damaged CDs
CDs
Chipped/
Cracked
Small CDs
8-cm
(3-inch)
CD
318
With Label/
Sticker
Warped
Burrs
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
319 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuCompatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
Compatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
■ iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
1iPod and iPhone Model Compatibility
This system may not work with all software versions
of these devices.
Features
Model
iPod (5th generation)
iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)
iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)
iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)
iPod nano (1st to 6th generation) launch in 2010
iPod nano (7th generation) launch in 2012
iPod touch (1st to 4th generation) launch in 2010
iPod touch (5th generation) launch in 2012
iPhone 3G/iPhone 3GS/iPhone 4/iPhone 4s/iPhone 5/iPhone 5s*1/iPhone 5c*1
*1:Display audio system
■ USB Flash Drives
•
•
•
•
•
1USB Flash Drives
Use a recommended USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher.
Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, AAC, or WAV * formats may be unsupported.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored
order. This order may be different from the order
displayed on your PC or device.
319
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
320 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuCompatible iPod, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
Models with display audio system
■ Recommended Devices
Media
USB Flash Drive
Profile (MP4 version)
Baseline Level 3 (MPEG4-AVC), Simple Level 5 (MPEG4)
.mp4/.m4v
File extension (MP4 version)
Compatible audio codec
MPEG4-AVC (H.264)
MPEG4 (ISO/IEC 14496 Part.2)
Bit rate
10 Mbps (MPEG4-AVC)
8 Mbps (MPEG4)
Maximum image
Features
320
720 X 576 pixels
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
321 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuAbout Open Source Licences
Models with display audio system
About Open Source Licences
To see the open source licence information, follow these steps.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Android.
4. Select About device.
5. Select Legal information.
6. Select Open source licences.
1About Open Source Licences
You can also go to step 4 when you:
• Swipe down from the top.
u Select
appears on the screen.
• Select , then select Settings on the App tab.
Features
321
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
322 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Customized Features
Models with colour audio system
1Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
Continuously variable transmission models
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the ignition switch in ON (w *1, press the
MENU/CLOCK button, then select Settings. To customize the phone settings,
press the
button, then select Phone setup.
• Shift to (P .
Manual transmission models
• Set the parking brake.
1How to customize
Audio/Information Screen
Features
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
To customize other features, select Settings, rotate
, then press
.
2 List of customizable options P. 327
(Phone) Button
MENU/CLOCK Button
Selector Knob
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
322
When you customize settings:
• Make sure that the vehicle is at a complete stop.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
323 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ Customization Flow
Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
Adjust clock
BAS
Sound
TRE
FAD
BAL
SVC
Normal play
Features
Play mode
*1, *2
Repeat one folder
Repeat one track
Random in folder
Random all
Shuffle albums
Shuffle
Scan folders
Scan tracks
Scan*3
*1: The items of play mode depend on audio modes.
*2: CD/iPod/USB mode
*3: AM/FM/DAB * mode
* Not available on all models
Continued
323
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
324 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Settings
RDS settings
Radio text
AF
REG
News*1
DAB settings *
Radio text
DAB-Link
Features
FM-Link
Band select
Bluetooth
Add new device
Connect an audio device
Display adjustment
Brightness
Contrast
Black level
*1: Except AM/FM/DAB * mode
324
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
325 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Display change
Audio
Wallpaper
Wallpaper
Select
Import
Delete
Features
Colour theme
Blue
Red
Amber
Grey
Language
Clock format
12h
24h
Continued
325
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
326 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Press the
button and rotate
to select Phone setup, then press
Bluetooth setup
.
Add new device
Connect a phone
Connect an audio device
Disconnect all devices
Delete device
Pass-key
Features
Speed dial
Ringtone
Fixed
Mobile phone
Caller ID info
Name priority
Number priority
System clear
326
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
327 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Adjusts Clock.
Adjust clock
Sound
Description
2 Clock P. 146
BAS
TRE
FAD
BAL
SVC
Adjusts the settings of the audio speaker’s sound.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 242
Selectable Settings
—
—
Features
Continued
327
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
328 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Normal play
CD/USB mode
Repeat one folder
CD/iPod/USB mode
Repeat one track
CD/USB mode
Random in folder
CD/USB mode
Play mode
Random all
Features
iPod mode
Selects a play mode
2 How to Select a Play Mode P. 258, 261, 264
—
Shuffle albums
iPod mode
Shuffle
CD/USB mode
Scan folders
CD/USB mode
Scan tracks
AM/FM/DAB * mode
Scan
328
* Not available on all models
Selects the scan mode.
2 Scan P. 251, 255
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
329 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
RDS
settings
Radio text
AF
REG
Except AM/FM/DAB * mode
News
Radio text
DAB-Link
DAB
settings *
Band select
Add new device
Bluetooth
Turns on and off the radio text information.
Turns on and off Alternative Frequency (AF).
Turns on and off Regional Programme (REG).
Turns on and off to automatically to tune to the news
programme.
Turns on and off the radio text information.
Selects whether the system automatically searches for
the same station from Ensembles, and switches to it.
Selects whether the system finds the same station from
an FM band, and automatically switches the band.
Selects specific bands to reduce the time to update the
lists, and search for a station.
Pairs a new phone to HFT, edits and deletes a paired
phone, and create a code for a paired phone.
Selectable Settings
On/Off*1
On*1/Off
On*1/Off
On/Off*1
On/Off*1
On*1/Off
On*1/Off
Both*1/BandIII/L-Band
Features
Settings
FM-Link
Description
—
2 Phone Setup P. 354
Connect an audio
device
Brightness
Display
Contrast
adjustment
Black level
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth® Audio
device to HFT.
Changes the brightness of the audio/information
screen.
Changes the contrast of the audio/information screen.
Changes the black level of the audio/information
screen.
—
—
—
—
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
329
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
330 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Display change
Select
Wallpaper
Import
Delete
Settings
Colour theme
Features
Language
Clock format
*1:Default Setting
330
Description
Changes the display type.
Changes the wallpaper type.
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 240
Selectable Settings
Audio*1/Wallpaper
Clock*1/Image 1/Image 2/
Image 3
—
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Image 1*1/Image 2/Image 3
Changes the background colour of the audio/
Blue*1/Red/Amber/Grey
information screen.
English*1: See other
Changes the display language.
selectable languages on the
screen.
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to
12h*1/24h
24H.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
331 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Add new device
Bluetooth
setup
Phone
setup
Ringtone
Caller ID info
System clear
Pairs a new phone to HFT.
2 Phone Setup P. 354
Pairs a new phone or connects a paired phone
to HFT.
Selectable Settings
—
—
2 Phone Setup P. 354
Connect an audio device
Disconnect all devices
Delete device
Pass-key
Connects a Bluetooth® Audio device to HFT.
Disconnects a paired phone from HFT.
Deletes a paired phone.
Inputs and changes a code for a paired phone.
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
2 Speed Dial P. 361
—
—
—
—
—
Selects the ring tone.
Fixed/Mobile phone*1
Prioritizes the caller’s name or phone number Name priority*1/Number
as the caller ID.
priority
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
—
Phone setup group as default.
Features
Speed dial
Connect a phone
Description
*1:Default Setting
Continued
331
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
332 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Models with display audio system
1Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, select Settings, then select a setting item.
When you customize settings, make sure that the
vehicle is at a complete stop and shift to (P .
To customize other features, select Settings.
2 List of customizable options P. 337
If you press and hold the
(power) button when
resetting the system, it may restore the customized
value to its default value depending on the setting
items.
Features
Audio/Information
Screen
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
332
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
333 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ Customization flow
Select the
icon.
HOME
Select Settings.
Display
Sound/Beep
Voice Recog.
System
Others
*1: Does not appear when you change the
screen interface design.
*2: Appears only when you change the
screen interface design.
Voice Prompt
Clock/Wallpaper Type*1/Clock
Type*2
Clock
Wallpaper
Clock Adjustment
Time Zone
Clock Format
Daylight Saving
Clock Display
Clock Location
Clock Reset
Language
Remember Last Screen*1
Memory Refresh
Refresh Time Adjustment
Skin Change
Factory Data Reset
Features
Clock
Home icon position
Menu icon position*2
Display Settings
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Background Colour*1
Volume
Beep
Default
Continued
333
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
334 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Audio
Sound
BAS-TRE
FAD-BAL
SVC
Source Popup
Cover Art
Display
Adjustment
Display
Colour
Features
Aspect Adjustment
Connect Audio
Bluetooth Device List
RDS Settings
DAB Settings *
Default
Info
Clock
Clock/Wallpaper Type
Clock Adjustment
Time Zone
Clock Format
Daylight Saving
Clock Reset
Clock Display
Clock Location
Other
Default
334
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Colour
Tint
* Not available on all models
Info Screen Preference
Clock
Wallpaper
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
335 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Phone
Connect Phone
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Speed Dial
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
Default
Camera *
Rear Camera
Fixed Guideline
Features
Dynamic Guideline
Default
Bluetooth / Wi-Fi
Bluetooth
Bluetooth On/Off Status
Bluetooth Device List
Edit Pairing Code
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi On/Off Status
Wi-Fi Device List
Wi-Fi Device Information
Default
* Not available on all models
Continued
335
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
336 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Android
Wi-Fi
Bluetooth
Data usage
More…
Sound
Display
Storage
Features
Apps
Accounts & sync
Location services
Security
Language & input
Backup & reset
Date & time
Accessibility
About device
336
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
337 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Home icon position
HOME
Changes the home screen icon layout.
—
Brightness
Changes the brightness of the audio/information
screen.
—
Contrast
Changes the contrast of the audio/information screen.
—
Black Level
Changes the black level of the audio/information
screen.
—
Menu icon position*3
Display
Settings
Display
Background Colour*2
Sound/
Beep
Voice
Recog.
Volume
Changes the background colour of the audio/
information screen.
Blue*1/Amber/Red/
Violet
Changes the sound volume.
Adjusts the guidance volume of the navigation system.
0~6*1~11
Features
System
() Refer to the Navigation System Manual
Beep
Changes the beep volume.
Off/1/2*1/3
Voice Prompt
Turns the voice prompt on and off.
On*1/Off
*1:Default Setting
*2:Does not appear when you change the screen interface design.
*3:Appears only when you change the screen interface design.
Continued
337
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
338 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Clock
Clock/
Wallpaper*2/
Clock Type*3
Description
Changes the clock display type.
●
Wallpaper
●
●
Clock Adjustment
Features
System
Clock
Changes the wallpaper type.
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Analog/Digital*1/
Small Digital/Off
Galaxy*1/Metallic/
Blank
Adjusts clock.
—
2 Adjusting the Clock P. 146
Time Zone
Changes the time zones.
WET/GMT*1
Clock Format
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H.
12H*1/24H
Daylight Saving
Adjusts the clock automatically when a summer
time change occurs.
On*1/Off
Clock Display
Selects whether the clock display comes on.
On*1/Off
Clock Location
Changes the clock display layout.
Upper right*1/Upper
left/Lower right/
Lower left
Clock Reset
Resets the clock settings to the factory default.
*1:Default Setting
*2:Does not appear when you change the screen interface design.
*3:Appears only when you change the screen interface design.
338
Selectable Settings
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
339 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Others
Changes the display language.
English (United Kingdom)*1:
See other selectable languages on
the screen.
Remember Last
Screen*2
Selects whether the device remembers the last
screen.
On/Off*1
Memory Refresh
Turns on the audio system automatically and
restores the fragmentation of a memory when the
ignition switch is LOCK (0 *3.
On*1/Off
Refresh Time
Adjustment
Sets the time for Memory Refresh.
00:00~02:00*1~23:59
Skin Change
Changes the screen interface design.
Factory Data
Reset
Resets all the settings to their factory default.
Sound
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 347
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the System
settings group as default.
Adjusts the settings of the audio speakers’ sound.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 284
Features
Audio
Selectable Settings
Language
System
Default
Description
—
Yes/No
Yes/No
-6 ~ 0*1 ~ +6 (BASS and TREBLE),
RR9~0*1~FR9 (FADER), L9~0*1~R9
(BALANCE), Off/Low/Mid*1/High
(Speed Volume Compensation)
*1:Default Setting
*2:Does not appear when you change the screen interface design.
*3:Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
339
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
340 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Source Popup
CD, iPod, USB mode
Cover Art
Description
Selectable Settings
Selects whether the list of selectable audio
sources comes on when Audio is selected on
the home screen.
On/Off*1
Turns the cover art display on and off.
On*1/Off
Brightness
Display
Features
Display
Adjustment
Colour
Changes the colour of the audio/information
screen.
—
Tint
Changes the tint of the audio/information
screen.
—
Colour
USB, HDMITM mode
Aspect Adjustment
Bluetooth® Audio mode
Connect Audio
Bluetooth® Audio mode
Bluetooth Device List
*1:Default Setting
340
See System on P. 337
Black Level
USB, HDMITM mode
Audio
Contrast
Selects the display mode with a different
aspect ratio from Original (only USB),
Normal, Full and Zoom.
Connects, disconnects or pairs a Bluetooth®
Audio device to HFT.
Pairs a new phone to HFT, edits or deletes a
paired phone.
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Original (only USB)/
Normal/Full*1/Zoom
—
—
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
341 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
RDS Settings
Turns on and off the traffic information.
On/Off*1
News
Turns on and off to automatically to tune to the news
programme.
On/Off*1
REG
Turns on and off to keep the same stations within that
region even if the signal gets weak.
On*1/Off
AF
Turns on and off to automatically change the
frequency of the same programme as you enter
different regions.
On*1/Off
DAB-DAB Link
Selects whether the system automatically searches for
the same station from Ensembles, and switches to it.
On*1/Off
DAB-FM Link
Selects whether the system finds the same station from
an FM band, and automatically switches the band.
On*1/Off
Band select
Selects specific bands to reduce the time to update the
lists, and search for a station.
BOTH*1/BANDIII/LBAND
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Audio
settings group as default.
Yes/No
Features
Default
Selectable Settings
TA-Information
Audio
DAB Settings *
Description
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
341
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
342 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Clock/
Wallpaper
Type
Description
Selectable Settings
Clock
Wallpaper
Clock Adjustment
Time Zone
Clock
Clock Format
See System on P. 338
Features
Daylight Saving
Info
Clock Reset
Clock Display
Clock Location
Other
Default
*1:Default Setting
342
Info Screen Preference
Changes the information screen type.
Info Top/Info Menu/
Off*1
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Info
settings group as default.
Yes/No
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
343 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Connect Phone
Description
Selectable Settings
Pairs a new phone to HFT, connects or disconnects a
paired phone.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Bluetooth Device List
Pairs a new phone to HFT, edits or deletes a paired
phone.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Phone
Edit Speed Dial
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
—
2 Speed Dial P. 381
Selects the ring tone.
Fixed/Mobile phone*1
Automatic Phone Sync
Sets phonebook and call history data to be
automatically imported when a phone is paired to
HFT.
On/Off
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Phone
settings group as default.
Yes/No
Features
Ring Tone
*1:Default Setting
Continued
343
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
344 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Fixed Guideline
Description
Selects whether the fixed guidelines come on the
rear camera monitor.
Selectable Settings
On*1/Off
2 Multi-View Rear Camera * P. 477
Camera *
Rear
Camera
Dynamic Guideline
Selects whether the dynamic guidelines come on
the rear camera monitor.
On*1/Off
*
2 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 477
Features
Bluetooth
Default
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the Rear
Camera setting group as default.
Yes/No
Bluetooth On/Off Status
Selects to display the Bluetooth® status.
On*1/Off
Bluetooth Device List
Pairs a new phone to HFT, edits or deletes a
paired phone, or creates a security PIN.
Edit Pairing Code
Bluetooth /
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi
Default
*1:Default Setting
344
* Not available on all models
—
2 Phone Setup P. 375
Edits a pairing code.
2 To change the pairing code setting P. 376
Random/Fixed*1
On*1/Off
Wi-Fi On/Off Status
Changes the Wi-Fi mode.
Wi-Fi Device List
Connects, disconnects, or deletes the Wi-Fi
device.
—
Wi-Fi Device Information
Shows the Wi-Fi information of the device.
—
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
Bluetooth / Wi-Fi settings group as default.
Yes/No
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
345 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Description
Selectable Settings
Wi-Fi
Shows the status of the Wi-Fi connection (On/Off) and adds new
Wi-Fi networks.
On*1/Off
Bluetooth
Shows the status of the Bluetooth® connection (On/Off) and
adds new Bluetooth® devices.
On*1/Off
Data usage
Shows the data usage of the system.
—
More…
Adds VPN (Virtual Private Network).
—
Sound
Adjusts the alarm volume and selects the favourite sound.
—
Display
Sets up the wallpaper and changes the font size.
—
Storage
Shows the storage capacity of the system and the USB capacity.
—
Apps
Shows the status of the installed apps.
—
Accounts & sync
Adds the additional account information.
—
Location services
Turn on/off the GPS setting before using apps.
—
Security
Shows the security status of the system.
—
Language & input
Changes the display language of the system and the input
keyboard.
—
Backup & reset
Resets the system.
—
Date & time
Changes the date, the time zones, and the clock format.
—
Features
Android
Customizable Features
*1:Default Setting
Continued
345
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
346 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Accessibility
Changes the display font of the system and the voice guidance of
the password.
—
About device
Shows the status of the system, the Android version, the legal
information, and so on.
—
Android
Features
346
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
347 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCustomized FeaturesuDefaulting All the Settings
Defaulting All the Settings
Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select the Others tab.
5. Select Factory Data Reset.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen.
6. Select Yes to reset the settings.
7. Select Yes again to reset the settings.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select OK.
1Defaulting All the Settings
When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset
all settings to default and delete all personal data.
If you perform Factory Data Reset, it will reset the
preinstalled apps to their factory default.
Features
347
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
348 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Hands-Free Telephone System
Models with colour audio system
1Hands-Free Telephone System
The Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System allows you to place and receive phone calls
using your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your mobile phone.
Using HFT
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system’s
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
■ HFT Buttons
Volume up
Volume down
Microphone
Features
(Phone) Button
(Hang-up) Button
(Pick-up) Button
If you receive a call while using the audio system, the
system resumes its operation after ending the call.
Up to 20 speed dial entries can be stored. If there is
no entry in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 361
Selector Knob
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up) button: Press to end a call.
(Phone) button: Press to go directly to the Phone screen.
LIST/SELECT (Selector): Rotate
to select an item on the screen, then press
348
To use HFT, you need a Bluetooth-compatible mobile
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities, ask a
dealer or your local Honda.
Up to 20 call histories can be stored. If there is no call
history, Call History is disabled.
.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
349 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuUsing HFT
■ HFT Status Display
Battery Level Status
1Hands-Free Telephone System
The audio/information screen notifies you
when there is an incoming call.
Signal Strength
Roam Status
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFT.
HFT Mode
Call Name
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
licence. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFT Limitations
An incoming call on HFT will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
Features
See the following URLs for Declaration of conformity
(DoC) of Hands Free Telephone:
http://www.ptc.panasonic.eu/
1HFT Status Display
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a greyed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
You can change the system language.
2 Customized Features P. 322
349
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
350 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
HFT Menus
The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w *1 to use HFT.
1HFT Menus
To use HFT, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible mobile phone to the system while the
vehicle is parked.
or
Phone
Speed dial*2
Add new
Some functions are limited while driving.
Features
(Existing entry list)
Call history*2
Call history
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to
store as a speed dial number.
Phone number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Dialed calls
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Received calls
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
Missed calls
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Phonebook*2
Display the paired phones’s phonebook.
Dial*2
Enter a phone number to dial.
*1 : Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
*2 : Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.
350
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
351 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
Redial*1
Phone setup
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Bluetooth setup
Pair a phone to the system.
Connect a phone
Connect a phone to the system.
Connect an audio device
Connect a Bluetooth® Audio device to the
system.
Disconnect all devices
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
Delete device
Delete a previously paired phone.
Pass-key
Create a code for a paired phone.
Features
Add new device
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.
Continued
351
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
352 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
Speed dial*1
Add new
Call history
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Phone number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Features
Existing entry list
Change speed dial
Delete speed dial
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to the system.
352
Select a phone number from the call history
to store as a speed dial number.
Change a previously stored speed dial
number.
Delete a previously stored speed dial number.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
353 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
Ringtone
Caller ID info
Select the ring tone stored in HFT.
Mobile phone
Select the ring tone stored in the connected
mobile phone.
Name priority
Prioritize the caller’s name as the caller ID.
Number priority
Prioritize the caller’s phone number as the
caller ID.
Features
System clear
Fixed
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries,
and security codes.
Continued
353
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
354 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a mobile phone (No phone has
Features
been paired to the system)
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFT automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone doesn’t appear, select
Phone not found? and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, select Honda HFT.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. A notification appears on the screen if
pairing is successful.
354
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
the system before you can make and receive handsfree calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
connected to HFT.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFT.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
355 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To Change the currently paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth setup, then
press .
Features
4. Rotate
to select Connect a phone,
then press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
5. Rotate
to select a desired device name,
then press .
u The system disconnects the connected
phone and starts searching for another
paired phone.
Continued
355
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
356 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth setup, then
press .
4. Rotate
.
to select Pass-key, then press
Features
5. Input a new pairing code, then press
356
.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
357 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth setup, then
press .
Features
4. Rotate
to select Delete device, then
press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
5. Rotate
to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
6. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
Continued
357
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
358 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Ringtone, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Fixed or Mobile
phone, then press .
Features
358
■ Caller’s ID Information
You can select a caller’s information to be displayed when you have an incoming
call.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Caller ID info, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select a mode you want, then
press .
1Ring Tone
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.
Mobile phone: The ring tone stored in the
connected mobile phone sounds from the speakers.
1Caller’s ID Information
Name priority: A caller’s name is displayed if it is
stored in the phonebook.
Number priority: A caller’s phone number is
displayed.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
359 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To Clear the System
Pairing codes, paired phones, all speed dial entries, all call history data, and all
imported phonebook data are erased.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select System clear, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
Features
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
6. A notification appears on the screen. Press
.
Continued
359
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
360 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History
When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are
automatically imported to the system.
1Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History
When you select a person from the list in the mobile
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Pref
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
Work
Features
Pager
If a name has four or more numbers, ... appears
instead of category icons.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to the system.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
360
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
361 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Continued
You can use the audio preset buttons during a call to
store a speed dial number:
1. Press and hold the desired audio preset button
during a call.
2. The contact information for the active call will be
stored for the corresponding speed dial.
Features
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Add new, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
From Call history:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Phonebook:
u Select a number from the connected
mobile phone’s imported phonebook.
From Phone number:
u Input the number manually.
361
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
362 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
Features
362
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change speed dial,
then press .
6. Select a new speed dial number, then press
.
■ To delete a speed dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete speed dial,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
363 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Making a Call
1Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.
The maximum range between your phone and
vehicles is 10 metres (30 feet).
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Features
Continued
363
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
364 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
Features
phonebook
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook are automatically imported to the
system.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phonebook, then
press .
3. The phonebook is stored alphabetically.
Rotate
to select the initial, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a name, then press .
5. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Dial, then press .
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select
, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
364
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
365 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1To make a call using redial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Redial, then press
u Dialing starts automatically.
.
■ To make a call using the call history
Continued
1To make a call using the call history
The call history appears only when a phone is
connected to the system, and displays the last 20
dialed, received, or missed calls.
Features
Call history is stored by Dialed calls,
Received calls, and Missed calls.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Call history, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Dialed calls, Received
calls, or Missed calls, then press .
4. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Press and hold the
button to redial the last
number dialed in your phone’s call history.
365
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
366 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Features
366
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
On the Phone screen, the first six speed dials on the
list can be directly selected by pressing the
corresponding audio preset buttons (1-6).
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
367 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Receiving a Call
HFT Mode
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds and the Incoming call
screen appears.
Press the
Press the
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the call.
Caller’s Name
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold
to answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
Continued
Features
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons. Rotate
to select the icon, then press
.
367
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
368 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone Systemu
■ Options During a Call
Features
368
The following options are available during a call.
Swap call: Put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer call: Transfer a call from the system to your phone.
Dial tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven
phone system.
1. To view the available options, press the
button.
2. Rotate
to select the option, then press
.
u The check box is checked when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
1Options During a Call
Dial tones: Available on some phones.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
369 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuUsing HFT
Models with display audio system
1Hands-Free Telephone System
The Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System allows you to place and receive phone calls
using your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your mobile phone.
Using HFT
To use the system, the Bluetooth On/Off Status
setting must be On.
2 Customized Features P. 322
■ HFT Buttons
Button
SOURCE Button
Volume up
To use HFT, you need a Bluetooth-compatible mobile
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities, ask a
dealer or your local Honda.
(Menu) Button
Microphone
Features
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
• Press the
button when you want to call a
number using a stored voice tag. Speak clearly and
naturally after a beep.
• If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, select the audio
system's VOL (Volume) or use the remote audio
controls on the steering wheel.
Volume down
Up to five speed dial entries can be displayed among
a total of 20 that can be entered. If there is no entry
in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 381
(Talk) Button
(Hang-up/Back) Button
(Pick-up) Button
Up to five call histories can be displayed among a
total of 20 that can be entered. If there is no call
history, Call History is disabled.
Continued
369
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
370 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuUsing HFT
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the phone screen, or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/back) button: Press to end a call, go back to the previous
command, or cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.
(Menu) button: Press to display Speed Dial, Call History, or Redial on the
phone screen.
button: Press to select an item displayed on the phone screen.
SOURCE button: Press to call a number listed in the selected item on the phone
screen.
Features
370
To go to the Phone Menu screen:
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Phone to switch the display to the phone screen.
3. Select the
icon.
1Hands-Free Telephone System
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
licence. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFT Limitations
An incoming call on HFT will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
371 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuUsing HFT
■ HFT Status Display
1HFT Status Display
The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.
Bluetooth Indicator
Battery Level Status
Appears when your phone is
connected to HFT.
HFT Mode
Caller’s Name
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
You can change the system language.
2 Customized Features P. 322
Roaming Status
Signal Strength
Caller’s Number
Features
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a greyed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries with voice tags, phonebook names, or
numbers can be called using voice commands while the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 381
371
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
372 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
HFT Menus
The ignition switch must be in ACCESSORY (q or ON (w *1 to use the system.
1HFT Menus
To use HFT, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible mobile phone to the system while the
vehicle is parked.
■ Phone settings screen
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Phone.
Some functions are limited while driving.
Features
Phone
Connect Phone
(Existing entry list)
Add Bluetooth Device
Disconnect
Bluetooth Device List
(Existing entry list)
Add Bluetooth Device
Connect a paired phone to the system.
Pair a new phone to the system.
Disconnect a paired phone from the system.
Edit Device Name
Edit a paired phone name.
Delete This Device
Delete a paired phone.
Pair a new phone to the system.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
372
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
373 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
Edit Speed Dial
(Existing entry list)
Edit
Edit a previously stored speed dial number.
●
●
●
Delete
New Entry
Ring Tone
Automatic Phone Sync
Default
Delete a previously stored speed dial number.
Enter a phone number to store as a speed
dial number.
Import from Call History
Select a phone number from the call history
to store as a speed dial number.
Import from Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Features
Delete All
Manual Input
Change a name.
Change a number.
Create or delete a voice tag.
Delete all of the previously stored speed dial number.
Select the ring tone.
Set phonebook and call history data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to HFT.
Cancel/Reset all customized items in the Phone settings group as default.
Continued
373
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
374 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Phone Menu screen
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Phone.
3. Select the
icon.
Speed Dial
Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
(Existing entry list)
Features
New Entry
Manual Input
Import from Call History
Import from Phonebook
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Redial
Redial the last number dialed.
Dial
Enter a phone number to dial.
Call History
All
Display the last outgoing, incoming and missed calls.
Dialed
Display the last outgoing calls.
Received
Display the last incoming calls.
Missed
374
Enter a phone number to store as a speed
dial number.
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Display the last missed calls.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
375 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a mobile phone (when there is
Continued
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone's battery may drain faster when it is
paired to the system.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and returns to idle.
Features
no phone paired to the system)
1. Select Phone.
2. Select Yes.
3. Make sure your phone is search or
discoverable mode, then select Continue.
u HFT automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
4. Select your phone when it appears on the
list.
u If your phone does not appear, you can
select Refresh to search again.
u If your phone still does not appear, select
Phone not Found and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, search for Honda
HFT.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
the system before you can make and receive handsfree calls.
375
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
376 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To change the currently paired phone
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Connect Phone.
3. Select a phone to connect.
u HFT disconnects the connected phone
and starts searching for another paired
phone.
■ To change the pairing code setting
Features
1. Select the
icon.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Bluetooth / Wi-Fi.
4. Select the Bluetooth tab.
5. Select Edit Pairing Code.
6. Select Random or Fixed.
376
1To change the currently paired phone
If no other phones are found or paired when trying to
switch to another phone, HFT will inform you that the
original phone is connected again.
To pair other phones, select Add Bluetooth Device
from the Connect Phone screen.
1To change the pairing code setting
The default pairing code is 0000 until you change the
setting.
To create your own, select Fixed, and delete the
current code, then enter a new one.
For a randomly generated pairing code each time you
pair a phone, select Random.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
377 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To edit an already-paired phone name
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Bluetooth Device List.
3. Select a paired phone you want to edit.
Features
4. Select Edit Device Name.
5. Edit the name and select OK.
Continued
377
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
378 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Bluetooth Device List.
3. Select a phone you want to delete.
Features
378
4. Select Delete This Device.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
379 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.
Mobile phone: The ring tone stored in the
connected mobile phone sounds from the speakers.
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Ring Tone.
3. Select Fixed or Mobile phone.
Features
Continued
379
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
380 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History
■ When Automatic Phone Sync is set to
On:
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook and call history are automatically
imported to the system.
1Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook and Call History
When you select a name from the list in the mobile
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Features
Pref
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
■ Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
Work
Voice
setting
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
Pager
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Automatic Phone Sync.
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to the system.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
3. Select On or Off.
380
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
381 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
When a voice tag is stored, press the
button to
call the number using the voice tag. Say the voice tag
name.
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Go to the Phone Menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 374
Features
2. Select Speed Dial.
3. Select New Entry.
4. Select a place to choose a number.
From Import from Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Manual Input:
u Input the number manually.
From Import from Phonebook:
u Select a number from the connected
mobile phone’s imported phonebook.
5. When the speed dial is successfully stored,
you are asked to create a voice tag for the
number. Select Yes or No.
6. Select Record to store a voice tag for the
speed dial entry.
u Using the
button, follow the prompts
to store a voice tag for the speed dial
entry.
Continued
381
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
382 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select Voice Tag.
u From the pop-up menu, select Record.
5. Select Record to store the voice tag.
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
Features
■ To delete a voice tag
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select Voice Tag.
u From the pop-up menu, select Clear.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
382
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for the system to recognise a longer name.
For example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
383 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Edit.
4. Select a setting you want.
■ To delete a speed dial
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 372
■ Making a Call
Features
2. Select Edit Speed Dial.
3. Select an existing speed dial entry.
u From the pop-up menu, select Delete.
4. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Yes.
1Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone
number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or
redial.
Continued
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from most screens.
Press the
button and say the voice tag name.
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
383
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
384 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
phonebook
1. Go to the Phone Menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 374
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
You can call a stored voice-tagged speed dial number
using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 381
2. Select Phonebook.
3. Select a name.
u You can also search by letter. Select
Search.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering letters.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Features
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Go to the Phone Menu screen.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 374
2. Select Dial.
3. Select a number.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering numbers.
4. Select Done.
u Dialing starts automatically.
384
1To make a call using a phone number
You can call a stored voice-tagged speed dial number
using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 381
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
385 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1To make a call using redial
1. Go to the Phone Menu screen.
Press and hold the
number dialed.
2 Phone Menu screen P. 374
button to redial the last
2. Select Redial.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using the Call History
1To make a call using the Call History
The call history displays the last 20 all, dialed,
received, or missed calls.
(Appears only when a phone is connected to the
system.)
2 Phone Menu screen P. 374
Features
Call history is stored by All, Dialed,
Received, and Missed.
1. Go to the Phone Menu screen.
2. Select Call History.
3. Select All, Dialed, Received, or Missed.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
■ To make a call using a Speed Dial entry
1. Go to the Phone Menu screen.
1To make a call using a Speed Dial entry
When a voice tag is stored, press the
call the number using the voice tag.
2 Speed Dial P. 381
2 Phone Menu screen P. 374
2. Select Speed Dial.
3. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
button to
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
Continued
385
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
386 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuHands-Free Telephone SystemuHFT Menus
■ Receiving a Call
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds (if activated) and the
Incoming call screen appears.
Press the
Press the
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the call.
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold to
answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons.
Features
■ Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
The following options are available during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer: Transfer a call from the system to your phone.
Touch Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menudriven phone system.
The available options are shown on the lower
Mute Icon
half of the screen.
Select the option.
u The mute icon appears when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
386
Touch Tones: Available on some phones.
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
387 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Driving
This chapter discusses driving, refueling, and information on items such as accessories.
Before Driving................................... 388
Towing a Trailer................................ 392
When Driving
Starting the Engine .................. 397, 400
Precautions While Driving................. 403
Continuously Variable Transmission * ... 404
Shifting ............................ 405, 407, 412
Auto Idle Stop.......................... 415, 419
ECON Button ................................... 423
Cruise Control ................................. 424
Adjustable Speed Limiter.................. 427
Intelligent Speed Limiter................... 431
* Not available on all models
Forward Collision Warning * ............. 438
Lane Departure Warning * ................ 442
Traffic Sign Recognition System * ..... 446
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System .... 453
Deflation Warning System................ 455
Adjusting Headlight Distribution ...... 457
Braking
Brake System ................................... 458
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ........... 464
Brake Assist System.......................... 465
City-Brake Active system .................. 466
Emergency Stop Signal..................... 471
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped ................................ 472
Parking Sensor System * ................... 473
Multi-View Rear Camera *
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera ...477
Refueling
Fuel Information ...................... 479, 480
How to Refuel ......................... 481, 482
Fuel Economy.................................... 483
Accessories and Modifications ........ 484
387
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
388 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Before Driving
Driving Preparation
Check the following items before you start driving.
■ Exterior Checks
• Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior
lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
u Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
u Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of
vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
u When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel
or wheel components.
• Make sure the bonnet is securely closed.
u If the bonnet opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
• Make sure the tyres are in good condition.
u Check air pressures, and check for damage and excessive wear.
Driving
388
2 Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 534
• Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
u There are blind spots from the inside.
1Exterior Checks
NOTICE
When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around
the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force
them open, as this can damage the rubber trim
around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid
further freezing.
Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder.
You will be unable to insert the key if the water
freezes in the hole.
Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite
flammable materials left under the bonnet, causing a
fire. If you've parked your vehicle for an extended
period, inspect and remove any debris that may have
collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have
fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a
small animal. Also check under the bonnet for
leftover flammable materials after you or someone
else has performed maintenance on your vehicle.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
389 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
■ Interior Checks
1Interior Checks
• Store or secure all items on board properly.
u Carrying too much luggage, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle's
handling, stability, stopping distance, and tyres, and make it unsafe.
2 Load Limit P. 391
Models with headlight adjuster
You can adjust the low beam headlight angle by
yourself.
2 Headlight Adjuster * P. 183
Models with LED type headlights
Your vehicle is equipped with the automatic
headlight adjusting system that automatically adjusts
the vehicle angle of the headlights.
Driving
• Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
u They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden
braking.
• Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor
mat *.
u An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator
pedal operation while driving.
• If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
u They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
• Securely close all doors and the tailgate.
• Adjust your seating position properly.
u Adjust the head restraint, too.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the luggage area or tow a trailer, have
the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified
technician.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 197
2 Adjusting the Head Restraints P. 199
• Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly for your driving.
u Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
2 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 193
2 Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 192
* Not available on all models
Continued
389
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
390 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
• Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the
seats.
u They can interfere with the driver's ability to operate the pedals, or the
operation of the seats.
• Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 43
• Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the
vehicle, and go off soon after.
u Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
2 Indicators P. 86
Driving
390
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
391 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBefore DrivinguLoad Limit
Load Limit
When you load luggage, the total weight of the vehicle, all passengers, and luggage
must not exceed the maximum permissible weight.
2 Specifications P. 608, 611
The load for the front and rear axles also must not exceed the maximum permissible
axle weight.
1Load Limit
3 WARNING
Overloading or improper loading can affect
handling and stability and cause a crash in
which you can be hurt or killed.
2 Specifications P. 608, 611
Follow all load limits and other loading
guidelines in this manual.
Driving
391
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
392 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Towing a Trailer
Towing Preparation
■ Towing Load Limits
1Towing Load Limits
Your vehicle can tow a trailer if you carefully observe the load limits, use the proper
equipment, and follow the towing guidelines. Check the load limits before driving.
■ Total trailer weight
Do not exceed the maximum towing weight
of the trailer and towbar (with/without
brakes), luggage and everything in or on it.
Total Load
Towing loads in excess of the maximum
towing weight can seriously affect vehicle
handling and performance and can damage
the engine and drivetrain.
3 WARNING
Exceeding any load limit or improperly
loading your vehicle and trailer can cause a
crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Check the loading of your vehicle and
trailer carefully before starting to drive.
Driving
Check if all loads are within limits at a public scale.
If a public scale is not available, add the estimated
weight of your luggage load to the weight of your
trailer (as quoted by the manufacturer), and the
trailer nose load.
Break-in Period
Avoid towing a trailer during your vehicle's first 1,000
km (625 miles).
If you tow a trailer in mountainous conditions,
remember to reduce 10% of the combined vehicle
and trailer weights from the maximum towing
weight for every 1,000 metres of elevation.
Never exceed the maximum towing weight and any
specified load limit.
2 Specifications P. 610, 613
392
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
393 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Trailer Nose load
The trailer nose load should never exceed 70
kg (154 Ibs). This is the amount of weight the
trailer puts on the towbar when it is fullyloaded. As a rule of thumb for trailer weights
of less than 700 kg (1,543 Ibs), the trailer nose
load should be 10 percent of the total trailer
package.
Trailer
Nose
Load
Tongue
Load
• Excessive trailer nose load reduces front tyre traction and steering control. Too
little trailer nose load can make the trailer unstable and cause it to sway.
• To achieve a proper trailer nose load, start by loading 60% of the load towards
the front of the trailer and 40% towards the rear. Readjust the load as needed.
Driving
Continued
393
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
394 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Towing Equipment and Accessories
Towing equipment varies by the size of your trailer, how much load you are towing,
and where you are towing.
1Towing Equipment and Accessories
Make sure that all equipment is properly installed and
maintained, and that it meets the regulations of the
country where you are driving.
■ Towbars
The towbar must be of an approved type and properly bolted to the underbody.
■ Safety chains
Always use safety chains when you tow a trailer. Leave enough slack to allow the
trailer to turn corners easily, but do not allow the chains to drag on the ground.
■ Trailer brakes
Driving
If you are thinking of getting a trailer that has brakes, be sure they are electronically
actuated. Do not attempt to tap into your vehicle’s hydraulic system. No matter how
successful it may seem, any attempt to attach trailer brakes to your vehicle’s
hydraulic system will lower braking effectiveness and create a potential hazard.
■ Additional towing equipment
There may be laws requiring special outside mirrors when towing a trailer. Even if
mirrors are not required in your locale, you should install special mirrors if visibility is
restricted in any way.
■ Trailer light
Trailer lights and equipment must comply with the regulations of the country where
you are driving. Check with your local trailer sales or rental agency for the
requirements in the area where you plan to tow.
394
Consult your trailer sales or rental agency if any other
items are recommended or required for your towing
situation.
The lighting and wiring of trailers can vary by type
and brand. If a connector is required, it should only
be installed by a qualified technician.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
395 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuTowing a TraileruDriving Safely with a Trailer
Driving Safely with a Trailer
■ Things You Need To Know Before Towing a Trailer
1Driving Safely with a Trailer
• Have the trailer properly serviced and keep it in good condition.
• Make sure that all the weights and load in the vehicle and trailer are within limits.
2 Towing Load Limits P. 392
■ Towing Speeds and Gears
Parking
In addition to the normal precautions, place wheel
chocks at each of the trailer’s tyres.
We recommend you drive uphill of less than 12%
slope. Follow the trailer association’s
recommendations for suitable roads.
Winds caused by passing large vehicles can sway your
trailer, keep a constant speed and steer straight
ahead.
Always drive slowly and have someone guide you
when reversing.
Driving
• Securely attach the tow bar, safety chains, and other necessary parts to the trailer.
• Securely store all the items in and on the trailer so that they do not shift while
driving.
• Check if the lights and brakes on the trailer are working properly.
• Check the pressures of the trailer tyres, including the spare.
• Check regulations concerning the maximum speed or driving restrictions for
vehicles towing trailers. If you are driving across several countries, check each
country’s requirements before leaving home, because regulations may vary.
• Turn off the Auto Idle Stop system using the Auto Idle Stop OFF button. The
trailer weight can affect your vehicle’s brake effectiveness if Auto Idle Stop is
activated on a hill while towing a trailer.
Operating speed when towing a trailer is restricted
up to 100 km/h (62 mph).
• Drive slower than normal.
• Obey posted speed limits for vehicles with trailers.
Continuously variable transmission models
• Use the (D position when towing a trailer on level roads.
Continued
395
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
396 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuTowing a TraileruDriving Safely with a Trailer
■ Turning and Braking
• Turn more slowly and with a wider turning arc than normal.
• Allow more time and distance for braking.
• Do not brake or turn suddenly.
■ Driving in Hilly Terrain
• Closely watch your high temperature indicator. If the indicator remains on, turn
off the climate control system and reduce speed. Pull to the side of the road safely
to cool down the engine if necessary.
Continuously variable transmission models
• Shift to the (S position if the transmission shifts frequently.
Driving
396
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
397 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
When Driving
Models without keyless access system
Starting the Engine
1Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
Petrol models
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 2,400 metres
(8,000 feet).
Continuously variable transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Clutch Pedal
Manual transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (N . Then
depress the brake pedal with your right
foot, and the clutch pedal with your left
foot.
u The clutch pedal must be fully depressed
to start the engine.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft. If an improperly coded device is used, the
engine's fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 163
Driving
Brake Pedal
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, climate
control system, and rear demister in order to reduce
battery drain.
Brake Pedal
Continued
397
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
398 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
All models
3. Turn the ignition switch to START (e
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
1Starting the Engine
Petrol models
Do not wait until the engine start with the key in
START (e .
• If the engine does not start right away, wait for at
least 10 seconds before trying again.
• If the engine starts, but then immediately stops,
wait at least 10 seconds before repeating step 3
while gently depressing the accelerator pedal.
Release the accelerator pedal once the engine
starts.
Diesel models
Driving
Do not hold the key in START (e for more than 15
seconds.
• If the engine does not start right away, wait for at
least 20 seconds before trying again.
• If the engine starts, but then immediately stops,
wait at least 20 seconds before repeating step 3
while gently depressing the accelerator pedal.
Release the accelerator pedal once the engine
starts.
Diesel models
NOTICE
For proper lubrication, the engine must not be run
above fast idle speed until the low oil pressure
indicator goes off.
Avoid harsh acceleration or labouring the engine
before the normal operating temperature has been
reached.
398
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
399 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Starting to Drive
Continuously variable transmission models
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, put the shift lever in (D . Select (R
when reversing.
2. With the parking brake applied, release the brake pedal and gently depress the
accelerator pedal.
u Make sure the electric parking brake indicator goes off.
2 Parking Brake P. 458
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help to prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Manual transmission models
Continuously variable transmission models
Move the shift lever to (D , (S , or (L * when facing uphill, or (R when facing
downhill, then release the brake pedal.
Diesel models
When the engine malfunctions or stalls due to
insufficient fuel, move the vehicle to a safe place
immediately and refuel 10 Litres (2.2 Imp gal) or
more.
When fuel runs out, air enters the fuel system. This
may cause slow starting of the engine.
If the engine does not start on the first try, try again
a few times. If the engine still does not start, ask a
dealer.
1Starting to Drive
You can also release the parking brake by pressing
the electric parking brake switch while depressing the
brake pedal.
When facing downhill, you can start your vehicle
more smoothly by manually releasing it with the
electric parking brake switch than by releasing it with
the accelerator pedal.
Driving
Depress the clutch pedal, and shift to one of the forward gears when facing uphill,
or (R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.
1Starting the Engine
Manual Transmission models
Fully depress the clutch pedal within three seconds.
The engine automatically restarts if certain conditions
are met.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
does not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
* Not available on all models
399
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
400 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
Models with keyless access system
Starting the Engine
1Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
Petrol models
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 2,400 metres
(8,000 feet).
Continuously variable transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (P , then
depress the brake pedal.
u Although it is possible to start the vehicle
in (N , it is safer to start it in (P .
Driving
Brake Pedal
Clutch Pedal
Brake Pedal
400
Manual transmission models
2. Check that the shift lever is in (N . Then
depress the brake pedal with your right
foot, and the clutch pedal with your left
foot.
u The clutch pedal must be fully depressed
to start the engine.
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, climate
control system, and rear demister in order to reduce
battery drain.
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft. If an improperly coded device is used, the
engine’s fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 163
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
401 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
All models
1Starting the Engine
3. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
ENGINE
START
STOP
Bring the keyless remote close to the ENGINE
START/STOP button if the battery in the keyless
remote is weak.
2 If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak
P. 577
The engine may not start if the keyless remote is
subjected to strong radio waves.
Do not hold the ENGINE START/STOP button to
start the engine.
■ Stopping the Engine
Petrol models
You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.
If the engine does not start, wait at least 10 seconds
before trying again.
Continuously variable transmission models
Diesel models
If the engine does not start, wait at least 20 seconds
before trying again.
Manual transmission models
• If the shift lever is in (N , press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
• If the shift lever is in any gear other than (N , depress the clutch pedal, then press
the ENGINE START/STOP button.
Continued
Diesel models
Driving
1. Shift to (P .
2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
NOTICE
For proper lubrication, the engine must not be run
above fast idle speed until the low oil pressure
indicator goes off.
Avoid harsh acceleration or labouring the engine
before the normal operating temperature has been
reached.
401
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
402 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Starting to Drive
Continuously variable transmission models
1. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, put the shift lever in (D . Select (R
when reversing.
2. With the parking brake applied, release the brake pedal and gently depress the
accelerator pedal.
u Make sure the electric parking brake indicator goes off.
2 Parking Brake P. 458
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly help to prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Manual Transmission models
Driving
Depress the clutch pedal, and shift to one of the forward gears when facing uphill,
or (R when facing downhill, then release the brake pedal.
Continuously variable transmission models
Move the shift lever to (D , (S , or (L * when facing uphill, or (R when facing
downhill, then release the brake pedal.
1Starting the Engine
Diesel models
When the engine malfunctions or stalls due to
insufficient fuel, move the vehicle to a safe place
immediately and refuel 10 Litres (2.2 Imp gal) or
more.
When fuel runs out, air enters the fuel system. This
may cause slow starting of the engine.
If the engine does not start on the first try, try again
a few times. If the engine still does not start, ask a
dealer.
1Starting to Drive
You can also release the parking brake by pressing
the electric parking brake switch while depressing the
brake pedal.
When facing downhill, you can start your vehicle
more smoothly by manually releasing it with the
electric parking brake switch than by releasing it with
the accelerator pedal.
Manual Transmission models
Fully depress the clutch pedal within three seconds.
The engine automatically restarts if certain conditions
are met.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
does not operate on small inclines.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
402
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
403 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguPrecautions While Driving
Precautions While Driving
■ In Rain
1Precautions While Driving
Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the engine or
driveline, or cause electrical component failure.
CAUTION: Do not drive on the road where water is
deep. Driving through deep water will cause damage
to the engine and electrical equipment and the
vehicle will break down.
NOTICE
Do not operate the shift lever while pressing the
accelerator pedal. You could damage the
transmission.
NOTICE
Driving
If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an
extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel on
the full left or right position for a while, the electric
power steering (EPS) system heats up. The system
goes into a protective mode, and limits its
performance. The steering wheel becomes harder
and harder to operate. Once the system cools down,
the EPS system is restored. Repeated operation under
these conditions can eventually damage the system.
If the ignition switch is turned to ACCESSORY (q or
LOCK (0 *1 while driving, the engine will shut down
and all steering and brake power assist functions will
stop, making it difficult to control the vehicle.
Do not put the shift lever in (N , as you will lose
engine braking (and acceleration) performance.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
403
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
404 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguContinuously Variable Transmission *
■ Other Precautions
If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location.
Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.
1Precautions While Driving
During the first 1,000 km (625 miles) of operation,
avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so
as not to damage the engine or powertrain.
Avoid hard braking for the first 300 km (200 miles).
You should also follow this when the brake pads are
replaced.
Continuously Variable Transmission *
■ Creeping
The engine runs at a higher idle speed and creeping increases.
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.
Driving
404
■ Kickdown
Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the
transmission to drop to a lower ratio, unexpectedly increasing vehicle speed.
Depress the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and curves.
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
405 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Continuously variable transmission models without paddle shifters
Shifting
1Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
Models without keyless access system
You cannot turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 and
remove the key unless the shift lever is in (P .
■ Shift lever positions
Models with keyless access system
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Used when idling
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
Driving
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-30°C), there may be a short delay
before the shift position is displayed. Always confirm
you are in the correct shift position before driving.
Drive
Used for normal driving
Release Button
You cannot change the power mode from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in (P .
Drive (S)
Used:
● For better acceleration
● To increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
● When towing a trailer in hilly terrain
Low
Used:
● To further increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
Continued
405
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
406 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Tachometer’s red zone
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Driving
Shift Lever Position Indicator
Depress the brake pedal and press the
shift lever release button to shift.
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button and
shift.
406
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer's red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
407 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Continuously variable transmission models with paddle shifters
Shifting
1Shifting
Change the shift position in accordance with your driving needs.
Models without keyless access system
You cannot turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 and
remove the key unless the shift lever is in (P .
■ Shift lever positions
Models with keyless access system
Park
Used when parking or starting the
engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Used when idling
Release Button
The vehicle may move forward very slightly even in
(N while the engine is cold.
Depress the brake pedal firmly and, when necessary,
apply the parking brake.
When shifting positions in extremely low
temperatures (-30°C), there may be a short delay
before the shift position is displayed. Always confirm
you are in the correct shift position before driving.
Driving
Drive
Used:
● For normal driving
● When temporarily driving in the 7speed manual shift mode
You cannot change the power mode from ON to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) unless the shift lever is in (P .
Drive (S)
Used:
● For better acceleration
● To increase engine braking
● When going up or down hills
● When driving in the 7-speed manual
shift mode
● When towing a trailer in hilly terrain
Continued
407
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
408 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
1Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Tachometer’s red zone
When you change the shift lever from (D to (R and
vice versa, come to a complete stop and keep the
brake pedal depressed.
Operating the shift lever before the vehicle has come
to a complete standstill can damage the transmission.
Use the shift lever position indicator to check the
lever position before pulling away.
If the transmission indicator blinks when driving, in
any shift position, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Driving
Shift Lever Position Indicator
M (7-Speed Manual Shift Mode)
Indicator/Shift Indicator
Depress the brake pedal and press the
shift lever release button to shift.
Shift without pressing the shift lever
release button.
Press the shift lever release button
and shift.
408
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer’s red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
It may not be possible to operate the shift lever if the
brake pedal is applied while the shift lever release
button is held down.
Depress the brake pedal first.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
409 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode
17-Speed Manual Shift Mode
Use the paddle shifters to change between 1st and 7th speeds without removing
your hands from the steering wheel. The transmission switches to the 7-speed
manual shift mode when you pull a paddle shifter while driving. This mode is useful
when engine braking is needed.
■ When the shift lever is in (D :
The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode temporarily, and the
number is displayed in the shift indicator.
The 7-speed manual shift mode is cancelled automatically if you drive at constant
speed or accelerate, and the number in the shift indicator goes off.
You can cancel this mode by pulling the (+ paddle shifter for a few seconds.
The 7-speed manual shift mode is especially useful when reducing the vehicle speed
temporarily before making a turn.
The shift mode goes into the 7-speed manual shift mode. The M indicator and the
speed number are displayed in the shift indicator. As the vehicle speed slows down,
the transmission automatically shifts down accordingly. When the vehicle comes to
a stop, it automatically shifts down into 1st.
When the engine speed reaches near the
tachometer’s red zone, the transmission shifts up
automatically.
When the engine speed reaches the lowest threshold
of the selected speed position, the transmission shifts
down automatically.
Operating the paddle shifters on slippery surfaces
may cause the tyres to lock up. In this case, the 7speed manual shift mode is cancelled and goes back
to the normal D driving mode.
Driving
■ When the shift lever is in (S :
In the 7-speed manual shift mode, the transmission
shifts up or down by operating either paddle shifter
under the following conditions:
Shift Up: The engine speed reaches the lowest
threshold of the higher speed position.
Shift Down: The engine speed reaches the highest
threshold of the lower speed position.
If the vehicle speed increases and the engine speed reaches near the tachometer’s
red zone, the transmission automatically shifts up.
You can only pull away in 1st speed.
When cancelling the 7-speed manual shift mode, move the shift lever from (S to
(D . When the 7-speed manual shift mode is cancelled, the M indicator and shift
indicator go off.
Continued
409
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
410 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ 7-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation
(- Paddle Shifter
(Shift down)
17-Speed Manual Shift Mode Operation
(+ Paddle Shifter
(Shift up)
Each paddle shift operation makes a single speed
change.
To change continuously, release the paddle shifter
before pulling it again for the next speed.
The shift indicator blinks when you cannot shift up or
down. It indicates that your vehicle speed is not in its
allowable shifting range.
Slightly accelerate to shift up and decelerate to shift
down while the indicator is blinking.
The shift indicator may also blink when you cannot
shift down while driving in low speed. This prevents
the transmission from being damaged.
Driving
410
Downshifting when pulling
the (- paddle shifter
(Changes to lower speed
number)
Upshifting when pulling
the (+ paddle shifter
(Changes to higher speed
number)
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
411 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Up/Down Indicators
1Shift Up/Down Indicators
Come on while the vehicle is in the 7-speed
manual shift mode to indicate when a speed
change is appropriate to maintain the most
fuel efficient driving style.
The shift up indicator: Comes on when
shifting up is recommended.
The shift down indicator: Comes on when
shifting down is recommended.
3 WARNING
The shift indicator is only a guide to help
you achieve better fuel economy.
Never refer to the Shift Indicators when
road and traffic conditions are unsuitable
or when it may distract you.
The shift down indicator will not prompt you to
downshift to increase engine braking. It is up to you
to downshift to increase engine braking when driving
downhill.
Always shift down at the appropriate vehicle speed.
Driving
When the ECON mode is on, ambient meter colour
may change if you do not change speed positions
when a shift indicator illuminates. This can result in a
change in fuel economy.
Road and traffic conditions may require you to shift
at times other than those indicated.
411
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
412 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Manual transmission models
Shifting
1Shifting
■ Shift Lever Operation
NOTICE
Fully depress the clutch pedal to operate the shift lever and change gears, then
slowly release the pedal.
Depress the clutch pedal, and pause for a few seconds before shifting into (R , or
shift into one of the forward gears for a moment. This stops the gears so they do not
“grind.”
When you are not shifting, do not rest your
foot on the clutch pedal. This can cause your
clutch to wear out faster.
Driving
412
Do not shift to (R before the vehicle comes to a
complete stop.
Shifting to (R before stopping can damage the
transmission.
NOTICE
Before downshifting, make sure the engine will not
go into the tachometer's red zone. Should this occur,
it can severely damage your engine.
If you exceed the maximum speed for the gear you
are in, the engine speed will enter into the
tachometer's red zone. When this happens, you may
experience a slight jolt.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
413 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Up/Down Indicators
1Shift Up/Down Indicators
Come on to indicate when a gear change is
appropriate to maintain the most fuel efficient
driving style.
The shift up indicator: Comes on when
shifting up is recommended.
The shift down indicator: Comes on when
shifting down is recommended.
3 WARNING
The shift indicator is only a guide to help
you achieve better fuel economy.
Never refer to the Shift Indicators when
road and traffic conditions are unsuitable
or when it may distract you.
The shift down indicator will not prompt you to
downshift to increase engine braking. It is up to you
to downshift to increase engine braking when driving
downhill.
Always shift down at the appropriate vehicle speed.
Driving
The shift down indicator does not come on when
downshifting from (2 to (1 .
When the ECON mode is on, ambient meter colour
may change if you do not change gears when a shift
indicator illuminates. This can result in a change in
fuel economy.
Road and traffic conditions may require you to shift
at times other than those indicated.
Continued
413
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
414 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Reverse Lockout
The manual transmission has a lockout mechanism that stops you from accidentally
shifting into (R from a forward gear while the vehicle is moving at a certain speed.
If you cannot shift to (R when the vehicle is stopped, do the following:
1. Depress the clutch pedal, move the shift
lever all the way to the left, and shift to (R .
2. If you still cannot shift into (R , apply the
parking brake, and turn the ignition
switch to ACCESSORY (q or LOCK (0 *1,
then depress the brake pedal.
3. Depress the clutch pedal and shift into (R .
4. Keep depressing the clutch pedal and start
the engine.
Driving
Have the vehicle checked by a dealer if you have to go through this procedure
repeatedly.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
414
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
415 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
Continuously variable transmission models
Auto Idle Stop
1Auto Idle Stop
To help to maximise fuel economy, the engine automatically stops when the vehicle
comes to a stop, depending on environmental and vehicle operating conditions. The
indicator (green) comes on.
The engine then restarts once the vehicle is
Auto Idle Stop
about to move again, and the indicator
Indicator (Green)
(green) goes off.
A message associated with Auto Idle Stop
appears on the multi-information display.
The duration of the Auto Idle Stop operation:
• Increase in the ECON mode, compared to when
the ECON mode is off, with climate control in use.
2 Indicators P. 86
2 Customized Features P. 136
■ Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
Auto Idle Stop may activate less frequently in such
conditions as a traffic jam.
1Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
To turn the Auto Idle Stop system off, press
this button. The Auto Idle Stop system stops.
u Auto Idle Stop system will stop and the
indicator (amber) will come on.
Continued
Driving
If the driver’s door is opened while the
indicator (green) is on, a buzzer sounds to
notify you that the Auto Idle Stop function is
in operation.
Auto Idle
Stop
System
Indicator
(Amber)
The battery installed in this vehicle is specifically
designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. Using a
battery other than this specified type may shorten the
battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop from
activating. If you need to replace the battery, make
sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for
more details.
2 Specifications P. 608
Pressing the Auto Idle Stop system OFF button
restarts the engine during the Auto Idle Stop
activated.
415
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
416 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ Auto Idle Stop Activates When:
The vehicle stops with the shift lever in (D and the brake pedal depressed.
■ Auto Idle Stop does not activate when:
Driving
416
• The driver’s seat belt is not fastened.
• The engine coolant temperature is low or high.
• The engine is started with the bonnet open.
u Turn off the engine. Close the bonnet before you restart the engine to activate
Auto Idle Stop.
•
is on (indicator (amber) on).
• The battery charge is low.
•
is on (indicator on).
• The climate control system temperature is set to Hi or Lo.
• The climate control system is in use, and the outside temperature is below -20°C
or over 40°C.
• The transmission fluid temperature is low or high.
• The shift lever is in a position other than (D .
• The engine restarts but the vehicle stops again before reaching 5 km/h (3 mph).
• Stopped on a steep incline.
* Not available on all models
1Auto Idle Stop Activates When:
Do not open a bonnet, during idling stop.
If the bonnet is opened, the engine will not restart
automatically.
In this case, restart the engine with the ENGINE
START/STOP button * or turn the ignition switch * to
START (e .
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
Models with keyless access system
Pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button changes
the power mode to ACCESSORY even while Auto Idle
Stop is in operation. Once in ACCESSORY, the engine
no longer restarts automatically. Follow the standard
procedure to start the engine.
2 Starting the Engine P. 400
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
417 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ Auto Idle Stop may not activate when:
•
•
•
•
•
The steering wheel is operated.
Altitude is high.
The vehicle is stopped by braking suddenly.
The vehicle is repeatedly accelerated and decelerated at a low speed.
The climate control system is in use, and there is a significant difference between
the set temperature and the actual interior temperature.
• Humidity in the interior is high.
• The fan speed is high.
Driving
Continued
417
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
418 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ The Engine Automatically Restarts When:
The brake pedal is released.
■ The engine restarts even if the brake pedal is depressed when:
•
•
•
•
•
Driving
•
•
•
•
•
•
The Auto Idle Stop system OFF button is pressed.
A steering wheel is operated.
The shift lever is set to (R , (S , and (L *, or when it is set from (N to (D .
The pressure to the brake pedal is reduced and the vehicle starts moving while
stopped on an incline.
The pressure on the brake pedal is repeatedly applied and released slightly during
a stop.
The battery charge becomes low.
The accelerator pedal is depressed.
The driver’s seat belt is unlatched.
is on (indicator on).
The climate control system is in use, and the difference between the set
temperature and actual interior temperature becomes significant.
The climate control system is being used to dehumidify the interior.
■ Starting Assist Brake Function
Briefly keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal to restart the engine.
This can keep your vehicle from unexpectedly moving while on an incline.
418
* Not available on all models
1The Engine Automatically Restarts When:
If you are using an electronic device during Auto Idle
Stop, the device may temporarily be turned off when
the engine restarts.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
419 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
Manual transmission models
Auto Idle Stop
1Auto Idle Stop
To help to maximise fuel economy, the engine automatically stops when the vehicle
comes to a stop, depending on environmental and vehicle operating conditions. The
indicator (green) comes on.
The engine then restarts once the vehicle is
Auto Idle Stop
about to move again when you depress the
Indicator (Green)
clutch pedal, and the indicator (green) goes
off.
A message associated with Auto Idle Stop
appears on the multi-information display.
2 Indicators P. 86
2 Customized Features P. 136
■ Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
Auto Idle
Stop
System
Indicator
(Amber)
The battery installed in this vehicle is specifically
designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. Using a
battery other than this specified type may shorten the
battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop from
activating. If you need to replace the battery, make
sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for
more details.
2 Specifications P. 608, 611
The duration of the Auto Idle Stop operation:
• Increase in the ECON mode, compared to when
the ECON mode is off, with climate control in use.
Driving
If the driver’s door is opened while the
indicator (green) is on, a buzzer sounds to
notify you that the Auto Idle Stop function is
in operation.
If Auto Idle Stop is turned on long enough to lower
the battery charge, the engine may not restart
automatically. Manually turn off the engine when
you leave your vehicle.
1Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
To turn the Auto Idle Stop system off, press
this button. The Auto Idle Stop system stops.
u Auto Idle Stop system will stop and the
indicator (amber) will come on.
Continued
Pressing the Auto Idle Stop system OFF button
restarts the engine during the Auto Idle Stop
activated.
419
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
420 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ Auto Idle Stop Activates When:
After the vehicle moves forward, stopping with the brake, the clutch pedal is fully
depressed, the shift lever is in (N , and release the clutch pedal.
u To restart the engine automatically, depress the clutch pedal.
■ Auto Idle Stop does not activate when:
Driving
• The driver’s seat belt is not fastened.
• The engine coolant temperature is low or high.
• The engine is started with the bonnet open.
u Turn off the engine. Close the bonnet before you restart the engine to activate
Auto Idle Stop.
•
is on (indicator (amber) on).
• The battery charge is low.
•
is on (indicator on).
• The climate control system temperature is set to Hi or Lo.
• The climate control system is in use, and the outside temperature is below -20°C
or over 40°C.
• The shift lever is in any position except (N .
• The engine restarts but the vehicle stops again before reaching 3 km/h (2 mph).
■ Auto Idle Stop may not activate when:
• The steering wheel is operated.
• Altitude is high.
• The climate control system is in use, and there is a significant difference between
the set temperature and the actual interior temperature.
• Humidity in the interior is high.
• The fan speed is high.
420
* Not available on all models
1Auto Idle Stop Activates When:
Do not open a bonnet, during idling stop.
If the bonnet is opened, the engine will not restart
automatically.
In this case, restart the engine with the ENGINE
START/STOP button * or turn the ignition switch * to
START (e .
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
Models with keyless access system
Pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button changes
the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) even while
Auto Idle Stop is in operation. Once in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK), the engine no longer restarts automatically.
Follow the standard procedure to start the engine.
2 Starting the Engine P. 400
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
421 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ The Engine Automatically Restarts When:
1The Engine Automatically Restarts When:
The clutch pedal is depressed.
■ The engine automatically restarts even if the clutch pedal is not depressed
•
•
•
•
•
with the shift lever in (N when:
The Auto Idle Stop system OFF button is pressed.
Your vehicle is moved.
The pressure on the brake pedal is repeatedly applied and released slightly during
a stop.
The battery charge becomes low.
The steering wheel is operated.
If you are using an electronic device during Auto Idle
Stop, the device may temporarily be turned off when
the engine restarts.
The engine does not restart automatically when there
is a problem in the system. Follow the normal
procedure to start the engine.
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
Driving
The engine does not restart automatically when:
• The driver’s seat belt is unlatched.
Fasten the driver's seat belt to keep the Auto Idle
Stop activated.
• The shift lever is moved from (N to any other
position.
Shift to (N .
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 110
When the system stops operating, follow the normal
procedure to start the engine.
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
Continued
421
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
422 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ When the Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Green) Starts Blinking
Rapidly
Fully depress the clutch pedal.
u The engine automatically restarts.
Driving
422
1 When the Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Green) Starts Blinking Rapidly
The indicator starts blinking rapidly under the
following conditions:
•
(windscreen demister) is touched.
• When the climate control system is in use and
moisture builds up inside the vehicle.
• When the climate control system is in use and the
different between the set temperature and the
actual temperature inside the vehicle becomes
significant.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
423 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguECON Button
ECON Button
The ECON button turns the ECON mode on
and off.
Petrol models
1ECON Button
While in ECON mode, the climate control system has
greater temperature fluctuations.
The ECON mode helps you to improve your
fuel economy by adjusting the performance of
the climate control system, and cruise control.
Diesel models
The ECON mode helps you to improve your
fuel economy by adjusting the performance of
the transmission, climate control system, and
cruise control.
Driving
423
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
424 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
Cruise Control
Maintains a constant vehicle speed without having to keep your foot on the
accelerator pedal. Use cruise control on motorways or open roads where you can
travel at a constant speed with little acceleration or deceleration.
■ Vehicle speed for cruise control: Desired
Continuously variable transmission models
3 WARNING
Improper use of the cruise control can lead
to a crash.
When to use
speed in a range from about 30 km/h
(18 mph) to about 200 km/h (125 mph)
1Cruise Control
Always keep sufficient distance
between you and the vehicle in
front of you.
■ Shift positions for cruise control:
Use the cruise control only when travelling
on open motorways in good weather.
It may not be possible to maintain a constant speed
when driving uphill or downhill.
In (D or (S
Manual transmission models
How to use
Driving
The indicator is on in the instrument panel
Cruise control is ready to use.
■ Press the MAIN button
on the steering wheel
When the engine speed slows down, try to
downshift. You can maintain the set speed if you
change gear within five seconds.
When not using cruise control:
Turn off cruise control by pressing the MAIN button.
It may take more time to accelerate in ECON mode.
You cannot use the cruise control and adjustable
speed limiter or intelligent speed limiter * at the same
time.
If a different indicator comes on, press the LIM button to switch the cruise control.
424
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
425 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
−/SET Button
Press and release
The set speed appears
when cruise control
begins
The moment you release the –/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control
begins. The set speed is displayed.
Continued
Driving
Take your foot off the accelerator pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach
the desired speed.
425
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
426 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguCruise Control
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
To increase speed
To decrease speed
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the set speed increases or decreases by 1 km/h or
1 mph accordingly.
• If you keep the button pressed, the set speed increases or decreases in increments
of 10 km/h or 10 mph every 0.5 second until system limit is reached.
• The vehicle will accelerate or decelerate until the set speed is reached.
■ To Cancel
MAIN
Button
LIM
Button
426
CANCEL
Button
* Not available on all models
To cancel cruise control, do any of the
following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Press the LIM button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
• Depress the clutch pedal * for five seconds
or more.
The displayed set speed goes off.
1To Cancel
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been cancelled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+
button while driving at a speed of at least 30 km/h
(18 mph) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 30 km/h (18 mph)
• When the MAIN button is turned off
At vehicle speeds of 25 km/h (16mph) or less, cruise
control is cancelled automatically.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
427 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAdjustable Speed Limiter
Adjustable Speed Limiter
This system enables you to set a maximum speed that cannot be exceeded even if
you are depressing the accelerator pedal.
The vehicle speed limit can be set from about 30 km/h (18 mph) to about 250 km/h
(156 mph).
How to use
The indicator is on in the instrument panel
Adjustable speed limiter is ready to use.
■ Press the MAIN button
1Adjustable Speed Limiter
3 WARNING
Adjustable Speed Limiter has limitations.
It is always your responsibility to adjust the
vehicle speed to obey the actual speed
limit, and safely operate the vehicle.
on the steering wheel
3 WARNING
Do not depress the accelerator pedal more
than necessary.
Maintain an appropriate accelerator pedal
position depending on the vehicle speed.
Driving
If a different indicator comes on, press the LIM button to switch to the adjustable speed limiter.
The adjustable speed limiter may not hold the set
speed limit when driving downhill. If this occurs, slow
down by depressing the brake pedal.
When not using the adjustable speed limiter:
Turn off the adjustable speed limiter by pressing the
MAIN button.
You cannot use the adjustable speed limiter and
cruise control or intelligent speed limiter * at the same
time.
Manual transmission models
When the engine speed slows down, try to
downshift.
* Not available on all models
Continued
427
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
428 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAdjustable Speed Limiter
■ To Set the Speed Limit
1To Set the Speed Limit
−/SET Button
RES/+ Button
If you set the speed limit while travelling at less than
30 km/h (18 mph), the speed limit is set to 30 km/h
(18 mph).
The beeper sounds and the displayed speed limit
blinks if the vehicle speed exceeds the limit by 3 km/
h (2 mph) or more on a steep descent.
Press and release
On when the
adjustable speed
limiter is set
Driving
428
• Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the
desired speed.
The moment you release the –/SET button, the speed limit is fixed, and the
adjustable speed limiter is set. The speed limit is displayed.
• You can set the previously set speed limit by pressing the RES/+ button.
The adjustable speed limiter is set to the current
speed if it is higher than the previously set speed limit
when you press the RES/+ button.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
429 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAdjustable Speed Limiter
■ To Adjust the Speed Limit
Increase or decrease the speed limit by using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
To increase speed
To decrease speed
■ Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the speed limit increases or decreases by 1 km/h
or 1 mph accordingly.
• If you keep the button pressed, the speed limit increases or decreases in
increments of 10 km/h or 10 mph every 0.5 second until system limit is reached.
• The vehicle may accelerate or decelerate until the set speed is reached.
1Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily
The beeper sounds when the vehicle speed goes
higher than the set speed limit with the acceleration
pedal depressed completely.
The speed limit can be exceeded by depressing the accelerator pedal fully.
u The displayed speed limit blinks.
The beeper sounds once the speed limit has been exceeded.
The adjustable speed limiter resumes working once
the vehicle speed goes lower than the set speed limit.
Continued
429
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
430 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAdjustable Speed Limiter
■ To Cancel
1To Cancel
To cancel the adjustable speed limiter, do any
of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Press the LIM button.
MAIN
Button
LIM
Button
Driving
430
The adjustable speed limiter changes into cruise
control if the LIM button is pressed.
Models with intelligent speed limiter
The adjustable speed limiter changes into intelligent
speed limiter if the LIM button is pressed.
CANCEL
Button
If there is a problem with the system when you are
using the adjustable speed limiter, the beeper sounds
and OFF comes on. The adjustable speed limiter will
be turned off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
431 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
Models with traffic sign recognition system
Intelligent Speed Limiter
1Intelligent Speed Limiter
Automatically sets the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects.
And the speed limit cannot be exceeded even if you are depressing the accelerator
pedal. If you fully depress the accelerator the speed limit can be exceeded.
2 Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 446
3 WARNING
Intelligent Speed Limiter has limitations.
The Intelligent Speed Limiter may set itself
to a speed above or below the actual speed
limit, or may not work, particularly where
the traffic sign recognition system does not
operate correctly or where a road has no
speed limit signs. It is always your
responsibility to adjust the speed to obey
the actual speed limit and to safely operate
the vehicle.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Driving
Depending on the amount of depression of the
accelerator pedal, the vehicle will accelerate until it
reaches the speed identified by the traffic sign
recognition system.
431
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
432 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
1Intelligent Speed Limiter
How to use
The indicator is on in the instrument panel
Intelligent speed limiter is ready to use.
■ Press the MAIN button
on the steering wheel
If a different indicator comes on, press the LIM button to change it to the intelligent speed limiter.
The system is designed to detect signs that follow the
Vienna Convention standards. Not all signs may be
detected, but any signs posted on roadsides should
not be ignored. The system does not work on the
designated traffic signs of all the countries you travel,
nor in all situations.
2 Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 448
Driving
If the intelligent speed limiter is set to the wrong
speed limit, try one of the following:
To cancel
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Press the LIM button.
To exceed the speed limit temporarily
• Depressing the accelerator pedal fully.
The intelligent speed limiter may not hold the set
speed limit when driving downhill. If this occurs, slow
down by depressing the brake pedal.
When not using the intelligent speed limiter, turn off
the intelligent speed limiter by pressing the MAIN
button.
You cannot use the intelligent speed limiter and
cruise control or adjustable speed limiter at the same
time.
432
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
433 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
■ To Set the Speed Limit
1Intelligent Speed Limiter
Manual transmission models
When the engine speed slows down, try to
downshift.
−/SET Button
RES/+ Button
Do not use the intelligent speed limiter in areas of
different units from the display unit of the intelligent
speed limiter.
Right-hand drive type
Change the displayed measurement of the set vehicle
speed to the same units as the driving areas.
2 Customized Features P. 136
Press and release
On when the
intelligent speed
limiter is set to the
speed limit that the
traffic sign
recognition system
detects.
1To Set the Speed Limit
• The moment you release the –/SET button or RES/+ button, the intelligent speed
limiter is set to the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects. The
speed limit is displayed.
Continued
Driving
If you set the intelligent speed limiter when the speed
limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects is
less than 30 km/h (20 mph), the speed limitation
function and warning function may switch to pause.
If your vehicle speed is higher than the speed limit
that the traffic sign recognition system detects, your
vehicle decelerates slowly to the speed limit or less. If
necessary, slow down by depressing the brake pedal.
And the beeper sounds and the displayed speed limit
blinks if the vehicle speed exceeds the limit by 3 km/
h (2 mph) or more.
433
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
434 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
■ When the traffic sign recognition system detects the new speed limit sign
The intelligent speed limiter is set to the new speed limit that the traffic sign
recognition system detects.
■ The speed limitation function and warning function may switch to pause
Driving
434
if there is no speed limit sign in the screen of the traffic sign recognition
system when:
• The end of speed limit or other designated limit is detected.
• Your vehicle enters/exits motorway or highway.
• You make a turn with a turn signal to change direction at an intersection.
1To Set the Speed Limit
The intelligent speed limiter may also switch to pause
when the traffic sign recognition system detects only
additional speed limit signs.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
435 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
■ When the traffic sign recognition system detects the speed limit sign
while the intelligent speed limiter is paused
The speed limitation function and warning function will be resumed automatically.
■ When the traffic sign recognition system does not detect the speed limit
Continued
Driving
sign for a time while the intelligent speed limiter is activated
While driving, in addition to when the traffic sign recognition system detects no
speed limit sign, the traffic sign recognition system may display no speed limit.
But, intelligent speed limiter functions continue.
435
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
436 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
■ To Adjust the Speed Limit
1To Adjust the Speed Limit
Increase or decrease the speed limit by using the RES/+ or –/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
To increase speed
A negative or positive offset with respect to the
speed limit will be reset automatically when the
traffic sign recognition system detects the new speed
limit sign.
You cannot decrease the speed limit less than 30 km/
h (18 mph).
To decrease speed
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the speed limit is increased or decreased by about
1 km/h or 1 mph accordingly.
• You can increase the speed limit until +10 km/h or +5 mph on the basis of the
speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects.
• You can decrease the speed limit until -10 km/h or -5 mph on the basis of the
speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects.
• You can accelerate until the set speed is reached. If your vehicle speed is higher
than the speed limit that the traffic sign recognition system detects, your vehicle
decelerates slowly to the speed limit.
■ Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily
The speed limit can be exceeded by depressing the accelerator pedal fully.
u The displayed speed limit blinks.
The beeper sounds once the speed limit has been exceeded.
436
1Exceeding the Speed Limit Temporarily
The beeper sounds when the vehicle speed goes
higher than the set speed limit with the acceleration
pedal depressed completely.
The intelligent speed limiter resumes working once
the vehicle speed goes lower than the set speed limit.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
437 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Speed Limiter
■ To Cancel
1To Cancel
To cancel the intelligent speed limiter, do any
of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Press the LIM button.
MAIN
Button
LIM
Button
The intelligent speed limiter changes into cruise
control if the LIM button is pressed.
CANCEL
Button
* Not available on all models
Driving
If there is a problem with the system or traffic sign
recognition system when you are using the intelligent
speed limiter, the beeper sounds and OFF comes on.
The intelligent speed limiter will be turned off.
2 Traffic Sign Recognition System * P. 448
437
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
438 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning *
Forward Collision Warning *
Alerts you when it detects the possibility of your vehicle colliding with the vehicle in
front of yours.
If the system determines a collision is possible, it gives both visual and audible alerts.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change lanes,
etc.).
■ How the system works
The system may give warnings of potential collisions when your vehicle speed is
above 15 km/h (9 mph).
You can set Far, Normal or Near for when warnings start:
Important Safety Reminder
Forward Collision Warning cannot detect all objects
ahead and may not detect a given object; accuracy of
the system will vary based on weather, speed and
other factors. Forward Collision Warning does not
include a braking function. It is always your
responsibility to safely operate the vehicle and avoid
collisions.
You can change the Forward Collision Warning
Distance setting or turn the system on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 136
The camera is shared with Lane Departure Warning,
Traffic Sign Recognition System * and High beam
Support System.
Far
Normal
Driving
Near
Your Vehicle
1Forward Collision Warning *
Vehicle Ahead
For the system’s proper operation:
• Do not impact the camera or the area around the
camera when you clean the windscreen.
• Keep the upper windscreen clean. Wipe away any
debris including ice and frost.
Consult a dealer in the following cases.
• The camera or the area around the camera is
severely impacted.
• The area around the windscreen needs repair.
438
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
439 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning *
1Forward Collision Warning *
The camera is located behind
the rearview mirror.
* Not available on all models
Driving
Beep
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windscreen that could obstruct the Forward Collision
Warning camera’s field of vision.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the
windscreen within the Forward Collision Warning
camera’s field of vision can cause the system to
operate abnormally. If this occurs, we recommend
that you replace the windscreen with a genuine
Honda replacement windscreen. Making even minor
repairs within the camera’s field of vision or installing
an aftermarket replacement windscreen may also
cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windscreen, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the
Forward Collision Warning camera is necessary for
the system to operate properly.
The beeper sounds and the
message
appears in the multi-information display
until a possible collision is avoided.
Continued
439
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
440 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning *
■ Automatic shutoff
Forward Collision Warning may automatically shut itself off and the
indicator
comes and stays on when:
• The temperature inside the system is high.
• The windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
Once the conditions that caused Forward Collision Warning to shut off improve or
are addressed (e.g., cleaning), the system comes back on.
1Automatic shutoff
To help to reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut
off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front
of the vehicle away from the sun.
If you use a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to
cover the camera housing. Covering the camera can
concentrate heat on the camera.
Driving
If the
message appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the demister mode when
windows are fogged.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen
temperature, which cools down the area around
the Forward Collision Warning camera.
If the
message appears:
Park your vehicle in a safe place. Wipe away debris
blocking the windscreen, then start driving again. If
the message remains on even after driving for a while
with the clean windscreen, have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
440
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
441 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguForward Collision Warning *
■ Forward Collision Warning Limitations
Forward Collision Warning may not activate or may not detect a vehicle in front of
your vehicle, and may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you,
or when there is no vehicle ahead, under the following conditions.
Condition
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Driving
●
The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you.
When either your vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you accelerates rapidly.
The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, a small vehicle, or a unique vehicle such as a tractor.
When you drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an extended period that makes it difficult for the camera to properly
detect a vehicle in front of you.
When there are pedestrians or animals in front of your vehicle.
When you drive in bad weather (rain, fog, etc.).
A heavy load in the rear or modifications to the suspension tilts your vehicle.
An abnormal tyre condition is detected (wrong tyre size, flat tyre, etc.).
When the windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
When the temperature inside the system is high.
A sudden change between light and dark such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
You drive into the sunlight (e.g. at dawn or dusk).
When the windscreen is dirty or cloudy.
When streetlights are perceived as the taillight of a vehicle in front of yours.
When driving at night, the vehicle ahead of you is running with either taillight bulb burned out.
When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
When your vehicle is towing a trailer.
441
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
442 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning *
Lane Departure Warning *
Alerts you when the system detects a possibility of your vehicle unintentionally
crossing over left or right side lane markings.
■ How the System Works
If your vehicle is getting too close to detected
left or right side lane markings without a turn
signal activated, Lane Departure Warning will
give audible and visual alerts.
The beeper sounds and the
message
appears on the multi-information display,
letting you know that you need to take
appropriate action.
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, Lane Departure Warning
has limitations.
Over-reliance on Lane Departure Warning may result
in a collision. It is always your responsibility to keep
the vehicle within your driving lane.
Lane Departure Warning only alerts you when lane
drift is detected without a turn signal in use. Lane
Departure Warning may not detect all lane markings
or lane departures; accuracy will vary based on
weather, speed and lane marker condition. It is
always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
Driving
The Lane Departure Warning may not work properly
or may work improperly under the certain conditions:
2 Lane Departure Warning Conditions and
Limitations P. 444
■ How the System Activates
The system begins to search for lane markings when all the following conditions are
met:
• The vehicle is travelling above about 72 km/h (45 mph).
• The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
442
1Lane Departure Warning *
* Not available on all models
1How the System Activates
Lane Departure Warning may automatically shut off
and the
indicator comes and stays on.
2 Indicators P. 107
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
443 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning *
■ Lane Departure Warning Camera
Camera
1Lane Departure Warning Camera
The camera is located behind the rearview
mirror.
■ Lane Departure Warning On and Off
Buttons
Do not place an object on the top of the instrument
panel. It may reflect onto the windscreen and prevent
the system from detecting lane lines properly.
Driving
Indicators
Press the Lane Departure Warning button to
turn the system on and off.
u The indicator in the button comes on
when the system is on.
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windscreen that could obstruct the Lane Departure
Warning camera’s field of vision.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the
windscreen within the Lane Departure Warning
camera’s field of vision can cause the system to
operate abnormally. If this occurs, we recommend
that you replace the windscreen with a genuine
Honda replacement windscreen. Making even minor
repairs within the camera’s field of vision or installing
an aftermarket replacement windscreen may also
cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windscreen, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the Lane
Departure Warning camera is necessary for the
system to operate properly.
To help to reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera system to shut
off, when parking, find a shady area or face the front
of the vehicle away from the sun.
If you use a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to
cover the camera housing. Covering the camera can
concentrate heat on the camera.
Continued
443
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
444 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning *
■ Lane Departure Warning Conditions and Limitations
The system may not properly detect lane markings and the position of your vehicle
under certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below.
■ Environmental conditions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving
444
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the front windscreen.
1Lane Departure Warning Camera
If the
message appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, the demister mode when
windows are fogged.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen
temperature, which cools down the area around
the Lane Departure Warning camera.
If the
message appears:
Park your vehicle in a safe place. Wipe away debris
blocking the windscreen, then start driving again. If
the message remains on even after driving for a while
with the clean windscreen, have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
445 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguLane Departure Warning *
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
• The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
• When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognised as white
lines (or yellow lines).
• When driving on roads with double lines.
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windscreen is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windscreen is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too hot.
• An abnormal tyre or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tyre *, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
• When tyre chains are installed.
* Not available on all models
Driving
■ Vehicle conditions
445
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
446 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
Traffic Sign Recognition System *
Reminds you of road sign information, such as the current speed limit and that
overtaking is prohibited, your vehicle has just passed through, showing it on the
multi-information display.
■ How the System Works
When the camera located behind the rearview mirror captures traffic signs while
driving, the system displays the ones that are recognised as designated for your
vehicle. The sign icon will be displayed for a while, then until the vehicle reaches a
predetermined time and distance.
Driving
The sign icon also may switch to another one, or disappear when:
• The end of speed limit or other designated limit is detected.
• Your vehicle enters/exists motorway or highway.
• You make a turn with a turn signal to change direction at an intersection.
446
* Not available on all models
1Traffic Sign Recognition System *
The system is designed to detect signs that follow the
Vienna Convention standards. Not all signs may be
displayed, but any signs posted on roadsides should
not be ignored. The system does not work on the
designated traffic signs of all the countries you travel,
nor in all situations.
Do not rely too much on the system. Always drive at
speeds appropriate for the road conditions.
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windscreen that could obstruct the camera’s field of
vision and cause the system to operate abnormally.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the
windscreen within the camera’s field of vision can
cause the system to operate abnormally. If this
occurs, we recommend that you replace the
windscreen with a genuine Honda replacement
windscreen. Making even minor repairs within the
camera’s field of vision or installing an aftermarket
replacement windscreen may also cause the system
to operate abnormally. After replacing the
windscreen, have a dealer recalibrate the camera.
Proper calibration of the camera is necessary for the
system to operate properly.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
447 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
While driving, in addition to when there is no detected sign, you may also see the
below screen when.
1Traffic Sign Recognition System *
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera’s sensing system
to shut off, when parking, find a shady area or face
the front of the vehicle away from the sun. If you use
a reflective sun shade, do not allow it to cover the
camera housing.
Covering the camera can concentrate heat on it.
If
appears, the traffic sign recognition system
does not work, and
will be displayed.
Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the
windscreen. If the message does not disappear after
you have cleaned the windscreen and driven for a
while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Driving
If
appears, the traffic sign recognition system
does not work, and
will be displayed.
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, also use demister mode
with the air flow directed towards the camera.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windscreen
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
447
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
448 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
■ Traffic Sign Recognition System Conditions and Limitations
The traffic sign recognition system may not be able to recognize the traffic sign in
the following cases.
■ Vehicle conditions
•
•
•
•
•
Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
The outside of the windscreen is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
The inside of the windscreen is fogged.
There are portions remaining to be wiped.
An abnormal tyre or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tyre *, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
■ Environmental conditions
Driving
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
When you drive in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Driving at night, in dark areas such as long tunnels.
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
A vehicle in front of you is travelling flying up spray or snow.
448
* Not available on all models
1Traffic Sign Recognition System Conditions and Limitations
When the traffic sign recognition system
malfunctions, appears on the multi-information
display. If this message does not disappear, have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
449 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
■ The position or the condition of the traffic sign
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
A sign is hard to be found since it is in a complicated area.
A sign is located far away from your vehicle.
A sign is located where the beam of the headlight is hard to reach.
A sign is on a corner or bend in the road.
Faded or bent signs.
Rotated or damaged signs.
A sign is covered with mud, snow, or frost.
A part of the sign is hidden by the trees, or the sign itself is hidden by a vehicle
and others.
• Light (a streetlight) or a shadow is reflected on the surface of the sign.
• A sign is too bright or too dark (an electric sign).
• A sign of a small size.
■ Other conditions
Driving
• When you are driving at a high speed.
Continued
449
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
450 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
Driving
450
The traffic sign recognition system may not operate correctly, such as displaying a
sign that does not follow the actual regulation for the roadway or does not exist at
all in the following cases.
u Regarding the speed limit sign, it may display higher or lower speed than the
actual speed limit.
• There is a supplementary sign with further information such as weather, time,
vehicle type, etc.
• Figures on the sign are hard to read (electric sign, numbers on the sign are
blurred).
• A sign is in the vicinity of the lane you are driving even though it is not for the lane
(speed limit sign situated at the junction between the side road and the main
road, etc.).
• There are things that look similar to the colour or shape of the recognition object
(similar sign, electric sign, signboard, structure, etc.).
• A lorry and others stuck with the sticker of the speed limit sign on the back are
travelling in front of you.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
451 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
■ Signs Displayed on the Multi-Information Display
Two traffic signs can be simultaneously displayed next to each other when detected.
The speed limit sign icon is displayed on the right half of the screen. The overtaking
prohibition sign icon appears on the left. Any additional sign that indicates speed
limit based on weather (rain, snow, etc.) or specific period of time can appear on
either side.
■ When main mode is selected
Speed Limit
Sign
Additional
Speed Limit
Sign Based on
Conditions*2
Speed Limit
Sign
Driving
Overtaking
Prohibition
Sign*1
■ When main mode is not selected
Overtaking
Prohibition
Sign*1
Speed Limit Sign
Depending on situation, *1 can be replaced with *2, or *2 can appear on the right
side.
Continued
451
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
452 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguTraffic Sign Recognition System *
■ Selecting to display traffic signs when main mode is off
You can continue displaying reduced-size traffic sign icon on the multi-information
display even while the main mode is not selected.
2 Customized Features P. 136
Driving
452
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
453 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
Helps to stabilise the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less than
what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces. It does
so by regulating engine output and selectively applying the brakes.
■ VSA Operation
VSA System
Indicator
When VSA activates, you may notice that the
engine does not respond to the accelerator.
You may also notice some noise from the
hydraulic system. You will also see the
indicator blink.
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
VSA may not function properly if tyre types and sizes
are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and type
of tyre, and the air pressures are as specified.
When the VSA system indicator comes on and stays
on while driving, there may be a problem with the
system. While this may not interfere with normal
driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
VSA cannot enhance stability in all driving situations
and does not control the entire braking system. You
still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate
for the conditions and always leave a sufficient
margin of safety.
Driving
Continued
453
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
454 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
■ VSA OFF Button
VSA OFF Indicator
1Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
This button is on the driver side control panel.
To partically turn the VSA features on and off,
press and hold it until you hear a beep.
The traction control stops fully functioning,
allows the wheels to spin more freely at low
speed. The VSA OFF indicator will also come
on.
To turn it on again, press the
button until you hear a beep.
(VSA OFF)
Driving
VSA is turned on every time you start the
engine, even if you turned it off the last time
you drove the vehicle.
With the
button pressed, your vehicle will have
normal braking and cornering ability, but VSA
traction and stability enhancement becomes less
effective.
In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets
stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the VSA temporarily switched off.
When the
button is pressed, the traction control
function becomes less effective. This allows for the
wheels to spin more freely at low speed. You should
only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA off if
you are not able to free it when the VSA is on.
Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to
switch VSA on again. We do not recommend driving
your vehicle with the VSA system switched off.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
454
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
455 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguDeflation Warning System
Deflation Warning System
Instead of directly measuring the pressure in each tyre, the deflation warning system
on this vehicle monitors and compares the rolling radius and rotational
characteristics of each wheel and tyre while you are driving to determine if one or
more tyres are significantly under-inflated. This will cause the low tyre pressure/
deflation warning system indicator to come on and a message to appear on the
multi-information display.
■ Deflation Warning System Calibration
The system does not monitor the tyres when driving
at low speed.
Conditions such as low ambient temperature and
altitude change directly affect tyre pressure and can
trigger the low tyre pressure/deflation warning
system indicator to come on.
Tyre pressure checked and inflated in:
• Warm weather can become under-inflated in
colder weather.
• Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer
weather.
The low tyre pressure indicator will not come on as a
result of over inflation.
You must start deflation warning system calibration every time you:
• Adjust the pressure in one or more tyres.
• Rotate the tyres.
• Replace one or more tyres.
Make sure:
• The vehicle is at a complete stop.
Driving
The deflation warning system may not function
properly if tyre types and sizes are mixed.
Make sure to use the same size and type of tyre.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 534
Before calibrating the deflation warning system:
• Set the cold tyre pressure in all four tyres.
The low tyre pressure/deflation warning system
indicator may come on with a delay or may not come
on at all when:
• You rapidly accelerate, decelerate, or turn the
steering wheel.
• You drive on snowy or slippery roads.
• Snow chains are used.
Manual transmission models
• The parking brake is applied.
Continuously variable transmission models
• The shift lever is in (P .
All models
• The ignition switch is in ON (w *1.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
1Deflation Warning System
Continued
The low tyre pressure/deflation warning system
indicator may come on under the following conditions:
• A compact spare tyre * is used.
• There is a heavier and uneven load on the tyres, such as
when towing a trailer, than the condition at calibration.
• Snow chains are used.
455
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
456 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguDeflation Warning System
Driving
You can calibrate the system from the
customized features on the multi-information
display.
1. Press the
button until
(customize settings) appears on the display,
then press the SEL/RESET button.
2. Press the
button until Deflation
Warning System appears on the display.
3. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select Cancel or Initialise.
4. Press the
button and select
Initialise, then press the SEL/RESET
button.
u Completed screen appears, then the
display returns to the customization
menu screen.
• The calibration process finishes
automatically.
456
* Not available on all models
1Deflation Warning System Calibration
• Deflation Warning System cannot be calibrated if a
compact spare tyre * is installed.
• The calibration process requires approximately 30
minutes of cumulative driving at speeds between
40−100 km/h (25−62 mph).
• During this period, if the ignition is turned on and
the vehicle is not moved within 45 seconds, you
may notice the low tyre pressure indicator comes
on briefly. This is normal and indicates that the
calibration process is not yet complete.
If the snow chains are installed, remove them before
calibrating the deflation warning system.
If the low tyre pressure/deflation warning system
indicator comes on even when the properly inflated
specified regular tyres are installed, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
We recommend that the tyres be replaced with the
same brand, model, and size as the originals. Ask a
dealer for details.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
457 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen DrivinguAdjusting Headlight Distribution
Models with halogen low beam headlights
Adjusting Headlight Distribution
1Adjusting Headlight Distribution
Driving the right-hand type vehicle in right-hand traffic, or the left-hand type vehicle
in left-hand traffic causes headlight glare to oncoming vehicles. You need to alter
the headlight beam distribution using masking tape.
Right-hand drive type vehicle
Left-hand drive type vehicle
48 mm (1.9 in)
48 mm (1.9 in)
15 mm 20 mm
(0.6 in) (0.8 in)
34.8 mm
(1.37 in)
38.7 mm (1.52 in)
Centre
point
20 mm 15 mm
(0.8 in) (0.6 in)
Centre
point
38.7 mm (1.52 in)
48 mm (1.9 in)
15 mm 20 mm
(0.6 in) (0.8 in)
38.7 mm (1.52 in)
34.8 mm
(1.37 in)
Driving
48 mm (1.9 in)
34.8 mm
(1.37 in)
Be careful not to adhere the tape to an incorrect
location. If the headlight beam is distributed
incorrectly, it may not comply with your country’s
legal requirements. Ask a dealer for details.
Centre
point
20 mm 15 mm
(0.8 in) (0.6 in)
Centre
point
34.8 mm
(1.37 in)
38.7 mm (1.52 in)
1. Prepare for two pieces of masking tape as shown.
u Use masking tape that can shut out light, such as seal type waterproof vinyl.
2. Affix the tape to the lens as shown.
457
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
458 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Braking
Brake System
■ Parking Brake
Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parked. You can
manually apply and release, or automatically release it.
■ Manual operations
Driving
Use the electric parking brake switch to apply or release the brake. Manually
releasing the parking brake using the switch helps your vehicle start slowly and
smoothly when facing down hill on steep hills.
■ To apply manually
Pull the electric parking brake switch up gently
and securely.
u The electric parking brake indicator
comes on.
u When the ignition switch is in LOCK
(0 *1, the electric parking brake indicator
comes on for 15 seconds when you pull
Electric Parking
up the electric parking brake switch if the
Brake Switch
electric parking brake has been already
applied.
■ To release manually
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Press the electric parking brake switch.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
Electric Parking
Brake Switch
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
458
1Parking Brake
You may hear the electric parking brake system
operating from the rear wheel area when you apply
or release the parking brake, or turn the ignition
switch to LOCK (0 *1. This is normal.
The brake pedal may slightly move due to the electric
parking brake system operation when you apply or
release the parking brake. This is normal.
You cannot apply or release the parking brake if the
battery goes dead.
2 Jump Starting P. 579
The parking brake is applied while the vehicle is
moving with the electric parking brake switch being
pulled.
In the following situations, the parking brake
automatically operates.
• When the vehicle stops with the automatic brake
hold system activated for more than 10 minutes.
• When the vehicle stops with the automatic brake
hold system activated and the driver’s seat belt is
unlatched.
• When the vehicle stops with the automatic brake
hold system activated and the ignition switch is
turned to LOCK (0 *1.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
459 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ To release automatically
1Parking Brake
Use the accelerator pedal to release the brake when you are starting the vehicle
facing uphill, or in a traffic jam.
Continuously variable transmission models
Depressing the accelerator pedal releases the parking brake.
Manual transmission models
Depressing the accelerator pedal while releasing the clutch pedal releases the
parking brake.
Accelerator Pedal
Continuously variable transmission models
Continued
The parking brake cannot be released automatically
while the following indicators are on:
• Malfunction indicator lamp
• Transmission indicator
The parking brake may not be released automatically
while the following indicators are on:
• Electric parking brake system indicator
• VSA system indicator
• ABS indicator
• Supplemental restraint system indicator
Driving
Gently depress the accelerator pedal.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
You can release the parking brake
automatically when:
• You are wearing the driver’s seat belt.
• The engine is running.
• The shift lever is in any position other than
(P or (N .
If the parking brake cannot be released
automatically, release it manually.
459
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
460 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguBrake System
Accelerator Pedal
Manual transmission models
Gently depress the accelerator pedal and
release the clutch pedal.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes
off.
You can release the parking brake
automatically when:
• You are wearing the driver’s seat belt.
• The engine is running.
• The shift lever is in any position other than
(N .
• The clutch pedal is fully depressed, and the
clutch pedal is released after the accelerator
pedal is gently depressed.
Driving
■ Foot Brake
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A vacuum power assist
helps to reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The brake assist system
increases the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an
emergency situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you to retain steering
control when braking very hard.
2 Brake Assist System P. 465
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 464
1Foot Brake
Check the brakes after driving through deep water,
or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If
necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the
pedal several times.
If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when
applying the brakes, the brake pads need to be
replaced. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a
long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake
effectiveness. Apply engine braking by taking your
foot off the accelerator pedal and downshifting to a
lower speed position. With manual transmission use
a lower gear for greater engine braking.
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause
them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad
life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.
460
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
461 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ Automatic Brake Hold
1Automatic Brake Hold
3 WARNING
Continuously variable transmission models
Keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal until the accelerator pedal is
pressed. You can use this system while the vehicle is temporarily stopped, such as
when you stop at a traffic light.
■ Turning on the system
■ Activating the system
On
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
On
On
On
Goes
Off
Brake Pedal
Depress the brake pedal
to come to a complete
stop. The shift lever must
be in other than (P or (R .
● The automatic brake
hold indicator comes
on. Braking is kept for
up to 10 minutes.
● Release the brake pedal
after the automatic
brake hold indicator
comes on.
Accelerator Pedal
Depress the accelerator
pedal while the shift
lever is in other than (P
or (N . The system is
cancelled and the vehicle
starts to move.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator goes
off. The system
releases the brake
automatically.
If a vehicle unexpectedly moves, it may
cause a crash resulting in serious injury or
death.
Never activate the automatic brake hold
system or rely on it to keep a vehicle from
moving when stopped on a steep hill or
slippery roads.
3 WARNING
Using the automatic brake hold system to
park the vehicle may result in the vehicle
unexpectedly moving.
Driving
Fasten your seat belt
properly, then start the
engine. Press the
automatic brake hold
button.
● The automatic brake
hold system indicator
comes on. The system
is turned on.
■ Cancelling the system
Activating the automatic brake hold system
on steep hills or slippery roads may still
allow the vehicle to move if you remove
your foot from the brake pedal.
If a vehicle moves unexpectedly, it may
cause a crash, resulting in serious injury or
death.
Never leave the vehicle when braking is
temporarily kept by automatic brake hold
and always park the vehicle by putting the
transmission in (P and applying the parking
brake.
Continued
461
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
462 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguBrake System
Manual transmission models
Keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal until you shift into one of
the gears other than (N and:
• Release the clutch pedal on a level road or when facing downhill.
• Release the clutch pedal and depress the accelerator pedal when facing uphill.
You can use this system while the vehicle is temporarily stopped, such as when you
stop at a traffic light.
■ Turning on the system
■ Activating the system
On
On
On
Goes
Off
Depress the brake pedal
to come to a complete
stop.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator comes
on. Braking is kept for
up to 10 minutes.
● Release the brake
pedal after the
automatic brake hold
indicator comes on.
Shift into one of the gears
other than (N and:
● Release the clutch
pedal on a level road or
when facing downhill.
● Release the clutch
pedal and depress the
accelerator pedal when
facing uphill.
The system is cancelled
and the vehicle starts to
move.
● The automatic brake
hold indicator goes off.
The system releases the
brake automatically.
On
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
Driving
462
Fasten your seat belt
properly, then start the
engine. Press the
automatic brake hold
button.
● The automatic brake
hold system indicator
comes on. The system
is turned on.
■ Cancelling the system
Brake Pedal
Accelerator Pedal
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
463 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ The system automatically cancels when:
• You engage the parking brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
• You depress the brake pedal and move the shift lever to (P or (R .
Under the following conditions, the system automatically cancels, and the parking
brake is applied:
• Braking is kept for more than 10 minutes.
• The driver’s seat belt is unfastened.
• The engine is turned off.
• There is a problem with automatic brake hold system.
Manual transmission models
• The engine stalls while the automatic brake hold is active except during the Auto
Idle Stop is in operation.
Goes
Off
Automatic Brake
Hold Button
While the system is on, press the automatic
brake hold button again.
u The automatic brake hold system
indicator goes off.
If you want to turn off automatic brake hold
while the system is in operation, press the
automatic brake hold button with the brake
pedal depressed.
While the system is activated, you can turn off the
engine or park the vehicle through the same
procedure as you normally do.
2 When Stopped P. 472
Whether the system is on, or the system is activated,
the automatic brake hold turns off once the engine is
off.
Manual transmission models
The system turns off if the engine stalls while
automatic brake hold is active or the system is on.
The system turns on again once the engine
automatically restarts.
2 Starting to Drive P. 399, 402
1Turning on the system
Make sure to turn off the automatic brake hold
system before using an automated car wash.
Driving
■ Turning off the automatic brake hold system
1Automatic Brake Hold
You may hear an operating noise if the vehicle moves
while the automatic brake hold system is in
operation. The system generates sound while holding
the vehicle and it moves.
463
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
464 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguAnti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
■ ABS
Helps to prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you to retain steering
control by pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also
balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as
“stomp and steer.”
■ ABS operation
Driving
The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Keep holding the
pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to press on the brake pedal very
hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel the ABS activate immediately
if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
When the vehicle speed goes under 10 km/h (6 mph), the ABS stops.
1Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
NOTICE
The ABS may not function correctly if you use an
incorrect tyre type and size.
When the ABS indicator comes on while driving,
there may be a problem with the system.
While normal braking is not affected, there is a
possibility of the ABS not operating. Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
The ABS does not reduce the time or distance it takes
to stop the vehicle. It only helps with steering control
during hard braking.
In the following cases, your vehicle may need more
stopping distance than a vehicle without the ABS:
• When driving on rough road surfaces, including
when driving on uneven surfaces, such as gravel or
snow.
• When tyre chains are installed.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
464
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
465 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguBrake Assist System
Brake Assist System
■ Brake Assist System
Designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress
the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.
■ Brake assist system operation
Depress the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.
When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise
may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.
Driving
465
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
466 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguCity-Brake Active system
City-Brake Active system
Can assist you when driving at a low speed, and there is a possibility of your vehicle
colliding with a vehicle detected right in front of yours. The City-Brake Active system
is designed to alert you when a potential collision is determined, as well as to reduce
your vehicle speed when a collision is deemed unavoidable to help to minimise
collision severity.
■ How the System Works
A laser sensor starts to monitor if there is a vehicle in front of you when your
vehicle speed is between about 5 km/h (3 mph) and about 32 km/h (20 mph).
Driving
Laser Sensor
The laser sensor is behind
the rearview mirror.
The system activates when the speed difference between your vehicle and a
vehicle detected in front of you is about 5 km/h (3 mph) to 32 km/h (20 mph) with
a high chance of collision.
The system don’t activate when shift position is (R .
466
1City-Brake Active system
3 WARNING
Do not rely on the city-brake active system
to avoid every possible frontal collision.
Failure to pay close attention to a vehicle
ahead of you, and to operate the brake
pedal appropriately according to the
situation can cause serious injury or death.
For the system to work properly:
• Always keep the upper part of the windscreen
clean. Wipe away any dirt, ice, frost, etc.
• Do not impact the area around the laser sensor
when cleaning the windscreen.
• Do not remove the laser sensor form the unit.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
467 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguCity-Brake Active system
■ Collision Alert Stages
1City-Brake Active system
The beeper sounds, and a
blinks on the
multi-information display, and hard braking is
applied when a possible collision becomes
likely unavoidable.
This automatic braking with the system
activated is cancelled after the vehicle comes
to a complete stop.
Apply the brakes accordingly.
A message indicating that the system has
activated appears on the multi-information
display after the vehicle is stopped.
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and
Information Messages P. 110
Driving
The system may be cancelled if you operate
the brake pedal, the accelerator pedal, or the
steering wheel to avoid the collision.
The system may not activate or may not detect a
vehicle in front of your vehicle under the following
conditions:
• A vehicle in front of you is diagonally, horizontally,
or frontally positioned.
• The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle
ahead of you is too short.
• The speed difference between your vehicle and a
vehicle ahead of you is large.
• A vehicle cuts in front of you, and brakes suddenly.
• You rapidly accelerate your vehicle, getting closer
to a vehicle ahead.
• An oncoming vehicle suddenly drifts in front of you.
• Your vehicle suddenly drifts into the oncoming lane.
• A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you at
intersections.
• When driving in bad weather (heavy rain, fog,
snow, etc.).
• When driving on a curved or winding road.
• A vehicle in front of you is extremely dirty, making
it difficult to reflect radio waves well.
• You depress the brake pedal or turn the steering
wheel to avoid a collision.
• A vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle or other
small vehicle the sensor cannot detect properly.
• The upper part of the windscreen around the laser
sensor is covered with dirt, ice frost, etc.
The system may not activate wile you are fully
depressing the accelerator pedal.
Continued
467
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
468 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguCity-Brake Active system
■ The System On and Off
1City-Brake Active system
You can turn the system on and off using the
multi-information display.
2 Customized Features P. 136
When the system is off, the CTBA indicator in
the instrument panel comes on.
City-Brake Active system is turned on every
time you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1,
even if you turned it off the last time you
drove the vehicle.
The system may automatically shut off, and the CTBA
indicator can come on and the message can appear
on the multi-information display when:
• The temperature around the laser sensor on the
upper part of the windscreen becomes high.
• The area around the laser sensor, which is located
in the upper part of the windscreen, is covered with
obstacles, such as dirt, ice and frost.
• The bonnet is covered with obstacles such as snow.
Stop your vehicle in a safe place, and
• Use the air conditioning system to cool down the
interior if the laser sensor temperature is high.
• Remove any obstacles such as dirt and snow from
Driving
the windscreen and bonnet.
2 Indicators P. 108
Once the conditions that caused the system to shut
off improve, the system comes back on.
Turn off the system when:
• You use a dynamometer or put the wheels on a
roller.
• Driving off road or on a mountainous road
obstructed with branches and leaves.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
468
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
469 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguCity-Brake Active system
■ With Little Chance of a Collision
1City-Brake Active system
The system may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you, or
when there is no vehicle ahead. Some examples of this are:
■ When passing
Your vehicle approaches another vehicle ahead of you and you change lanes to pass.
■ At an intersection
Your vehicle approaches or passes another vehicle that is making a left or right turn.
■ Through a low bridge
You drive under a low or narrow bridge.
■ Speed bumps, road work sites, train tracks, roadside objects, etc.
Do not alter your vehicle’s suspension.
Changing the vehicle height prevents the system to
work properly.
Make sure to use the same size and type of tyre for all
four wheels. Use the tyres that are all in about the
same condition with adequate tread. If not, the
system may operate abnormally.
The system may not work properly if:
• Your vehicle has heavy load in the rear.
• Tyres are over- or underinflated.
Driving
You drive over speed bumps, steel road plates, etc., or your vehicle approaches train
tracks or roadside objects, such as a traffic sign and guard rail, on a curve.
Take your vehicle to a dealer if you need the laser
sensor or area around it to be repaired, or removed,
or the area around the laser sensor is strongly
impacted.
■ When parking
Your vehicle approaches a stationary vehicle or wall.
Continued
469
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
470 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguCity-Brake Active system
■ About the Laser Equipped in the System
Laser Sensor
The City-Brake Active system unit, including
the laser sensor, is located behind the
rearview mirror.
Following lists the classified specifications of the laser used in this system according
to the IEC requirements. The same information can be found in the IEC60825-1
standard labels.
Driving
Laser classification
Max average power:
45 mW
Pulse duration:
33 ns
Wavelength:
905 nm
Average power angle
28 × 12
(horizontal × vertical)
Laser Classification
Label
Laser Explanation
Label
470
1City-Brake Active system
3 WARNING
Handling the laser sensor improperly can
lead to eye injury.
To avoid eye injury, Keep the following:
• Do not take the sensor apart from the
unit.
• Never look at the sensor within a 100 mm
distance using an optical device, such as a
magnified glass, microscopes, and an
object lens.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
471 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBrakinguEmergency Stop Signal
Emergency Stop Signal
Activates when you brake hard while driving at 60 km/h (37 mph) or above to alert
drivers behind you about sudden braking by rapidly flashing hazard warning lights.
This may help to alert drivers behind you to take appropriate means to avoid a
possible collision with your vehicle.
■ When the system activates:
Hard Braking
1Emergency Stop Signal
The emergency stop signal is not a system that can
prevent a possible rear-end collision caused by your
hard braking. It flashes the hazard warning lights at
the time you are braking hard. It is always
recommended to avoid hard braking unless it is
absolutely necessary.
The emergency stop signal does not activate with the
hazard warning button pressed in.
Brake Lights Come On
Hazard Warning Lights Flash
The hazard warning lights stop flashing when:
• You release the brake pedal.
• The ABS is deactivated.
• Your vehicle’s decelerating speed becomes moderate.
• You press the hazard warning button.
Driving
Hazard Warning Indicators Blink
If the ABS stops working for a certain period of the
during braking, the emergency stop signal may not
activate at all.
471
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
472 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped
1. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
2. With the brake pedal depressed, pull up the electric parking brake switch slowly,
but fully.
Continuously variable transmission models
1Parking Your Vehicle
Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects,
such as dry grass, oil, or timber.
Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.
3. Move the shift lever from (D to (P .
Manual transmission models
3. Move the shift lever to (R or (1 .
Diesel models
4. Keep idling the engine for about 10 seconds.
All models
5. Turn off the engine.
u The electric parking brake indicator goes off in about 15 seconds.
Driving
Always confirm the electric parking brake is set, in particular if you are parked on an
incline.
1When Stopped
NOTICE
Continuously variable transmission models
The following can damage the transmission:
• Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals
simultaneously.
• Holding the vehicle in place when facing uphill by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
• Moving the shift lever into (P before the vehicle
stops completely.
Raise the wiper arms when snow is expected.
To prevent the parking brake from freezing when the
outside temperature is extremely cold, do not apply
it.
Use a block or other wheel chock to prevent the
wheels from turning.
Diesel models
Keep idling the engine for a few minutes if your
vehicle has towed a trailer.
The engine idling may be prohibited in some
countries. Check and follow your local legal
requirements.
472
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
473 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
Parking Sensor System *
The corner and centre sensors monitor obstacles behind your vehicle, and the
beeper, audio/information screen and multi-information display let you know the
approximate distance between your vehicle and the obstacle.
■ The sensor location and range
Front Corner Sensors
Front Centre Sensors
Rear Centre Sensors
Rear Corner Sensors
1Parking Sensor System *
Even when the system is on, always confirm if there is
no obstacle near your vehicle before parking.
The system may not work properly when:
• The sensors are covered with snow, ice, mud, or
dirt.
• The vehicle is on uneven surface, such as grass,
bumps, or a hill.
• The vehicle has been out in hot or cold weather.
• The system is affected by some electronic devices
that generate ultrasonic wave.
• Driving in bad weather.
The system may not sense:
or sponge.
Within about 60 cm (24 in) or less
Front: Within about 100 cm (39 in) or less
Rear: Within about 110 cm (43 in) or less
* Not available on all models
Continued
• Objects directly under the bumper.
Driving
• Thin or low objects.
• Sonic-absorptive materials, such as snow, cotton,
Do not put any accessories on or around the sensors.
473
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
474 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Parking sensor system on and off
With the ignition switch in ON (w *1, press the
parking sensor system button to turn on or off
the system. The indicator in the button comes
on when the system is on.
The front corner and front centre sensors start
to detect an obstacle when the shift lever is in
any position other than (P or (R , and the
vehicle speed is less than 8 km/h (5 mph).
The front corner, rear corner and rear centre
sensors start to detect an obstacle when the
shift lever is in (R , and the vehicle speed is less
than less than 8 km/h (5 mph).
Driving
Manual transmission models
You also need to release the parking brake.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
474
1Parking sensor system on and off
When you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1, the
system will be in the previously selected condition.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
475 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ When the distance between your vehicle and obstacles behind becomes shorter
Length of the
intermittent beep
Distance between the bumper and obstacle
Audio/information screen
Multi-information display
Indicator
Corner sensors
Centre sensors
Front: About 100-60 cm
(39-24 inches)
Rear: About 110-60 cm
(43-24 inches)
Moderate
—
Short
About 60-45 cm
(24-18 inches)
About 60-45 cm
(24-18 inches)
Very short
About 45-35 cm
(18-14 inches)
About 45-35 cm
(18-14 inches)
Continuous
About 35 cm (14 inches)
or less
About 35 cm (14 inches)
or less
Audio/information screen
Blinks in yellow
*1
Blinks in amber
Indicators light where the
sensor detects an obstacle.
Driving
Blinks in red
Multi-information display
Indicators light where the
sensor detects an obstacle.
*1:At this stage, only the centre sensors detect obstacles.
Continued
475
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
476 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Turning off All Rear Sensors
1. Make sure that the parking sensor system is not activated. Turn the ignition
switch to LOCK (0 *1.
2. Press and hold the parking sensor system button, and turn the ignition switch to
ON (w *1.
3. Keep pressing the button for 10 seconds. Release the button when the indicator
in the button blinks.
4. Press the button again. The indicator in the button goes off.
u The beeper sounds twice. The rear sensors are now turned off.
To turn the rear sensors on again, follow the above procedure. The beeper sounds
three times when the rear sensors come back on.
Driving
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
476
1Turning off All Rear Sensors
When you shift to (R , the indicator in the parking
sensor system button blinks as a reminder that the
rear sensors have been turned off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
477 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Multi-View Rear Camera *
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view. The display
automatically changes to the rear view when the shift lever is moved to (R .
■ Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
Guidelines
Bumper
Wide View Mode
Normal View Mode
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before
reversing. Certain conditions (such as weather,
lighting, and high temperatures) may also restrict the
rear view. Do not rely on the rearview display which
does not give you all information about conditions at
the back of your vehicle.
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture,
use a soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free
of debris.
Camera
Top Down View Mode
Driving
Tailgate Open Range
Approx. 1 m (3.3 ft)
Approx. 2 m (6.6 ft)
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
Approx. 3 m (9.8 ft)
* Not available on all models
Continued
477
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
478 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMulti-View Rear Camera * uAbout Your Multi-View Rear Camera
You can view three different camera angles on the rearview display.
Touch the appropriate icon to switch the angle.
: Wide view
: Normal view
: Top down view
If the last used viewing mode is Wide or Normal, the same mode is selected the next
time you shift into (R . If Top Down View is last used before you turned off the
engine, Wide mode is selected next time you turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1 and
shift to (R .
When you select the
icon while the multi-view
rear camera is displayed, you can customize the
following items:
• Fixed Guideline
On: Guidelines appear when you shift into (R .
Off: Guidelines do not appear.
• Dynamic Guideline
On: Guidelines move according to the steering
wheel direction.
Off: Guidelines do not move.
• Display
You can change the Brightness, Contrast, Black
Level, Colour, and Tint settings for the multi-view
rear camera display.
Driving
You can also change the Fixed Guideline and
Dynamic Guideline settings with the customized
features.
2 Customized Features P. 322
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
478
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
479 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Refueling
Petrol models
Fuel Information
■ Fuel recommendation
Premium unleaded petrol, research octane number 95 or higher
Your vehicle is designed to operate on premium unleaded petrol with a research
octane of 95 or higher. If this octane grade is unavailable, regular unleaded petrol
with a research octane of 91 or higher may be used temporarily.
Use of regular unleaded petrol can cause metallic knocking noises in the engine and
will result in decreased engine performance. The long-term use of regular-grade
petrol can lead to engine damage.
■ Fuel tank capacity: 50 litres (11.0 Imp gal)
1Fuel Information
NOTICE
Use of petrol that contains lead presents the
following risks:
• Damage to the exhaust system including the
catalytic converter
• Damage to the engine and fuel system
• Detrimental effects on the engine and other
systems
Driving
Oxygenated Fuels
Oxygenated fuels are blended with petrol and
ethanol or ether compound. Your vehicle is also
designed to operate on oxygenated fuels containing
up to 10% ethanol by volume and up to 22% ETBE
by volume, based on the EN 228 standards. Consult a
dealer for more information.
479
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
480 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuRefuelinguFuel Information
Diesel models
Fuel Information
■ Fuel recommendation
EN 590 standard diesel fuel
Select the proper clean fuel of good quality according to the regional and climate
condition. Use of improper fuel can reduce engine power.
■ Fuel tank capacity: 50 litres (11.0 Imp gal)
Driving
480
1Fuel Information
NOTICE
Serious damage may occur if petrol is used in diesel
engines.
Your vehicle is not designed to use Biodiesel (pure or
high concentration more than specified by EN590).
Consult a dealer for more information.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
481 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
Petrol models
How to Refuel
1How to Refuel
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
rear.
2. Turn off the engine.
3. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle
under the dashboard at the driver’s side.
u The fuel fill door opens.
Fuel Fill Door
Release Handle
Pull
4. Remove the fuel fill cap slowly. If you hear a
release of air, wait until this stops, then turn
the knob slowly to open the fuel fill cap.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
Driving
Holder
Petrol is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
Do not continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
Cap
Cap
3 WARNING
5. Place the fuel fill cap in the holder.
6. Insert the filler nozzle fully.
u When the tank is full, the fuel nozzle will
click off automatically. This leaves space
in the fuel tank in case the fuel expands
with a change in the temperature.
7. After filling, replace the fuel fill cap,
tightening it until you hear it click at least
once.
u Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
481
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
482 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
Diesel models
How to Refuel
1How to Refuel
Your fuel tank is not equipped with a fuel filler cap. You can insert the diesel fuel
filler nozzle directly into the fuel filler neck. The tank seals itself again when you pull
out the filler nozzle.
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
rear.
2. Turn off the engine.
3. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle
under the driver's side lower outside corner
of the dashboard.
Pull
u The fuel fill door opens.
3 WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable and explosive. You
can be burned or seriously injured when
handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
Only a service station diesel fuel filler nozzle can be used.
Driving
4. Insert the filler nozzle fully.
u Keep the filler nozzle level.
u When the tank is full, the filler nozzle will
click off automatically.
u After filling, wait about 10 seconds
before removing the filler nozzle.
5. Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
Do not continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
If you have to refuel your vehicle from a portable
container, use the funnel provided with the vehicle.
2 Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container
P. 605
482
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
483 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Fuel Economy
Improving Fuel Economy
Fuel economy depends on several conditions, including driving conditions, your
driving habits, the condition of your vehicle, and loading. Depending on these and
other conditions, you may or may not achieve the rated fuel economy of this vehicle.
■ Maintenance and Fuel Economy
You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle.
Always maintain your vehicle according to the service reminder symbols displayed
on the multi-information display. On vehicles without service reminder system,
follow the maintenance schedule in the service book that came with your vehicle.
On vehicles without the service book, follow the maintenance schedule in this
owner’s manual. If necessary, consult your warranty booklet.
1Improving Fuel Economy
Direct calculation is the recommended method to
determine actual fuel consumed while driving.
100
Litres of
fuel
Kilometres
driven
Miles
driven
Gallons of
fuel
Miles per
Gallon
L per 100 km
2 Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
* Not available on all models
Driving
• Use engine oil with the viscosity recommended by the ACEA or API Certification
Seal.
• Maintain the specified tyre pressure.
• Do not load the vehicle with excess luggage.
• Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle's underside
adds weight and increases wind resistance.
483
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
484 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories
When installing accessories, check the following:
• Do not install accessories on the windscreen. They can obstruct your view and
delay your reaction to driving conditions.
• Do not install any accessories over areas marked SRS Airbag, on the sides or backs
of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows. Accessories
installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the vehicle’s
airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags deploy.
• Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with
proper operation of your vehicle.
2 Fuses P. 591
• Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for
assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.
Modifications
Driving
Do not modify your vehicle or use non-Honda components that can affect its
handling, stability, and reliability.
Overall vehicle performance can be affected. Always make sure all equipment is
properly installed and maintained, and that it meets your country’s and local
regulations.
484
1Accessories and Modifications
3 WARNING
Improper accessories or modifications can
affect your vehicle's handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a crash in which
you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner's
manual regarding accessories and
modifications.
When properly installed, mobile phones, alarms, twoway radios, radio antennas, and low-powered audio
systems should not interfere with your vehicle’s
computer controlled systems, such as your airbags
and anti-lock brakes.
Honda Genuine accessories are recommended to
ensure proper operation on your vehicle.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
485 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Maintenance
This chapter discusses basic maintenance.
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance ............ 486
Safety When Performing Maintenance .... 487
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance
Service ........................................... 488
About Your Maintenance Service ..... 488
Service Reminder System * ............... 489
Maintenance Schedule * ................... 494
Maintenance Under the Bonnet
Maintenance Items Under the Bonnet ..... 502
Opening the Bonnet ........................ 504
Recommended Engine Oil ........ 505, 506
Oil Check ......................................... 507
* Not available on all models
Adding Engine Oil............................ 509
Engine Coolant ........................ 510, 512
Transmission Fluid............................ 514
Brake/Clutch Fluid............................ 515
Refilling Window Washer Fluid......... 516
Fuel Filter ......................................... 516
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Regeneration * ................................. 517
Replacing Light Bulbs ....................... 519
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades.... 530
Checking and Maintaining Tyres
Checking Tyres ................................ 534
Wear Indicators ............................... 535
Tyre Service Life ............................... 535
Tyre and Wheel Replacement........... 536
Tyre Rotation ................................... 537
Snow Traction Devices ..................... 538
Battery............................................... 540
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery ........... 544
Climate Control System Maintenance .... 546
Cleaning
Interior Care .................................... 549
Exterior Care.................................... 551
485
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
486 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance
For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle
in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient
brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Refer to the service book that came with your vehicle/maintenance schedule in this
owner’s manual for detailed maintenance and inspection information.
2 Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
■ Types of Inspection and Maintenance
■ Daily inspections
Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when
refueling.
■ Periodic inspections
• Check the brake fluid level monthly.
2 Brake/Clutch Fluid P. 515
• Check the tyre pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tyres P. 534
Maintenance
• Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
486
* Not available on all models
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 519
• Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
2 Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 530
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
487 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuSafety When Performing Maintenance
Safety When Performing Maintenance
Some of the most important safety precautions are given here.
However, we cannot warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in
performing maintenance. Only you can decide whether or not you should perform
a given task.
■ Maintenance Safety
• To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
• Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the bonnet.
u Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them causing a fire.
• To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not petrol.
• Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the battery or
compressed air.
• Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
u Operate the engine only when there is sufficient ventilation.
• The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
u Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and
the engine is off.
• Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
u Make sure to let the engine and exhaust system cool thoroughly before
touching vehicle parts.
• Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
u Do not start the engine unless instructed, and keep your hands and limbs away
from moving parts.
u Do not open the bonnet while the Auto Idle Stop function is activated.
3 WARNING
Improperly maintaining this vehicle or
failing to correct a problem before driving
can cause a crash in which you can be
seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection and
maintenance recommendations and
schedules in this owner's manual/Service
Book.
3 WARNING
Failure to properly follow maintenance
instructions and precautions can cause you
to be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the procedures and
precautions in this owner's manual.
Maintenance
■ Vehicle Safety
1Safety When Performing Maintenance
487
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
488 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuParts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
The use of Honda genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Honda genuine parts are manufactured according to the
same high quality standards used in Honda vehicles.
1Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Diesel models
NOTICE
Do not press the engine cover forcibly. This may
damage the engine cover and component parts.
About Your Maintenance Service
If the service reminder system is available in your vehicle, you are informed by the
multi-information display when your vehicle's maintenance services are due. Refer
to the service book that came with your vehicle for an explanation of the service
item codes that appear on the display.
2 Service Reminder System * P. 489
If the service reminder system is not available, follow the maintenance schedules in
the service book that came with your vehicle.
Maintenance
488
If your vehicle is without the service book, follow the maintenance schedule in this
owner's manual.
2 Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
* Not available on all models
1About Your Maintenance Service
Models with service reminder system
If you are planning to take your vehicle outside the
service reminder system applied countries, consult a
dealer for how to record your service reminder
information and schedule your maintenance service
under the conditions of that country.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
489 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Service Reminder System *
Provides information of which service items are to be performed. Service items are
represented by a code and icon. The system tells you when to take your vehicle to a
dealer by days remaining.
When the next maintenance service timing is near, coming or passed, a warning
icon will also appear on the multi-information display every time you turn the
ignition switch to ON (w *1.
1Service Reminder System *
You can choose to have a corresponding warning
message displayed with the warning icon on the
multi-information display.
The maintenance schedule may not display correct
information if you disconnect or remove the battery
for an extended period. If this occurs, see a dealer.
Maintenance
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
489
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
490 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuService Reminder System * u
■ Displaying the Service Reminder Information
1Displaying the Service Reminder Information
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Press the
(information) button repeatedly until the maintenance item(s)
appears on the multi-information display.
Maintenance
Item Code(s)
Day Icon
Remaining Days
Button:
Changes the customize
menus and items.
SEL/RESET Button:
Enters the selected item.
Maintenance
The system message indicator (
Information.
) comes on along with the service reminder
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
490
Based on engine operating conditions and engine oil
conditions, the system calculates the remaining days
before the next service is to be performed.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
491 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuService Reminder System * u
■ Warning Icons and Service Reminder Information on the Multi-Information Display
Warning Icon
(Amber)
Service Reminder
Information
Explanation
Information
One or more of the service items are
The remaining days will be counted down
required in less than 30 days. The remaining per day.
days are estimated based on your driving
conditions.
SERVICE DUE NOW
One or more of the service items are
Have the indicated service performed as
required in less than 10 days. The remaining soon as possible.
days are estimated based on your driving
conditions.
SERVICE OVER DUE
The indicated maintenance service is still
Your vehicle has passed the service required
not done after the remaining days reach 0. point. Immediately have the service
performed and make sure to reset the
service reminder.
Continued
Maintenance
SERVICE DUE SOON
491
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
492 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuService Reminder System * u
■ Service Reminder Items
Service items displayed on the multi-information display are in code and icon.
For an explanation of the service reminder codes and icons, refer to the service book
that came with your vehicle.
■ Availability of the Service Reminder System
Even if the service reminder information appears on the multi-information display
while pressing the
(information) button, this system is not available in some
countries. Refer to service book that came with your vehicle, or ask a dealer if you
can use the service reminder system.
Maintenance
492
1Availability of the Service Reminder System
If you are planning to take your vehicle outside the
service reminder system applied countries, consult a
dealer on how to record your service reminder
information and schedule your maintenance service
under the conditions of that country.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
493 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuService Reminder System * u
■ Resetting the Display
1Resetting the Display
Reset the service reminder information display if you have performed the
maintenance service.
NOTICE
Failure to reset the service reminder information after
a maintenance service results in the system showing
incorrect maintenance intervals, which can lead to
serious mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the service reminder information
display after completing the required maintenance
service. If someone other than a dealer performs
maintenance service, reset the service reminder
information display yourself.
Button: Changes the
customize menus and items.
SEL/RESET Button: Enters the
selected item.
2 Customized Features P. 136
3. Press the SEL/RESET button.
u The service reminder information reset mode is displayed on the multiinformation display.
4. Select a service code you want to reset with the
button, then press the
SEL/RESET button.
u The service code will disappear.
To cancel the service reminder information reset mode, select Cancel, then press the
SEL/RESET button.
Maintenance
1. Turn the ignition switch to ON (w *1.
2. Go to the Maintenance info. screen.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
493
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
494 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Maintenance Schedule *
If your vehicle comes with the service book, the maintenance schedule for your vehicle is available in the book. For vehicles without the
service book, refer to the following maintenance schedule.
The maintenance schedule outlines the minimum required maintenance that you should perform to ensure the troublefree operation of
your vehicle. Due to regional and climatic differences, some additional servicing may be required. Please consult your warranty booklet for
a more detailed description.
Maintenance work should be performed by properly trained and equipped technicians. Your authorised dealer meets all of these
requirements.
Maintenance
494
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
495 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * u
Petrol models
Except European models
Service at the indicated distance or
time - whichever comes first.
Replace engine oil
Replace engine oil filter
Replace air cleaner element*1
Inspect valve clearance
Replace fuel filter*3
Replace spark plugs
Inspect drive belts
Inspect idle speed
Replace engine coolant
km X 1,000
miles X 1,000
months
Normal
Severe
Normal
Severe
Iridium type
20
12.5
12
40
25.0
24
60
80
100 120 140 160 180 200
37.5 50.0 62.5 75.0 87.5 100.0 112.5 125.0
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 1 year
Every 5,000 km (3,125 miles) or 6 months
Every 20,000 km (12,500 miles) or 2 years
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 1 year
Every 30,000 km (18,750 miles)
Every 120,000 km (75,000 miles)*2
•
•
Every 100,000 km (62,500 miles)
•
•
•
•
•
•
At 200,000 km (120,000 miles) or 10 years,
thereafter every 100,000 km (60,000 miles) or 5 years
Maintenance
*1:Only severe schedule is required in some countries: refer to the local warranty booklet.
*2:Sensory Method
Adjust the valves during service 120,000 km (75,000 miles) if they are noisy.
*3:Refer to page 516 for replacement information under driving conditions.
Continued
495
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
496 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * u
Service at the indicated distance or
time - whichever comes first.
Replace transmission fluid
Maintenance
496
km X 1,000
miles X 1,000
months
MT Normal
Severe
CVT
20
12.5
12
40
25.0
24
60
80
100 120 140 160 180 200
37.5 50.0 62.5 75.0 87.5 100.0 112.5 125.0
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
Every 120,000 km (75,000 miles) or 6 years
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 6 months
Every 3 years
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Every year
•
Inspect front and rear brakes
Replace brake fluid
Replace dust and pollen filter
•
•
Check expiry date for Temporary Repair Kit bottle *
Rotate tyres (Check tyre inflation and condition at least once
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles)
per month)
Visually inspect the following items:
Tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Suspension components
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 6 months
Driveshaft boots
Brake hoses and lines (including ABS)
All fluid levels and condition of fluid
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Exhaust system
Fuel lines and connections
* Not available on all models
•
•
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
497 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * u
If you drive your vehicle under severe conditions, you must have the following items
served to the maintenance schedule indicated as Severe.
Items
Engine oil and filter
Transmission fluid
Condition
A, B, C, D and E
B and D
1Maintenance Schedule *
The condition is considered as severe when you drive:
A. Less than 8 km (5 miles), or less than 16 km (10
miles) in freezing temperatures per trip.
B. In extremely hot temperature above 35°C.
C. With extensive idling or long periods of stop-andgo.
D. With a trailer towing, or loaded roof rack, or in
mountains.
E. On muddy, dusty or de-iced roads.
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
Continued
497
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
498 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * u
Diesel models
Except European models
Service at the indicated distance or
time - whichever comes first.
Replace engine oil and oil filter
Replace air cleaner element
Replace fuel filter
Inspect drive belts
Replace engine coolant
Maintenance
498
km X 1,000
miles X 1,000
months
Normal
Severe
20
12.5
12
40
25.0
24
•
60
80
100 120 140 160 180 200
37.5 50.0 62.5 75.0 87.5 100.0 112.5 125.0
36
48
60
72
84
96
108 120
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 1 year
Every 5,000 km (3,125 miles) or 6 months
Every 30,000 km (18,750 miles)
Every 30,000 km (18,750 miles)
•
•
•
•
•
•
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
499 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * u
Service at the indicated distance or
time - whichever comes first.
Replace transmission fluid
km X 1,000
miles X 1,000
months
MT Normal
Severe
20
12.5
12
40
25.0
24
60
37.5
36
80
50.0
48
100
62.5
60
120 140 160 180 200
75.0 87.5 100.0 112.5 125.0
72
84
96
108 120
•
•
•
•
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 6 months
Every 3 years
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
* Not available on all models
•
•
Continued
Maintenance
Inspect front and rear brakes
Replace brake fluid
Replace dust and pollen filter
•
•
Check expiry date for Temporary Repair Kit bottle *
•
•
Rotate tyres (Check tyre inflation and condition at least once
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles)
per month)
Visually inspect the following items:
Tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Suspension components
Every 10,000 km (6,250 miles) or 6 months
Driveshaft boots
Brake hoses and lines (including ABS)
All fluid levels and condition of fluid
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Exhaust system
Fuel lines and connections
499
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
500 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * u
If you drive your vehicle under severe conditions, you must have the following items
served to the maintenance schedule indicated as Severe.
Items
Engine oil and filter
Manual transmission fluid
Maintenance
500
* Not available on all models
Condition
A, B, C, D and E
B and D
1Maintenance Schedule *
The condition is considered as severe when you drive:
A. Less than 8 km (5 miles), or less than 16 km (10
miles) in freezing temperatures per trip.
B. In extremely hot temperature above 35°C.
C. With extensive idling or long periods of stop-andgo.
D. With a trailer towing, or loaded roof rack, or in
mountains.
E. On muddy, dusty or de-iced roads.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
501 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Schedule * uMaintenance Record (On vehicles without Service Book)
Maintenance Record (On vehicles without Service Book)
Except European models
Have your servicing dealer record all required maintenance below. Keep receipts for all work done on your vehicle.
Km (Mi.) or Month
Date
Sign or Stamp
20,000 km
12,500 Mi. (or 12 Mo.)
40,000 km
25,000 Mi. (or 24 Mo.)
60,000 km
37,500 Mi. (or 36 Mo.)
80,000 km
50,000 Mi. (or 48 Mo.)
100,000 km
62,500 Mi. (or 60 Mo.)
140,000 km 87,500 Mi. (or 84
Mo.)
160,000 km
100,000 Mi. (or 96 Mo.)
Maintenance
120,000 km
75,000 Mi. (or 72 Mo.)
180,000 km
112,500 Mi. (or 108 Mo.)
200,000 km
125,000 Mi. (or 120 Mo.)
501
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
502 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Maintenance Under the Bonnet
Maintenance Items Under the Bonnet
Petrol models
Left-hand drive type
Brake Fluid (Black Cap)
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Right-hand drive type
Brake Fluid (Black Cap)
Right-hand drive type
Manual transmission models
Clutch Fluid
(Light Grey Cap)
Washer Fluid
(Blue Cap)
Battery
Maintenance
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange)
Radiator Cap
502
Engine Coolant Reserve Tank
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
503 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuMaintenance Items Under the Bonnet
Diesel models
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange Handle)
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Right-hand drive type
Brake Fluid (Black Cap)
Left-hand drive type
Brake Fluid
(Black Cap)
Right-hand drive type
Clutch Fluid
(Light Grey Cap)
Washer Fluid
(Blue Cap)
Battery
Maintenance
Engine Coolant Reserve Tank
Radiator Cap
503
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
504 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuOpening the Bonnet
Opening the Bonnet
1. Park the vehicle on level ground, and set
the parking brake.
2. Pull the bonnet release handle under the
dashboard at the driver’s side.
u The bonnet will pop up slightly.
1Opening the Bonnet
NOTICE
Do not open the bonnet when the wiper arms are
raised.
The bonnet will strike the wipers, and may damage
either the bonnet or the wipers.
Pull
Diesel models
Bonnet Release
Handle
NOTICE
3. Push the bonnet latch lever in the centre of
the bonnet to release the lock mechanism,
and open the bonnet.
Maintenance
504
When closing the bonnet, check that the bonnet is
securely latched.
If the bonnet latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can
open the bonnet without lifting the lever, the latch
mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
Lever
Grip
Support
Rod
Do not press the engine cover forcibly. This may
damage the engine cover and component parts.
Clamp
4. Remove the support rod from the clamp
using the grip. Mount the support rod in
the bonnet.
When closing, remove the support rod, and
stow it in the clamp, then gently lower the
bonnet. Remove your hand at a height of
approximately 30 cm (12 inches) and let the
bonnet close.
Do not open the bonnet while the Auto Idle Stop
function is activated.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
505 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuRecommended Engine Oil
Petrol models
Recommended Engine Oil
Oil is a major contributor to your engine's performance and longevity. If you drive
the vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil, the engine may fail or be damaged.
European models
●
●
●
●
Honda ENG Oil #1.0
Honda Green Oil
ACEA A3/B3
ACEA A5/B5
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
ACEA viscosity oil is available for European models
only.
Use a commercial engine oil of suitable
viscosity for the ambient temperature as
shown.
Honda ENG Oil #1.0 oil is formulated to
improve fuel economy.
Ambient Temperature
If Honda ENG Oil #1.0, Honda Green Oil, or 0W20 are not available, use 0W-30 or 5W-30.
●
●
Genuine Honda Motor Oil
API service SM or higher grade fuel-efficient oil
0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-30
10W-30
Use a Genuine Honda Motor oil or another
commercial engine oil of suitable SAE viscosity
for the ambient temperature as shown.
Maintenance
Except European models
0W-20 oil is formulated to improve fuel
economy.
Ambient Temperature
505
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
506 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuRecommended Engine Oil
Diesel models
Recommended Engine Oil
Oil is a major contributor to your engine's performance and longevity. If you drive
the vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil, the engine may fail or be damaged.
●
●
Honda Diesel Oil #1.0
ACEA C2/C3
European models
★Honda Diesel Oil #1.0
0W-30
Use a commercial engine oil of suitable
viscosity for the ambient temperature as
shown.
Honda Diesel Oil #1.0 oil is formulated to
improve fuel economy.
Ambient Temperature
Except European models
Maintenance
Use a commercial engine oil of suitable
viscosity for the ambient temperature as
shown.
Honda Diesel Oil #1.0 oil is formulated to
improve fuel economy.
Ambient Temperature
506
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
507 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuOil Check
Oil Check
We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel.
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Wait approximately three minutes after turning the engine off before you check the oil.
1. Remove the dipstick (orange).
Petrol models
2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or
paper towel.
3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its
hole.
1Oil Check
If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly
add oil being careful not to overfill.
The amount of oil consumed depends on how the
vehicle is driven and the climatic and road conditions
encountered. The rate of oil consumption can be up
to 1 litre per 1,000 km/625 miles.
Consumption is likely to be higher when the engine is
new.
Diesel models
Maintenance
Continued
507
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
508 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuOil Check
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the
level. It should be between the upper and
lower marks. Add oil if necessary.
Petrol models
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
Diesel models
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
Maintenance
508
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
509 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuAdding Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
2. Add oil slowly.
3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten
it securely.
4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the
engine oil dipstick.
Petrol models
1Adding Engine Oil
NOTICE
Do not fill the engine oil above the upper limit mark.
Overfilling the engine oil can result in leaks and
engine damage.
If any oil spills, wipe it away immediately. Spilled oil
may damage the engine compartment components.
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Diesel models
Maintenance
509
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
510 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuEngine Coolant
Petrol models
Engine Coolant
1Engine Coolant
Specified coolant: Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the
reserve tank first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level in the
radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
■ Reserve Tank
1. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve
tank.
MAX
MIN
Maintenance
510
Reserve Tank
2. If the coolant level is below the MIN mark,
add the specified coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminium engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result
in corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed
and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle’s cooling system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
511 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuEngine Coolant
■ Radiator
Radiator
Cap
1Radiator
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Turn the radiator cap anticlockwise and
relieve any pressure in the cooling system.
Do not push the cap down when turning.
3. Push down and turn the radiator cap
anticlockwise to remove it.
4. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank until it
reaches the MAX mark. Put the cap back
on the reserve tank.
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
Maintenance
511
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
512 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuEngine Coolant
Diesel models
Engine Coolant
1Engine Coolant
Specified coolant: Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel.
Check the reserve tank. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
■ Reserve Tank
1. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve
tank.
Reserve
Tank
MAX
MIN
Maintenance
512
2. If the coolant level is below the MIN mark,
add the specified coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
3. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may
use another major brand non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminium engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result
in corrosion, causing the cooling system to
malfunction or fail. Have the cooling system flushed
and refilled with Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as
possible.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle’s coolant system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
513 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuEngine Coolant
■ Radiator
Radiator
Cap
1Radiator
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Turn the radiator cap 1/8 turn anticlockwise
and relieve any pressure in the coolant
system.
3. Push down and turn the radiator cap
anticlockwise to remove it.
4. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
5. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
6. Pour coolant into the reserve tank until it
reaches the MAX mark. Put the cap back
on the reserve tank.
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
Maintenance
513
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
514 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuTransmission Fluid
Transmission Fluid
Continuously variable transmission models
■ Continuously Variable Transmission Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Follow your vehicle’s maintenance service timing of when to change continuously
variable transmission fluid.
2 Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
1Continuously Variable Transmission Fluid
NOTICE
Do not mix Honda HCF-2 transmission fluid with
other transmission fluids.
Using a transmission fluid other than Honda HCF-2
transmission fluid may adversely affect the operation
and durability of your vehicle’s transmission, and
damage the transmission.
Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that
is not equivalent to Honda HCF-2 transmission fluid is
not covered by Honda’s new vehicle warranty.
Manual transmission models
■ Manual Transmission Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda Manual Transmission Fluid (MTF)
Maintenance
514
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Follow your vehicle’s maintenance service timing of when to change manual
transmission fluid.
2 Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
* Not available on all models
1Manual Transmission Fluid
If Honda MTF is not available, you may use the API
certificated SAE 0W-20 or 5W-20 viscosity motor oil
as a temporary measure.
Replace with MTF as soon as possible. Motor oil does
not contain the proper additives for the transmission
and continued use can cause decreased shifting
performance and lead to transmission damage.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
515 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuBrake/Clutch Fluid
Brake/Clutch Fluid
Specified fluid: Brake Fluid with DOT 3 or DOT 4
Use the same fluid for both the brakes and clutch.
■ Checking the Brake Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir.
Brake Reservoir
Left-hand drive type
MAX
MIN
Manual transmission models
1Brake/Clutch Fluid
NOTICE
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your
vehicle's braking system and can cause extensive
damage.
We recommend using a genuine product.
If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect the vehicle for leaks or worn
brake pads as soon as possible.
The brake reservoir is also used for your
vehicle’s clutch fluid. As long as you keep the
brake fluid level as instructed above, there is
no need for checking the clutch fluid level.
Right-hand drive type
Manual transmission models
Clutch Reservoir
1Checking the Clutch Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reservoir.
If the clutch fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect the vehicle for leaks or an
excessively worn clutch plate as soon as possible.
Maintenance
■ Checking the Clutch Fluid
MAX
MIN
515
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
516 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuMaintenance Under the BonnetuRefilling Window Washer Fluid
Refilling Window Washer Fluid
Check the amount of window washer fluid by looking at the reservoir.
If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.
Window Washer
Reservoir
Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not
overflow the reservoir.
Fuel Filter
Replace the fuel filter according to the time and distance recommendations in the
maintenance schedule.
Petrol models
Except European models
Maintenance
516
It is recommended to replace the fuel filter every 40,000 km (25,000 miles), or two
years, if you suspect the fuel you are using is contaminated. In a dusty environment,
the filter may become clogged sooner.
Have a qualified technician change the fuel filter. Fuel in the system can spray out
and create a hazard if all fuel line connections are not handled correctly.
1Refilling Window Washer Fluid
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water
solution in the windscreen washer reservoir.
Antifreeze can damage your vehicle's paint. A
vinegar/water solution can damage the windscreen
washer pump.
1Fuel Filter
Models with service reminder system
The fuel filter should be replaced according to the
service reminder indication.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
517 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Regeneration *
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Collects PM (particulate matter) from the exhaust gas. The DPF is installed in the
catalytic converter.
■ How the DPF Works
The DPF periodically burns off the collected PM while driving at a high temperature
of catalytic converter.
When PM is burned off, you may notice white smoke in the exhaust gas, and the
increase in the average fuel consumption. This is temporary, and normal.
1Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
The DPF must operate at a high temperature for the
chemical reactions to take place. It can set on fire any
combustible materials that come near it. Park your
vehicle away from high grass, dry leaves, or other
flammables.
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
Continued
517
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
518 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuDiesel Particulate Filter (DPF) Regeneration * uDiesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
■ Regenerating DPF
1Regenerating DPF
If you see
on the multi-information
display, you need to regenerate the DPF:
• Drive your vehicle at a speed of 60 km/h (37
mph) or over until the symbol disappears.
u It takes about 20 minutes to increase the
catalytic converter temperature to burn
out and remove PM.
Regenerate the DPF when this
symbol appears.
NOTICE
If you ignore the symbol and do not regenerate the
DPF, the multi-information display changes to the
DPF warning symbol. If this happens, take your
vehicle to a dealer as soon as possible. Continuously
ignoring the multi-information display warning
symbol causes the DPF to be clogged with PM,
seriously damaging the DPF and emission control
systems.
To minimize the accumulation of PM, always use the
recommended diesel fuel.
2 Fuel recommendation P. 480
PM is accumulated in the catalytic converter when
you drive at a low speed for a long period of time or
by frequent short journeys.
Maintenance
518
Take your vehicle to a dealer
when this warning symbol
appears.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
519 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Replacing Light Bulbs
Headlight Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1Headlight Bulbs
Models without LED low beam headlights
NOTICE
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit.
Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause
the bulb to overheat and shatter.
High/Low beam headlight: 60/55 W (H4 for halogen bulb type)
Models with LED low beam headlights
High beam headlight:
Low beam headlight:
60 W (HB3 for halogen bulb type)
LED type
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the luggage area, have the aiming
readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified technician.
Models without LED low beam headlights
■ High/Low Beam Headlight
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its base,
and protect the glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with
denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
1. Remove the coupler.
2. Remove the rubber weather seal.
Coupler
Hold-Down Wire
Bulb
Slot
3. Remove the hold-down wire, then remove
the bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb.
5. Reinstall the hold-down wire. Hook the end
of the wire on the knob in the slot.
6. Reinstall the rubber weather seal.
7. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Continued
Maintenance
Rubber Weather Seal
519
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
520 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuHeadlight Bulbs
Models with LED low beam headlights
■ High Beam Headlight
1. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
2. Rotate the old bulb to the left to remove.
3. Insert a new bulb into the headlight
assembly and turn it to the right.
4. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
Bulb
Tab
Coupler
Models with LED low beam headlights
■ Low Beam Headlight
Low beam headlight bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorised Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
Maintenance
520
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
521 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Fog Light Bulbs *
Front Fog Light Bulbs *
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1Front Fog Light Bulbs *
Insert a flat-tip screwdriver, lift and remove the centre
pin to remove the clip.
Front Fog Light: 35 W (H8 for halogen bulb type)
1. Remove the clip using a flat-tip screwdriver,
and push up the under cover.
Under
Cover
Clip
Insert the clip with the centre pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Maintenance
Push until the pin
is flat.
521
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
522 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Fog Light Bulbs *
Left side
Tab
Bulb
Coupler
Right side
Tab
Bulb
Coupler
Maintenance
522
* Not available on all models
2. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
3. Rotate the old bulb to the left on left side
and to the right on right side to remove.
4. Insert a new bulb into the fog light
assembly and turn it to the right on left side
and to the left on right side.
5. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
1Front Fog Light Bulbs *
NOTICE
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit. Oil, perspiration,
or a scratch on the glass can cause the bulb to
overheat and shatter.
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its
plastic case, and protect the glass from contact with
your skin or hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean
it with denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
523 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Front Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Front Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)
Models without LED low beam
headlights
Bulb
1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
2. Pull the bulb straight out of its holder.
3. Insert a new bulb.
Socket
Models with LED low beam
headlights
Bulb
Maintenance
Socket
523
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
524 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuPosition/Daytime Running Light Bulbs
Models without LED type position/daytime running lights
Position/Daytime Running Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Position/Daytime Running Light: 21/5 W
Bulb
1. Turn the socket to the left and remove it,
then remove the old bulb.
2. Insert a new bulb.
Socket
Models with LED type position/daytime running lights
Position/Daytime Running Light Bulbs
Maintenance
524
Position/daytime running light bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorised Honda
dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Light Bulbs
Door mirrors have side turn signal lights. Have an authorised Honda dealer inspect
and replace the light bulbs.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
525 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Rear Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Rear Turn Signal Light: 21 W (Amber)
1. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to remove
the bolts.
2. Pull the light assembly out of the rear pillar.
Bolt
3. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
Remove the old bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb.
5. Slide the light assembly onto the guide on
the body.
Socket
Maintenance
Bulb
525
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
526 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBrake *, Taillight *, Brake/Taillight * Bulbs
Brake *, Taillight *, Brake/Taillight * Bulbs
Brake, taillight, brake/taillight bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorised Honda
dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
Taillight * and Back-Up Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Taillight *: LED
Back-Up Light: 16 W
Cover
Maintenance
Bulb
Socket
526
* Not available on all models
1. Remove the cover by prying on the edge of
the cover using a flat-tip screwdriver.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
2. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
1Taillight * and Back-Up Light Bulbs
Taillight bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorised
Honda dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
527 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuHigh-Mount Brake Light Bulb
High-Mount Brake Light Bulb
High-mount brake light bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorised Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
Rear Licence Plate Light Bulbs
Rear licence plate light bulbs are the LED type. Have an authorised Honda dealer
inspect and replace the light assembly.
Maintenance
527
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
528 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuRear Fog Light Bulb
Rear Fog Light Bulb
When replacing, use the following bulb.
Rear Fog Light: 21 W
Under Cover
1. Remove the screws using a Phillips-head
screwdriver, then push up the under cover.
Screws
2. Turn the socket to the left and remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Maintenance
528
Bulb
Socket
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
529 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuOther Light Bulbs
Other Light Bulbs
■ Vanity Mirror Light Bulbs
■ Luggage Area Light Bulb
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
When replacing, use the following bulb.
Vanity Mirror Light: 2 W
1. Pry on the edge of the cover using a flattip screwdriver to remove the cover.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a
cloth to prevent scratches.
2. Remove the old bulb and insert a new
bulb.
1. Pry on the edge of the light using a flattip screwdriver to remove the light
assembly.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a
cloth to prevent scratches.
Bulb
Maintenance
Bulb
Luggage Area Light: 5 W
2. Remove the old bulb and insert a new
bulb.
529
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
530 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades
Checking Wiper Blades
If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the hard surfaces
of the blade may scratch the window glass.
Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the
passenger side.
2. Press and hold the tab, then slide the blade
from the wiper arm.
Maintenance
530
Tab
1Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
windscreen.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
531 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
3. Slide the wiper blade out from its holder by
pulling the tabbed end out.
Blade
4. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder
from the bottom end.
u The tab on the holder should fit in the
indent of the top of the wiper blade.
5. Slide the wiper blade onto the wiper arm
securely.
6. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first,
then the driver side.
Tab
Blade
Maintenance
531
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
532 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Raise the wiper arm off.
2. Pivot up the bottom end of the wiper blade
until it comes off from the wiper arm.
Wiper Arm
Blade
Maintenance
532
3. Slide the wiper blade out from the end with
the indent.
1Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm; it may damage the
rear window.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
533 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Retainer
Holder
4. Remove the retainers from the rubber blade
that has been removed, and mount to a
new rubber blade.
5. Slide the wiper blade onto the holder.
u Make sure it is engaged correctly, then
install the wiper blade assembly onto the
wiper arm.
Maintenance
533
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
534 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Checking and Maintaining Tyres
Checking Tyres
To safely operate your vehicle, your tyres must be of the proper type and size, in
good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.
■ Inflation guidelines
Properly inflated tyres provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and
comfort. Refer to the driver’s doorjamb label for the specified pressure.
Underinflated tyres wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and
are more likely to fail from overheating.
Overinflated tyres make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards,
and wear unevenly.
Every day before you drive, look at each of the tyres. If one looks lower than the
others, check the pressure with a tyre gauge.
Maintenance
At least once a month or before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in
all tyres, including the spare *. Even tyres in good condition can lose 10 to 20 kPa (0.1
to 0.2 bar, 1 to 2 psi) per month.
■ Inspection guidelines
Every time you check inflation, also examine the tyres and valve stems.
Look for:
• Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tyre if you find any cuts,
splits, or cracks in the side of the tyre. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
• Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
• Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
• Excessive tread wear.
2 Wear Indicators P. 535
• Cracks or other damage around valve stem.
534
* Not available on all models
1Checking Tyres
3 WARNING
Using tyres that are excessively worn or
improperly inflated can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding tyre inflation and
maintenance.
Measure the air pressure when tyres are cold. They
are considered as cold when the vehicle has been
parked for at least three hours, or driven less than 1.6
km (1 mile). If necessary, add or release air until the
specified pressure is reached.
If checked when hot, tyre pressure can be as much as
30–40 kPa (0.3–0.4 bar, 4–6 psi) higher than if
checked when cold.
Have a dealer check the tyres if you feel a consistent
vibration while driving. New tyres and any that have
been removed and reinstalled should be properly
balanced.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
535 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining TyresuWear Indicators
Wear Indicators
Example of a Wear
Indicator mark
The groove where the wear indicator is
located is 1.6 mm (1/16 inch) shallower than
elsewhere on the tyre. If the tread has worn so
that the indicator is exposed, replace the tyre.
Worn out tyres have poor traction on wet
roads.
Tyre Service Life
The life of your tyres is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road
conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and
environmental conditions (even when the tyres are not in use).
Maintenance
In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is
recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tyres reach five
years old. All tyres, including the spare, should be removed from service after 10
years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.
535
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
536 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining TyresuTyre and Wheel Replacement
Tyre and Wheel Replacement
Replace your tyres with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and
maximum cold tyre pressure rating (as shown on the tyre’s sidewall). Using tyres of
a different size or construction can cause the ABS (anti-lock brake system), VSA
(vehicle stability assist) system, and hill start assist to work incorrectly.
It is best to replace all four tyres at the same time. If that isn’t possible, replace the
front or rear tyres in pairs.
Make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
Maintenance
536
1Tyre and Wheel Replacement
3 WARNING
Installing improper tyres on your vehicle
can affect handling and stability. This can
cause a crash in which you can be seriously
hurt or killed.
Always use the size and type of tyres
recommended in the tyre information label
on your vehicle.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
537 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining TyresuTyre Rotation
Tyre Rotation
Rotating tyres according to the maintenance schedule helps to distribute wear more
evenly and increase tyre life.
■ Your Vehicle’s Tyre Rotation Pattern
1Tyre Rotation
Tyres with directional tread patterns should only be
rotated front to back (not from one side to the other).
Directional tyres should be mounted with the
rotation mark facing forward, as shown below.
Rotate the tyres as shown here.
Tyres without rotation mark
Tyres with rotation mark
FRONT
Front
Front
Rotation Mark
When the tyres are rotated, make sure the air
pressures are checked.
Maintenance
537
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
538 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining TyresuSnow Traction Devices
Snow Traction Devices
If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount winter tyres, or tyre chains; reduce
speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles when driving.
Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent skidding.
Use tyre chains, winter tyres, or all season tyres when necessary or according to the
law.
When mounting, refer to the following points.
For winter tyres:
• Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tyres.
• Mount the tyres to all four wheels.
Maintenance
538
1Snow Traction Devices
3 WARNING
Using the wrong chains, or not properly
installing chains, can damage the brake
lines and cause a crash in which you can be
seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding the selection and use of
tyre chains.
NOTICE
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly
installed can damage your vehicle's brake lines,
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are
hitting any part of the vehicle.
According to the EEC Directive for tyres, when winter
tyres are used, it is necessary to affix a sticker with the
allowable max. speed of the winter tyres clearly in the
field of view of the driver, if the designed max. speed
of vehicle is higher than the allowed max. speed of
winter tyre. A sticker is obtainable from your tyre
dealer. If you have any question, consult a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
539 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuChecking and Maintaining TyresuSnow Traction Devices
For tyre chains:
• Consult a dealer before purchasing any type of chains for your vehicle.
• Install them on the front tyres only.
• Because your vehicle has limited tyre clearance, we strongly recommend using the
chains listed below:
Original Tyre Size*1
215/60R16
215/55R17
Chain Type
RUD-matic classic 48492
RUD-matic classic 48493
*1 : Original tyre size is mentioned on the tyre information label on the driver’s doorjamb.
1Snow Traction Devices
When tyre chains are mounted, follow the chain
manufacturer’s instructions regarding vehicle
operational limits.
Use tyre chains only in an emergency or when they
are legally required for driving through a certain area.
Use greater caution when driving with tyre chains on
snow or ice. They may have less-predictable handling
than good winter tyres without chains.
• Follow the chain manufacturer's instruction when installing. Mount them as
tightly as you can.
• Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
• Drive slowly.
Maintenance
539
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
540 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Battery
Checking the Battery
Check the battery terminals for corrosion monthly.
1Battery
3 WARNING
The battery condition is being monitored by the sensor on the negative terminal. If
there is a problem with the sensor, the warning message on the multi-information
display will let you know. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen
gas during normal operation.
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead:
• The audio system is disabled.
A spark or open flame can cause the
battery to explode with enough force to
kill or seriously hurt you.
2 Reactivating the audio system P. 236
• The clock resets.
2 Clock P. 146
• The navigation system * is disabled.
2 Refer to the navigation system manual
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the battery.
Wear protective clothing and a face shield,
or have a skilled technician do any battery
maintenance.
3 WARNING
Maintenance
The battery contains sulfuric acid (electrolyte)
which is highly corrosive and poisonous.
Getting electrolyte in your eyes or on your
skin can cause serious burns. Wear
protective clothing and eye protection
when working on or near the battery.
Swallowing electrolyte can cause fatal
poisoning if immediate action is not taken.
KEEP OUT OF THE REACH OF CHILDREN
540
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
541 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBatteryuCharging the Battery
Charging the Battery
Disconnect both battery cables to prevent damaging your vehicle's electrical system.
Always disconnect the negative - cable first, and reconnect it last.
Replacing the Battery
When you remove and replace the battery, always follow the maintenance safety
and the warnings for when checking the battery to prevent potential hazards.
2 Maintenance Safety P. 487
2 Checking the Battery P. 540
Cover
Nut
Nut
Nut
Stay
Battery
Cover
Emergency Procedures
Eyes: Flush with water from a cup or other container
for at least 15 minutes. (Water under pressure can
damage the eye.) Call a physician immediately.
Skin: Remove contaminated clothing. Flush the skin
with large quantities of water. Call a physician
immediately.
Swallowing: Drink water or milk. Call a physician
immediately.
When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals
by applying a baking powder and water solution.
Clean the terminals with a damp towel. Cloth/towel
dry the battery. Coat the terminals with grease to
help to prevent future corrosion.
1Replacing the Battery
NOTICE
An improperly disposed of battery can be harmful to
the environment and human health. Always confirm
local regulations for battery disposal.
This symbol on the battery means that this product
must not be treated as household waste.
Maintenance
Nut
Stay
1. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1.
Open the bonnet.
2. Loosen the nut on the negative battery
cable, then disconnect the cable from the
- terminal.
3. Open the positive battery terminal cover.
Loosen the nut on the positive battery
cable, then disconnect the cable from the
+ terminal.
4. Loosen the nut on each side of the battery
bracket with a wrench.
5. Pull the bottom end of each battery stay out
of the hole on the battery base, and remove
the combination of the battery bracket and
the stays.
6. Remove the battery cover.
1Battery
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of
an ignition switch.
Continued
541
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
542 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBatteryuReplacing the Battery
7. Take out the battery carefully.
1Replacing the Battery
Always disconnect the - cable first, and reconnect it
last.
To install a new battery, reverse this procedure.
The battery installed in this vehicle is specifically
designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop. Using a
battery other than this specified type may shorten the
battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop from
activating. If you need to replace the battery, make
sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer for
more details.
2 Specifications P. 608, 611
Maintenance
542
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
543 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuBatteryuBattery Label
Battery Label
1Battery Label
Example
Maintenance
DANGER
• Keep flames and sparks away from the battery. The
battery produces explosive gas that can cause an
explosion.
• Wear eye protection and rubber gloves when
handling the battery to avoid risk of burns or loss of
eyesight if exposed to battery electrolyte.
• Do not allow children to handle the battery, under
any circumstance. Ensure that anyone handling the
battery has a proper understanding of the hazards
and correct handling procedures involved.
• Handle battery electrolyte with extreme care, as it
contains dilute sulfuric acid. Exposure to eyes or
skin can cause burns or loss of eyesight.
• Read this manual carefully, and understand it
before handling the battery. Failure to do so can
cause personal injury and damage to the vehicle.
• Do not use the battery if the level of electrolyte is at
or below the recommended level. Using the battery
with low electrolyte can cause it to explode,
causing serious injury.
543
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
544 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
1Replacing the Button Battery
■ Retractable Key *
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the upper half of the cover by
carefully prying on the edge with a coin.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the retractable key.
Battery
2. Remove the button battery with the small
flat-tip screwdriver.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
A warning mark is located adjacent to the button
battery *.
NOTICE
Maintenance
An improperly disposed of battery can damage the
environment. Always confirm local regulations for
battery disposal.
This symbol on the battery means that this product
must not be treated as household waste.
Replacement batteries are commercially available or
at a dealer.
544
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
545 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuRemote Transmitter CareuReplacing the Button Battery
■ Keyless Remote *
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the built-in key.
Battery
Maintenance
* Not available on all models
2. Remove the upper half of the cover by
carefully prying on the edge with a coin.
u Remove carefully to avoid losing the
buttons.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the keyless remote.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
545
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
546 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Climate Control System Maintenance
Air Conditioning
For proper and safe operation of the climate control system, the refrigerant system
should only be served by a qualified technician.
Never repair or replace the air conditioning evaporator (cooling coil) with one
removed from a used or salvaged vehicle.
1Air Conditioning
NOTICE
Vented refrigerant is harmful to the environment.
To avoid refrigerant from venting, never replace the
evaporator with one removed from a used or
salvaged vehicle.
Refrigerant in your vehicle’s air conditioning system is
flammable and can be ignited during servicing if
proper procedures are not followed.
The air conditioner label is found under the bonnet:
: Caution
: Flammable Refrigerant
: Requires Registered
Technician to Service
Maintenance
546
: Air Conditioning
System
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
547 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control System MaintenanceuDust and Pollen Filter
Dust and Pollen Filter
■ When to Replace the Dust and Pollen Filter
1Dust and Pollen Filter
Replace the dust and pollen filter according to your vehicle’s recommended
maintenance schedule. It is recommended to replace the filter even sooner if the
vehicle has been driven in a dusty environment.
2 Maintenance Schedule * P. 494
Using an air freshener may reduce the deodorizing
effect of the dust and pollen filter, and may reduce its
life.
If the airflow from the climate control system
deteriorates noticeably, and the windows fog up
easily, the filter may need to be replaced.
■ How to Replace the Dust and Pollen Filter
The dust and pollen filter collects pollen, dust, and
other debris in the air.
1. Open the glove box.
Handle
Pull
2. Push the stop on the driver’s side of the
glove box to detach it from the glove box.
3. Disengage the two tabs by pushing on each
side panel.
4. Pivot the glove box out of the way.
Maintenance
Tabs
Stop
* Not available on all models
Continued
547
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
548 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuClimate Control System MaintenanceuDust and Pollen Filter
Tabs
Push
Push
Cover
Dust and Pollen
Filter
Maintenance
548
5. Push in the tabs on the corners of the filter
case cover, and remove it.
6. Remove the filter from the case.
7. Install a new filter in the case.
u Put the AIR FLOW arrow directed side
down.
1Dust and Pollen Filter
If you are not sure how to replace the dust and pollen
filter, have it replaced by a dealer.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
549 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Cleaning
Interior Care
Use a vacuum cleaner to remove dust before using a cloth.
Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt.
Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.
■ Cleaning Seat Belts
Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts.
Let the belts air dry. Wipe the loop of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.
Loop
1Interior Care
Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle.
Electrical devices and systems may malfunction if
liquids are splashed on them.
Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices
such as audio devices and switches.
Doing so may cause the items to malfunction or a fire
inside the vehicle.
If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on
electrical devices, consult a dealer.
Depending on their composition, chemicals and
liquid aromatics may cause discolouration, wrinkles,
and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.
Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as
benzene or petrol.
Be careful not to spill a liquid type air freshener.
■ Cleaning the Window
Maintenance
After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them
away using a dry cloth.
Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts
or textiles for long periods of time without washing.
1Cleaning the Window
Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window.
Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a
soft cloth so as not to damage them.
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
Continued
549
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
550 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCleaninguInterior Care
■ Floor Mats *
The driver’s floor mat hooks over the floor anchors, which keep the mat from sliding
forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn the anchor knobs to the unlock
position. When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn the knobs to the lock
position.
Do not put additional floor mats on top of the anchored mat.
■ Maintaining Genuine Leather *
Vacuum dirt and dust from the leather frequently. Pay close attention to the pleats
and seams. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a 90% water and
10% neutral soap solution. Then buff it with a clean, dry cloth. Remove any dust or
dirt on leather surfaces immediately.
Maintenance
550
* Not available on all models
1Floor Mats *
If you use any floor mats that were not originally
provided with your vehicle, make sure they are
designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and
are securely anchored by the floor anchors.
Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are
not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere
with the front seat functions.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
551 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
Exterior Care
Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.
Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a
painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.
■ Washing the Vehicle
1Washing the Vehicle
Wash the vehicle frequently. Further, make sure to wash the vehicle in the following
circumstances:
• If driving on roads with road salt.
• If driving in coastal areas.
• If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.
Do not spray water into the air intake vents or engine
compartment. It can cause a malfunction.
■ Using an Automated Car Wash
• Fold in the door mirrors.
• Turn off the automatic intermittent wipers *.
Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the automated car wash.
• Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
• Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to
enter the vehicle interior.
• Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead,
use low pressure water and a mild detergent.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Maintenance
■ Using High Pressure Cleaners
Air Intake Vents
551
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
552 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Applying Wax
A good coat of automotive body wax helps to protect your vehicle’s paint from the
elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle’s paint to the
elements, so reapply as necessary.
■ Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
If you get petrol, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they may
be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and
water.
■ Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
■ Maintaining Aluminium Wheels
Maintenance
552
Aluminium is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road
contaminants. Use a sponge and mild detergent to wipe away promptly.
Be careful not to use harsh chemicals (including some commercial wheel cleaners) or
a stiff brush. They can damage the clear coat of the aluminium alloy wheels that
helps to keep the aluminium from corroding and tarnishing.
1Applying Wax
NOTICE
Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage
the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe
away spills immediately.
1Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when
you want to repair the painted surface of the parts
made of resin.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
553 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Fogged Exterior Light Lenses
The inside lenses of exterior lights (headlights, brake lights etc.) may fog temporarily
if you have driven in the rain, or after the vehicle has been run through a car wash.
Dew condensation also may build up inside the lenses when there is a significant
enough difference between the ambient and inside lens temperatures (similar to
vehicle windows fogging up in rainy conditions). These conditions are natural
processes, not structural design problems in the exterior lights.
Lens design characteristics may result in moisture developing on the light lens frame
surfaces. This also is not a malfunction.
However, if you see large amounts of water accumulation, or large water drop
building up inside the lenses, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Maintenance
553
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
554
554 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
555 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Handling the Unexpected
This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.
Tools
Types of Tools .................................. 556
If a Tyre Goes Flat
Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre * .... 557
Changing a Flat Tyre * ...................... 568
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine ........................ 575
If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak ..... 577
Emergency Engine Stop ................... 578
Jump Starting.................................... 579
Shift Lever Does Not Move .............. 582
* Not available on all models
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating............. 583
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On....585
If the Charging System Indicator Comes
On ................................................. 585
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes
On or Blinks ................................... 586
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes
On ................................................. 586
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 587
If the Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 588
If the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning
System Indicator Comes On or Blinks .....589
If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears.....590
If the PGM-FI Symbol Appears ......... 590
Fuses
Fuse Locations ................................. 591
Inspecting and Changing Fuses........ 599
Emergency Towing........................... 600
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate .....603
Refueling
Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container ....605
555
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
556 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Tools
Types of Tools
1Types of Tools
Jack
*1
Tool
Bag
Funnel *
Handling the Unexpected
Tool Case
*2
Jack
Tool Case
*3
Jack
Funnel *
Funnel *
Jack
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
Detachable
Towing Hook
Grip
Funnel *
Jack Handle Bar
*1 : Models with tyre repair kit, Models with front fog lights
*2 : Models with tyre repair kit, Models without front fog lights
*3 : Models with a compact spare tyre
556
* Not available on all models
Flat-tip Screwdriver
The tools are stored in the luggage area.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
557 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
If a Tyre Goes Flat
Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
If the tyre has a large cut or is otherwise severely damaged, you will need to have
the vehicle towed. If the tyre only has a small puncture, from a nail for instance, you
can use the temporary tyre repair kit so that you can drive to the nearest service
station for a more permanent repair.
If a tyre goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then stop in a safe place.
1Temporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
The kit should not be used in the following situations.
Instead, contact a dealer or roadside assistant to have
the vehicle towed.
• The tyre sealant has expired.
• More than one tyre is punctured.
• The puncture or cut is larger than 4 mm (3/16 inch).
• The tyre side wall is damaged or the puncture is
outside the contact area.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery surface and apply the parking
brake.
Contact
Area
2. Move the shift lever to (P .
Manual transmission models
Kit Use
Smaller than 4 mm
(3/16 inch)
Yes
Larger than 4 mm
(3/16 inch)
No
• Damage has been caused by driving with the tyres
extremely under inflated.
2. Move the shift lever to (R .
• The tyre bead is no longer seated.
• A rim is damaged.
All models
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1.
u When towing a trailer, unhitch the trailer.
Do not remove a nail or screw that punctured the
tyre. If you remove it from the tyre, you may not be
able to repair the puncture using the kit.
Handling the Unexpected
Continuously variable transmission models
When the puncture is:
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
* Not available on all models
Continued
557
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
558 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
■ Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tyre
Deflation Button
Air Compressor
Switch
Expiration Date
Speed Limit Label
Handling the Unexpected
558
Air Compressor
Sealant Bottle
Instruction Manual
Wheel Label
1Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair the Flat Tyre
When making a temporary repair, carefully read the
instruction manual provided with the kit.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
559 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
Models with front fog lights
Tab
Cover
1. Open the tailgate.
2. Pull the tab to open the compartment cover
located on the right side of the luggage
area.
3. Take the kit out of the compartment.
4. Place the kit face up, on flat ground near
the flat tyre, and away from traffic. Do not
place the kit on its side.
Tyre Repair Kit
Models without front fog lights
1. Pull up the strap and open the luggage area
floor lid.
2. Take the kit out of the case.
3. Place the kit, face up, on flat ground near
the flat tyre, away from traffic. Do not place
the kit on its side.
Tyre Repair Kit
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
Floor
Lid
559
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
560 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
■ Injecting Sealant and Air
1Injecting Sealant and Air
1. Remove the valve cap from the tyre valve
stem.
Tyre Valve Stem
3 WARNING
Tyre sealant contains substances that are
harmful and can be fatal if swallowed.
If accidentally swallowed, do not induce
vomiting. Drink plenty of water and get
medical attention immediately.
Valve Cap
Handling the Unexpected
2. Shake the sealant bottle.
3. Attach the sealant/air hose onto the tyre
valve stem. Screw it until it is tight.
u Make sure the bottle remains upright to
ensure all the sealant flows into the
tyre.
Tyre Valve Stem
Sealant/air hose
Bottle Adapter
Bottle
Cap
Air Compressor Hose
560
4. Remove the bottle cap from the bottle
adapter.
5. Attach the air compressor hose onto the
bottle adapter. Screw it until it is tight.
For skin or eye contact, flush with cool
water and get medical attention if
necessary.
Keep the sealant bottle out of the reach of children.
Do not shake the bottle after the bottle cap removed.
If you shake the bottle after the cap removed, it may
spill sealant.
In cold temperatures, the sealant may not flow easily.
In this situation, warm it up for five minutes before
using.
The sealant is latex based and can permanently stain
clothing and other materials. Be careful during
handling and wipe up any spills immediately.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
561 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
6. Plug in the compressor to the accessory
power socket.
u Be careful not to pinch the cord in a
door or window.
2 Accessory Power Sockets P. 214
7. Start the engine.
u Keep the engine running while injecting
sealant and air.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 82
Air Compressor Switch
OFF
9. Models with 215/60R16 95H tyres
After the air pressure reaches front:210 kPa
(2.1 bar, 30 psi)/rear:200 kPa (2.0 bar, 29 psi),
turn off the kit.
Models with 215/55R17 94V tyres
After the air pressure reaches front:220
kPa (2.2 bar, 32 psi)/rear:210 kPa (2.1 bar,
30 psi), turn off the kit.
u Check the air pressure gauge on the air
compressor.
3 WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing this colourless, odourless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
NOTICE
Do not operate the temporary tyre repair kit compressor
for more than 15 minutes. The compressor can overheat
and become permanently damaged.
Until the sealant injection is complete, the pressure
shown on the pressure gauge will appear higher than
actual. After the sealant injection is complete the pressure
will drop and then begin to rise again as the tyre is
inflated with air. This is normal. To accurately measure the
air pressure using the gauge, turn the air compressor off
only after the sealant injection is complete.
Handling the Unexpected
ON
8. Turn the air compressor on to inflate the
tyre.
u The compressor starts injecting sealant
and air into the tyre.
1Injecting Sealant and Air
If the required air pressure is not reached within 10
minutes, the tyre may be too severely damaged for
the kit to provide the necessary seal and your vehicle
will need to be towed.
See a Honda dealer for a replacement sealant bottle
and proper disposal of an empty bottle.
Continued
561
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
562 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
Air Pressure Gauge
10. Unplug the kit from the accessory power
socket.
11. Unscrew the sealant/air hose from the tyre
valve stem. Reinstall the valve cap.
12. Push the deflate button until the gauge
returns 0 kPa (0 bar, 0 psi).
Deflate Button
Handling the Unexpected
562
Wheel Label
13. Apply the wheel label to the flat surface of
the wheel.
u The wheel surface must be clean to
ensure the label adheres properly.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
563 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
■ Distributing the Sealant in the Tyre
Speed Limit Label
1. Apply the speed limit label to the location
as shown.
2. Drive the vehicle for about 10 minutes.
u Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph).
3. Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
Handling the Unexpected
Continued
563
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
564 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
4. Recheck the air pressure using the gauge
on the air compressor.
u Do not turn the air compressor on to
check the pressure.
5. If the air pressure is:
• Less than 130 kPa (1.3 bar, 19 psi):
Do not add air or continue driving. The
leak is too severe. Call for help and have
your vehicle towed.
2 Emergency Towing P. 600
Handling the Unexpected
564
Models with 215/60R16 95H tyres
• Front:210 kPa (2.1 bar, 30 psi)/rear:200
kPa (2.0 bar, 29 psi) or more:
Models with 215/55R17 94V tyres
• Front:220 kPa (2.2 bar, 32 psi)/rear:210
kPa (2.1 bar, 30 psi) or more:
Continue driving for another 10 minutes
or until you reach the nearest service
station. Do not exceed 80 km/h (50
mph).
u If the air pressure does not go down after
the 10 minute driving, you do not need
to check the pressure any more.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
565 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
Models with 215/60R16 95H tyres
1Distributing the Sealant in the Tyre
• Greater than 130 kPa (1.3 bar, 19 psi), but
less than front:210 kPa (2.1 bar, 30 psi)/
rear:200 kPa (2.0 bar, 29 psi):
Turn the air compressor on to inflate the
tyre until the tyre pressure reaches
front:210 kPa (2.1 bar, 30 psi)/rear:200 kPa
(2.0 bar, 29 psi).
Models with 215/55R17 94V tyres
ON
OFF
• Greater than 130 kPa (1.3 bar, 19 psi), but
less than front:220 kPa (2.2 bar,32 psi)/
rear:210 kPa (2.1 bar, 30 psi):
Turn the air compressor on to inflate the
tyre until the tyre pressure reaches
front:220 kPa (2.2 bar, 32 psi)/rear:210 kPa
(2.1 bar, 30 psi).
2 Injecting Sealant and Air P. 560
Air Pressure Gauge
Then drive carefully for 10 more minutes or
until you reach the nearest service station.
Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph).
u You should repeat this procedure as long
as the air pressure is within this range.
6. Repackage and properly stow the kit.
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing this colourless, odourless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
Handling the Unexpected
Air Compressor Switch
3 WARNING
Deflate Button
Continued
565
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
566 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
■ Inflating an Under-inflated Tyre
1Inflating an Under-inflated Tyre
You can use the kit to inflate a non-punctured under-inflated tyre.
1. Take the kit out of the case.
Tyre Valve
Stem
2 Getting Ready to Temporarily Repair
the Flat Tyre P. 558
Valve Cap
Air Compressor
Hose
Handling the Unexpected
Tyre Valve Stem
2. Place the kit, face up, on flat ground near
the flat tyre, away from traffic. Do not
place the kit on its side.
3. Remove the valve cap from the tyre valve
stem.
4. Attach the air compressor hose onto the
tyre valve stem.
Screw it until it is tight.
5. Plug in the compressor to the accessory
power socket.
u Be careful not to pinch the cord in a
door or window.
2 Accessory Power Sockets P. 214
6. Start the engine.
u Keep the engine running while injecting
sealant and air.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 82
566
3 WARNING
Running the engine with the vehicle in an
enclosed or even partly enclosed area can
cause a rapid build-up of toxic carbon
monoxide.
Breathing this colourless, odourless gas can
cause unconsciousness and even death.
Only run the engine to power the air
compressor with the vehicle outdoors.
NOTICE
Do not operate the temporary tyre repair kit
compressor for more than 15 minutes. The
compressor can overheat and become permanently
damaged.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
567 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuTemporarily Repairing a Flat Tyre *
Air Compressor Switch
ON
OFF
Air Pressure Gauge
9. Turn off the kit.
u Check the pressure gauge on the air
compressor.
u If overinflated, press the deflate button.
10. Unplug the kit from the accessory power
socket.
11. Unscrew the air hose from the tyre valve
stem. Reinstall the valve cap.
12. Push the deflate button until the gauge
returns 0 kPa (0 bar, 0 psi).
13. Repackage and properly stow the kit.
Handling the Unexpected
Deflate Button
7. Turn the air compressor switch on to
inflate the tyre.
u The compressor starts to inject air into
the tyre.
u If you have started the engine, leave it
running while injecting air.
8. Inflate the tyre to the specified air
pressure.
567
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
568 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
Changing a Flat Tyre *
If a tyre goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then, stop in a safe place. Replace the flat tyre with a compact
spare tyre. Go to a dealer as soon as possible to have the full-size tyre repaired or
replaced.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, and non-slippery surface and apply the parking
brake.
Continuously variable transmission models
2. Move the shift lever to (P .
Manual transmission models
Handling the Unexpected
2. Move the shift lever to (R .
All models
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1.
1Changing a Flat Tyre *
Follow compact spare precautions:
Periodically check the tyre pressure of the compact
spare. It should be set to the specified pressure.
Specified Pressure: 420 kPa (4.2 bar, 60 psi)
When driving with the compact spare tyre, keep the
vehicle speed under 80 km/h (50 mph). Replace with
a full-size tyre as soon as possible.
The compact spare tyre and wheel in your vehicle are
specifically for this model. Do not use them with
another vehicle. Do not use another type of compact
spare tyre or wheel with your vehicle.
Do not mount tyre chains on a compact spare tyre.
If a chain-mounted front tyre goes flat, remove one of
the full-size rear tyres and replace it with the compact
spare tyre. Remove the flat front tyre and replace it with
the full-size tyre that was removed from the rear. Mount
the tyre chains on the front tyre.
This tyre gives a harsher ride and less traction on some
road surfaces. Use greater caution while driving.
Do not use more than one compact spare tyre at the
same time.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
568
* Not available on all models
The compact spare tyre is smaller than the full-size
tyre. Your vehicle’s ground clearance reduces when
the compact spare tyre is installed. Driving over road
debris or bumps could possibly damage the
underside of your vehicle.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
569 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
■ Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tyre
Floor Lid
Jack
Tool Case
1Changing a Flat Tyre *
1. Open the luggage area floor lid.
2. Take the tool case out of the luggage area.
3. Take the wheel nut wrench, jack handle bar
and jack out of the tool case.
4. Unscrew the wing bolt, and remove the
spacer cone. Then, remove the spare tyre.
WARNING: The jack can only be used for helping an
emergency vehicle breakdown, not for changing the
regular seasonal tyre or any other normal
maintenance or repair operation.
The shape of the tool case varies by model.
NOTICE
Do not use the jack if it doesn’t work properly. Call
your dealer or a professional towing service.
Spare Tyre
Wheel
Blocks
The tyre to be replaced.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
5. Place a wheel block or rock in front and rear
of the wheel diagonal to the flat tyre.
569
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
570 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
6. Place the spare tyre (wheel side up) under
the vehicle body, near the tyre that needs to
be replaced.
Handling the Unexpected
570
7. Loosen each wheel nut about one turn
using the wheel nut wrench.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
571 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
■ How to Set Up the Jack
1How to Set Up the Jack
1. Place the jack under the jacking point
closest to the tyre to be changed.
3 WARNING
The vehicle can easily roll off the jack,
seriously injuring anyone underneath.
Follow the directions for changing a tyre
exactly, and no person should place any
portion of their body under a vehicle that is
supported by a jack.
Jack Points
2. Turn the end bracket clockwise as shown in
the image until the top of the jack contacts
the jacking point.
u Make sure that the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.
WARNING: The jack shall be placed on a flat and
stable surface on the same level as the vehicle is
parked.
The jack that came with your vehicle has the
following label.
Handling the Unexpected
Jack Points
1. See Owner’s Manual.
2. Never get under vehicle when supported by jack.
3. Place jack underneath reinforced area.
Continued
571
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
572 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
3. Raise the vehicle, using the jack handle bar
and the jack handle, until the tyre is off the
ground.
Jack
Handle
Bar
Handling the Unexpected
572
1How to Set Up the Jack
Do not use the jack with people or luggage in the
vehicle.
Use the jack provided in your vehicle.
Other jacks may not support the weight (“load”) or
may not fit the jacking point.
Wheel Nut
Wrench as Jack Handle
The following instructions must be followed to use
the jack safely:
• Do not use while the engine is running.
• Use only where the ground is firm and level.
• Use only at the jacking points.
• Do not get in the vehicle while using the jack.
• Do not put anything on top of or underneath the
jack.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
573 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
■ Replacing the Flat Tyre
1Replacing the Flat Tyre
1. Remove the wheel nuts and flat tyre.
Do not over tighten the wheel nuts by applying extra
torque using your foot or a pipe.
Wheel
Nut
Handling the Unexpected
2. Wipe the mounting surfaces of the wheel
with a clean cloth.
3. Mount the spare tyre.
4. Screw the wheel nuts until they touch the
lips around the mounting holes, and stop
rotating.
5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack.
Tighten the wheel nuts in the order
indicated in the image. Go around,
tightening the nuts, two to three times in
this order.
Wheel nut torque:
108 N∙m (11 kgf∙m, 80 lbf∙ft)
Continued
573
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
574 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIf a Tyre Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tyre *
■ Storing the Flat Tyre
Centre Cap
1Storing the Flat Tyre
1. Remove the centre cap.
3 WARNING
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
Handling the Unexpected
Wing
Bolt
For full- For
size tyre compact
spare tyre
2. Remove the spacer cone from the wing bolt,
flip it over, and insert it back on the bolt.
3. Place the flat tyre face down in the spare
tyre well.
4. Secure the flat tyre with the wing bolt.
5. Securely put the jack and wheel nut wrench
back in the tool case.
6. Store the case in the luggage area.
Spacer Cone
■ Deflation Warning System and the Spare Tyre
If you replace a flat tyre with the compact spare tyre,
indicator comes on while
you are driving. After driving for a few kilometres (miles), the indicator will start
blinking for a short time and then stay on, but this is normal.
Calibrate the deflation warning system when you replace the tyre with a specified
regular tyre.
2 Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 455
574
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
575 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine
If the engine does not start, check the starter.
1Checking the Engine
If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an
assisting vehicle to jump start it.
2 Jump Starting P. 579
Checklist
Models with keyless access system
Check for a message on the multi-information display.
● If
appears
2 If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak P. 577
uMake sure the keyless remote is in its operating range.
2 ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range P. 173
The starter turns over normally
but the engine doesn’t start.
There may be a problem with the
fuse. Check each of the items on
the right and respond accordingly.
Check the brightness of the interior lights.
Turn on the interior lights and check the brightness.
● If the interior lights are dim or do not come on at all 2 Battery P. 540
● If the interior lights come on normally 2 Fuses P. 591
Review the engine start procedure.
Follow its instructions, and try to start the engine again.
2 Starting the Engine P. 397, 400
Check the immobilizer system indicator.
When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the engine cannot be started.
Handling the Unexpected
Starter condition
Starter doesn’t turn or turns
over slowly.
The battery may be dead. Check
each of the items on the right and
respond accordingly.
2 Immobilizer System P. 163
Check the fuel level.
There should be enough fuel in the tank.
2 Fuel Gauge P. 132
Check the fuse.
Check all fuses, or have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 599
If the problem continues:
2 Emergency Towing P. 600
Continued
575
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
576 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuEngine Does Not StartuChecking the Engine
Starter condition
The starter turns over normally
but the engine doesn’t start.
There may be a problem with the
fuses. Check each of the items on
the right and respond accordingly.
Checklist
Diesel models
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer. If the malfunction indicator lamp comes on, or
appears on the multi-information display under the following circumstances:
● The fuel tank has been run dry.
2 Low Fuel Indicator P. 93
Diesel models
Have the fuel filter checked by a dealer to drain off water.
appears on the multi-information display.
Handling the Unexpected
576
2 Draining Water P. 126
2 Multi-Information Display Warning and Information Messages P. 126
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
577 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuEngine Does Not StartuIf the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak
Models with keyless access system
If the Keyless Remote Battery is Weak
ENGINE
START
STOP
2. Depress the brake pedal (continuously
variable transmission) or clutch pedal
(manual transmission) and press the
ENGINE START/STOP button within 10
seconds after the beeper sounds and the
indicator stays on.
u If you do not depress the pedal, the
mode changes to ACCESSORY.
Handling the Unexpected
If the beeper sounds,
appears on the multi-information display, the indicator on
the ENGINE START/STOP button blinks, and the engine won’t start. Start the
engine as follows.
1. Touch the centre of the ENGINE START/
STOP button with the H logo on the keyless
remote while the indicator on the ENGINE
START/STOP button is blinking. The
buttons on the keyless remote should be
facing you.
u The indicator blinks for about 30
seconds.
577
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
578 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuEngine Does Not StartuEmergency Engine Stop
Models with keyless access system
Emergency Engine Stop
The ENGINE START/STOP button may be used to stop the engine due to an
emergency situation even while driving. If you must stop the engine, do either of the
following operations:
• Press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for about two seconds.
• Firmly press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice.
The steering wheel will not lock.
Continuously variable transmission models
Handling the Unexpected
578
The power mode is in ACCESSORY when the engine is stopped.
To change the mode to VEHICLE OFF, move the shift lever to (P after the vehicle
comes to a complete stop. Then press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice
without depressing the brake pedal.
Manual transmission models
The power mode changes to VEHICLE OFF.
The vehicle comes to a complete stop. After press the ENGINE START/STOP button
three times without depressing the clutch pedal.
1Emergency Engine Stop
Do not press the button while driving unless it is
absolutely necessary for the engine to be switched
off.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
579 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Jump Starting
■ Jump Starting Procedure
1Jump Starting
Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the engine,
then open the bonnet.
1. Connect the first jumper cable to your
Petrol models
vehicle's battery + terminal.
u Remove the cover from the underbonnet fuse box.
2 Engine Compartment Fuse Box
P. 593
Diesel models
A battery can explode if you do not follow
the correct procedure, seriously injuring
anyone nearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the battery.
NOTICE
If a battery sits in extreme cold, the electrolyte inside
can freeze. Attempting to jump start with a frozen
battery can cause it to rupture.
Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they
do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be
careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the
cable ends to touch each other while attaching or
detaching the jumper cables.
Handling the Unexpected
Booster
Battery
2. Connect the other end of the first jumper
cable to the booster battery + terminal.
u Use a 12-volt booster battery only.
u Connect when using the automotive
battery charger to boost your 12-volt
battery, select a lower charging voltage
than 15-volt. Check the charger manual
for the proper setting.
3. Connect the second jumper cable to the
booster battery - terminal.
3 WARNING
Booster
Battery
Continued
579
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
580 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuJump Startingu
Petrol models
Diesel models
Handling the Unexpected
580
4. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the stud bolt as shown. Do
not connect this jumper cable to any other
part.
5. If the jumper cable is connected to another
vehicle, start the assisting vehicle's engine
and increase engine’s revolution slightly.
6. Attempt to start your vehicle's engine. If it
turns over slowly, check that the jumper
cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
1Jump Starting
Battery performance degrades in cold conditions and
may prevent the engine from starting.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
581 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuJump Startingu
■ What to Do After the Engine Starts
Once your vehicle's engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following
order.
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle's stud bolt.
2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery terminal.
3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle's battery + terminal.
4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery +
terminal.
Handling the Unexpected
Have your vehicle inspected by a nearby service station or a dealer.
581
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
582 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Shift Lever Does Not Move
Continuously variable transmission models
Follow the procedure below if you cannot move the shift lever out of the (P
position.
■ Releasing the Lock
Slot
Cover
1. Set the parking brake.
Models without keyless access system
2. Remove the key from the ignition switch.
Models with keyless access system
*1
Handling the Unexpected
Slot
All models
*2
*1 : Left-hand drive type
*2 : Right-hand drive type
Cover
Shift Lock
Release Slot
Release Button
582
2. Remove the built-in key from the keyless
remote.
3. Wrap a cloth around the tip of a small flattip screwdriver. Put it into the shift lock
release slot as shown in the image, and
remove the cover.
4. Insert the key into the shift lock release slot.
5. While pushing the key down, press the shift
lever release button and place the shift lever
into (N .
u The lock is now released. Have the shift
lever checked by a dealer as soon as
possible.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
583 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating
Overheating symptoms are as follows:
• The high temperature indicator (red) comes on or the engine suddenly loses
power.
• Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.
■ First thing to do
Continued
3 WARNING
Steam and spray from an overheated
engine can seriously scald you.
Do not open the bonnet if steam is coming
out.
NOTICE
Continuing to drive with the high temperature
indicator on may damage the engine.
Handling the Unexpected
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.
u No steam or spray present: Keep the engine running and open the bonnet.
u Steam or spray is present: Turn off the engine and wait until it subsides.
Then open the bonnet.
1How to Handle Overheating
583
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
584 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
■ Next thing to do
Petrol models
MAX
MIN
Reserve Tank
Handling the Unexpected
Diesel models
MAX
MIN
1How to Handle Overheating
1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and
stop the engine once the high temperature
indicator goes off.
u If the cooling fan is not operating,
immediately stop the engine.
2. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect
the coolant level and check the cooling
system components for leaks.
u If the coolant level in the reserve tank is
low, add coolant until it reaches the
MAX mark.
u If there is no coolant in the reserve tank,
check that the radiator is cool. Cover the
radiator cap with a heavy cloth and open
the cap. If necessary, add coolant up to
the base of the filler neck, and put the
cap back on.
Reserve Tank
■ Last thing to do
Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, restart it and check the high temperature
indicator.
If the high temperature indicator is off, resume driving. If it stays on, contact a dealer
for repairs.
584
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.
Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only.
Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze
as soon as possible.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
585 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the engine oil pressure is low.
■ What to do as soon as the indicator comes on
1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
■ What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about three minutes.
2. Open the bonnet and check the oil level.
1If the Low Oil Pressure Indicator Comes On
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
2 Oil Check P. 507
If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the battery is not being charged.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
1If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
If you need to stop temporarily, do not turn off the
engine. Restarting the engine may rapidly discharge
the battery.
Handling the Unexpected
3. Start the engine and check the low oil pressure indicator.
u The indicator goes off: Start driving again.
u The indicator does not go off within 10 seconds: Stop the engine
and contact a dealer for repairs immediately.
Turn off the climate control system, rear demister, and other electrical
systems, and immediately contact a dealer for repairs.
585
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
586 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator lamp to come on or blink
• Comes on if there is a problem with the engine emissions control
system.
• Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.
Diesel models
Handling the Unexpected
586
• Comes on when air may have entered the fuel system.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp comes on
Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a
dealer.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp blinks
Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least
10 minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• The brake fluid is low.
• There is a malfunction in the brake system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on while driving
Press the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.
• If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.
• If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the
transmission to slow the vehicle using engine braking.
1If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on,
the emissions control system and the engine could be
damaged.
If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again when
restarting the engine, drive to the nearest dealer at
50 km/h (30 mph) or less. Have your vehicle
inspected.
1If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
Have your vehicle repaired immediately.
It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there
is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop
immediately in a safe place. If necessary, downshift
the gears.
If the brake system indicator and ABS indicator come
on simultaneously, the electronic brake distribution
system is not working. This can result in vehicle
instability under sudden braking.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
587 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator Comes On
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator
Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• Comes on if there is a problem with the EPS system.
• If you depress the accelerator pedal repeatedly to increase the engine
speed while the engine is idling, the indicator comes on, and
sometimes the steering wheel becomes harder to operate.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and restart the engine.
If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Handling the Unexpected
587
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
588 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes On
If the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when there is a problem with the electric parking brake
system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Avoid using the parking brake and immediately get your vehicle
inspected at a dealer.
■ What to do when the electric parking brake indicator comes on
or blinks at the same time
Release the parking brake.
2 Parking Brake P. 458
Handling the Unexpected
588
• If the electric parking brake indicator remains on or blinks even after
releasing the parking brake, immediately stop the vehicle in a safe
place and call a dealer.
u Prevents your vehicle does move,
Continuously variable transmission models
move the shift lever to (P .
Manual transmission models
move the shift lever to (1 or (R .
• If only the electric parking brake indicator goes off, immediately get
your vehicle inspected at a dealer.
1If the Electric Parking Brake System Indicator Comes On
If you apply parking brake, it may not release.
If the electric parking brake indicator also turns on,
the parking brake is still applied.
When the electric parking brake indicator blinks at
the same time as the electric parking brake system
indicator, the system must be checked. The parking
brake may not operate under these conditions.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
589 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System Indicator Comes On or Blinks
If the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System
Indicator Comes On or Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on/blink
2 Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 455
■ What to do when the indicator blinks, then remains on
Have the tyre inspected by a dealer as soon as possible. If the compact
spare tyre * causes the indicator to blink, change the tyre to a full-size
tyre.
The indicator goes off after driving for a few kilometres (miles).
u Calibrate the deflation warning system after a full-size tyre is
reinstalled.
NOTICE
Driving on an extremely underinflated tyre can cause
it to overheat. An overheated tyre can fail. Always
inflate your tyres to the prescribed level.
Handling the Unexpected
A tyre pressure is significantly low, or the deflation warning system has
not been calibrated. If there is a problem with the deflation warning
system or the compact spare tyre * is installed, the indicator blinks for
about one minute, and then stays on.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Drive carefully and avoid abrupt cornering and hard braking.
Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tyre pressure and adjust the
pressure to the specified level. The specified tyre pressure is on a label on
the driver side doorjamb.
u Calibrate the deflation warning system after the tyre pressure is
adjusted.
1If the Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning System Indicator
Comes On or Blinks
2 Deflation Warning System Calibration P. 455
* Not available on all models
589
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
590 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears
If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears
■ Reasons for the symbol to appear
Appears when the engine oil level is low.
■ What to do as soon as the symbol appears
1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
■ What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Stop the engine and let it sit for about three minutes.
2. Open the bonnet and check the oil level.
2 Oil Check P. 507
Handling the Unexpected
590
1If the Low Oil Level Symbol Appears
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil level can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
This system activates after the engine warms up. If
the outside temperature is extremely low, you may
have to drive for a long time until the system senses
the engine oil level.
If the symbol appears again, stop the engine and
contact a dealer for repairs immediately.
Diesel models
If the PGM-FI Symbol Appears
■ Reasons for the symbol to appear while the engine is running
There is a problem with the engine control system.
■ What to do when the symbol appears repeatedly
Avoid full-throttle acceleration and high speed driving. Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
1If the PGM-FI Symbol Appears
NOTICE
Continuously driving with this symbol on can damage
the emissions controls and engine. Those repairs may
not be covered by your vehicle’s warranties.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
591 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Fuses
Fuse Locations
If any electrical devices are not working, turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 and check to see if any applicable fuse is blown.
■ Engine Compartment Fuse Box
■ Fuse box A
Located near the brake fluid reserve tank. Push the tabs to open the box.
Fuse locations are shown on the image below.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse number in the image and chart.
Handling the Unexpected
Tab
Fuse Box A
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an ignition switch.
Continued
591
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
592 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
5
6
Circuit Protected
Headlight Low Beam Main
–
Hazard
DBW*1
IGP 2*2
Front Wiper
Stop
7
IGP
1
2
3
4
Handling the Unexpected
592
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
IG Coil*1
LAF*2
–
INJ*1
VST 1 *
Main Fan
Starter *
MG Clutch
Battery Sensor
Small Lights
–
Horn
Front Fog Lights *
Back Up (FI ECU)*2
Back Up
Audio *
Sub Fan *
* Not available on all models
Amps
20 A
–
10 A
15 A
30 A
10 A
15 A*1
20 A*2
15 A*1
10 A*2
–
20 A
30 A
30 A
30 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
–
10 A
10 A
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
30 A
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
Circuit Protected
VST 2 *
Starter SW
–
–
IGPS 2*2
Back Up (VST) *
Fl Sub Relay*1
IGP Sub*1
Right Headlight Low Beam
Left Headlight Low Beam
*1:Petrol models
*2:Diesel models
Amps
30 A
7.5 A
–
–
7.5 A
30 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
593 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse box B
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
Pull up the cover on the + terminal, then
remove it while pulling out the tab as
shown.
Replacement of the engine compartment
fuses should be done by a dealer.
Circuit Protected
a
Battery Main
b
c
d
RB Main 1
RB Main 2
Glow*2
Amps
100 A*1
150 A*2
70 A
80 A
70 A
*1:Petrol models
*2:Diesel models
Tab
Handling the Unexpected
a
b
c
d
Continued
593
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
594 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Interior Fuse Box
■ Fuse Box A
Located behind the instrument panel.
Fuse locations are shown on the image below.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse number in the image and chart.
Handling the Unexpected
594
Fuse Box
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
595 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
* Not available on all models
Amps
20 A
–
10 A
10 A
10 A
–
–
20 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
7.5 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
10 A
–
15 A
10 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
Circuit Protected
Starter
ABS/VSA
SRS
Left Headlight High Beam
ACG
Relay
Fuel Pump
SRS 2 *
Meter
Mission SOL
Front Accessory Socket
ACC*1
ACC*2
Option
Rear Wiper
–
–
Amps
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
15 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
20 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
–
–
Handling the Unexpected
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Circuit Protected
Door Lock
–
Keyless Access System *
Left Side Door Unlock
Right Side Door Unlock
–
–
Driver’s Power Window
Passenger’s Power Window
Rear Left Power Window
Rear Right Power Window
Left Side Door Lock
Right Side Door Lock
Rear Fog Light *
Right Headlight High Beam
STS *
Sunshade *
Panoramic Glass Roof *
Seat Heaters *
Daytime Running Lights
–
Washer
Rear Wiper Main *
A/C
Daytime Running Lights
*1:Models with keyless access system
*2:Models without keyless access system
Continued
595
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
596 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse Box B
Fuse locations are shown on the image below.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse number in the image and chart.
Remove the cover by putting the flat-tip screwdriver into the side slot as shown.
Cover
Handling the Unexpected
596
Fuse Box B
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
597 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
Circuit Protected
Interior Lights
Centre Accessory Power
Socket *
Rear Demister*4
ACC Keylock *
Heated Door Mirror *
Heater Motor *
Front Wiper *
Amps
7.5 A
20 A
30 A
7.5 A
10 A
7.5 A
30 A
*1:Models with keyless access system
*2:Models without keyless access system
*3:Petrol models
*4:Diesel models
Handling the Unexpected
Circuit Protected
Amps
Electric Power Steering (EPS) 70 A
30 A*1
IG Main
50 A*2
Fuse Box Main 2
50 A
1
ABS/VSA Motor
40 A
Fuse Box Main
30 A
Fuse Box Main 3
40 A
Rear Demister
30 A
Left Electric Parking Brake
30 A
*1
IG
Main
2
30 A
2*3
Heater Motor
40 A
Right Electric Parking Brake 30 A
–
–
A/C PTC 1
40 A
A/C PTC 2
40 A
A/C
PTC
3
40 A
2*4
A/C PTC 4
40 A
Right Electric Parking Brake 30 A
Left Electric Parking Brake
30 A
3
Heater Motor*4
40 A
4
IG Main 2*1, *4
30 A
5
ABS/VSA FSR
30 A
6
Super Locking *
20 A
Rear Accessory Power
7
20 A
Socket *
8
–
–
* Not available on all models
Continued
597
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
598 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Fuse box C
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
Left-hand drive type
Fuse Box C
Located behind the steering column.
Fuse locations are shown on the label of the
fuse box.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
Fuse Label
Handling the Unexpected
598
Fuse Box C
Right-hand drive type
Located behind the glove box.
Fuse locations are shown on the label of the
glove box.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
2 How to Replace the Dust and Pollen
Filter P. 547
Fuse Label
* Not available on all models
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
–
–
Circuit Protected
Amps
–
–
IG1 Relay 2
7.5 A
Electric Power Pump * (10 A)
–
–
Accessory
7.5 A
IG1 Relay 1
7.5 A
Back Up 2 Main
15 A
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
599 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuFusesuInspecting and Changing Fuses
Inspecting and Changing Fuses
1. Turn the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1. Turn
headlights and all accessories off.
2. Check the fuses on the battery in the
engine compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, have it replaced by a
dealer.
Blown
Fuse Box on the Battery
Blown Fuse
5. Inspect the small fuses in the engine
compartment and the vehicle interior.
u If there is a burned out fuse, remove it
and replace it with a new one.
NOTICE
Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating
greatly increases the chances of damaging the
electrical system.
Replace fuse with a new one of the same specified
amperage.
Use the charts to locate the fuse in question and
confirm the specified amperage.
2 Fuse Locations P. 591
Handling the Unexpected
3. Remove the fuse box cover.
4. Check the large fuse in the engine
compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, use a Phillips-head
screwdriver to remove the screw and
replace it with a new one.
Combined Fuse
1Inspecting and Changing Fuses
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
599
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
600 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Emergency Towing
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.
■ Flat bed equipment
The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck.
This is the best way to transport your vehicle.
■ Wheel lift equipment
The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tyres and lift them off
the ground. The rear tyres remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to
tow your vehicle.
Handling the Unexpected
600
1Emergency Towing
NOTICE
Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will
cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed
to support the vehicle's weight.
Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain.
It is very dangerous, since ropes or chains may shift
from side to side or break.
Make sure the parking brake is released. If you
cannot release the parking brake, your vehicle must
be transported by the flat bed equipment.
2 Parking Brake P. 458
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
601 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuEmergency Towingu
■ If your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground:
Cover
1. Check the ground underneath the vehicle
around where the transmission housing is
for a fluid leak.
u If you find a leak, call a professional
towing service and have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
2. Push the left side of the cover to remove it.
u The detachable towing hook mounts on
the anchor in the front bumper.
1 If your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground:
Towing a vehicle is prohibited by law in some
countries.
Check and follow the legal requirements of the
country you are driving before towing your vehicle.
If you cannot follow the exact procedure, do not tow
your vehicle with the front wheels on the ground.
Manual transmission models
• Turning the ignition switch to LOCK (0 *1 locks the
steering wheel.
With the front wheels on the ground, it is best to tow
the vehicle no farther than 80 km (50 miles), and
keep the speed below 55 km/h (34 mph).
Handling the Unexpected
If you cannot turn on the engine, you may experience
the following while your vehicle is being towed.
• Braking may become difficult since the brake
system’s power assist is disabled.
• Steering wheel becomes heavy as the power
steering system is disabled.
Going down a long slope heats up the brakes. This
may prevent the brakes from working properly. If
your vehicle needs to be towed on an incline, call a
professional towing service.
Make sure to use the properly-designed and attached
towing equipment.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
Continued
601
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
602 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuEmergency Towingu
Wheel Nut
Wrench
Towing Hook
Handling the Unexpected
3. Take the towing hook and the wheel nut
wrench out of the luggage area.
4. Screw the towing hook into the hole, and
tighten it with the wheel nut wrench
securely.
5. Hook the towing device to the towing
hook.
6. Start the engine.
u If it is difficult to turn on the engine, put
the ignition switch in ACCESSORY (q or
ON (w *1.
Manual transmission models
7. Shift to (N .
Continuously variable transmission models
7. Depress the brake pedal.
8. Shift to (D and hold for five seconds, then
to (N .
All models
9. Release the parking brake.
*1: Models with the keyless access system have an ENGINE START/STOP button instead of an
ignition switch.
602
1 If your vehicle must be towed with the front wheels on the ground:
NOTICE
Continuously variable transmission models
If you cannot shift the transmission or turn on the
engine, will damage the transmission. Your vehicle
must be transported with the front wheels off the
ground.
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
603 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
■ What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
1When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
If you cannot open the tailgate, use the following procedure.
1. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip
screwdriver. Put it into the cover as shown
in the image, and open it.
2. Wrap a cloth around the flat-tip
screwdriver. Put it into the lid as shown in
the image, and open the lid.
Lid
Continued
When you open the tailgate from inside, make sure
there is enough space around the tailgate, and it
does not hit anyone or any object.
Handling the Unexpected
Cover
After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have
your vehicle checked.
603
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
604 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuWhen You Cannot Open the Tailgateu
3. To open the tailgate, push the tailgate
while sliding the lever to the right.
Lever
Handling the Unexpected
604
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
605 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Refueling
Diesel models
Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container
If you have run out of fuel and need to refuel your vehicle from a portable fuel
container, use the funnel provided with your vehicle.
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Pull on the fuel fill door release handle
under the driver’s side lower outside corner
of the dashboard.
u
The fuel fill door opens.
Funnel
Case
3. Take the funnel out of the luggage area.
2 Types of Tools P. 556
6. Fill the tank with fuel from the portable fuel
container.
u Pour fuel carefully so you do not spill any.
7. Remove the funnel from the filler neck.
u Wipe up any fuel from the funnel before
storing it.
8. Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
3 WARNING
Fuel is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
NOTICE
Do not insert the nozzle of a portable fuel container
or any funnel other than the one provided with your
vehicle. Doing so can damage the fuel system.
Do not try to pry open or push open the sealed fuel
tank with foreign objects. This can damage the fuel
system and its seal.
Make sure the fuel in the portable fuel container is
diesel fuel before you refuel.
Handling the Unexpected
4. Remove the funnel from the case.
5. Insert the funnel into the filler neck fully
and slowly.
1Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container
605
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
606
606 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
607 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Information
This chapter includes your vehicle's specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other
information required by regulation.
Specifications.................................... 608
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number and Transmission
Number ......................................... 614
Devices that Emit Radio Waves * ..... 615
EC Declaration of conformity Content
Outline * ........................................... 616
* Not available on all models
607
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
608 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Specifications
■ Engine Specifications
Petrol models
■ Vehicle Specifications
Type
*1
Model
Curb Weight
HR-V
Honda HR-V*2
1,241 – 1,313 kg (2,736 – 2,895 lbs)*3
1,249 – 1,322 kg (2,754 – 2,914 lbs)*4
Maximum permissible
1,790 kg (3,946 lbs)
weight
Front 960 kg (2,116 lbs)*3
Maximum permissible
965 kg (2,127 lbs)*4
axle weight
Rear 865 kg (1,907 lbs)
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
Except Turkish models
Turkish models
Manual transmission models
Continuously variable transmission models
Bore x Stroke
Displacement
Compression Ratio
Spark Plugs
Water cooled 4-stroke DOHC i-VTEC in line,
4-cylinder petrol engine
73.0 x 89.5 mm (2.87 x 3.52 in)
1,498 cm3 (91.4 cu-in)
11.5 : 1
NGK
DILZKAR7C11S
DENSO
DXE22HCR11S
■ Fuel
Fuel: Type
Fuel Tank Capacity
Premium unleaded petrol, Research octane
number of 95 or higher
50 L (11.0 Imp gal)
■ Battery
Capacity
Type
48AH(5)/60AH(20)
L2
■ Washer Fluid
Tank Capacity
Information
608
2.5 L (2.2 Imp qt)
■ Light Bulbs
Headlights (High/Low Beam)*1
Headlights (Low Beam)*2
Headlights (High Beam)*2
Position/Daytime Running Lights
Front Turn Signal Lights
Front Fog Lights *
Side Turn Signal Lights
(on Door Mirrors)
Brake/Taillights *
Brake Lights *
Taillights *
Taillights (on tailgate) *
Rear Turn Signal Lights
Back-Up Lights
Rear Fog Light
Rear Licence Plate Lights
High-Mount Brake Light
Interior Lights
Front and Rear Map
Lights
Vanity Mirror Lights
Luggage Area Light
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
* Not available on all models
60/55W (H4)
LED
60W (HB3)
21/5W*3
LED*4
21W (Amber)
35W (H8)
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
21W (Amber)
16W
21W
LED
LED
LED
2W
5W
Models without LED low beam headlights
Models with LED low beam headlights
Models without LED type position/daytime running lights
Models with LED type position/daytime running lights
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
609 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Brake/Clutch * Fluid
Specified
■ Continuously Variable Transmission
Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Honda Manual Transmission Fluid
Change
1.9 L (1.7 Imp qt)
■ Tyre
European models
Honda ENG Oil #1.0, Honda Green Oil,
ACEA A3/B3, A5/B5, 0W-20
Recommended
Honda HCF-2 Transmission Fluid
Change
3.4 L (3.0 Imp qt)
■ Manual Transmission Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
■ Engine Oil
Brake Fluid with DOT 3 or DOT 4
Capacity
Capacity
Pressure
Except European models
Genuine Honda Motor Oil,
API service SM or higher grade,
0W-20, 0W-30, 5W-30, 10W-30
Change
3.4 L (3.0 Imp qt)
Change
including
3.6 L (3.2 Imp qt)
filter
■ Engine Coolant
Specified
Ratio
Size
Regular
Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
50/50 with distilled water
3.63 L (0.799 Imp gal)
(change including the remaining 0.475 L
(0.1045 Imp gal) in the reserve tank)
Compact
Spare*1
Wheel Size
Size
Pressure
kPa (bar [psi])
Regular
Compact Spare*1
215/60R16 95H
215/55R17 94V
See the label on driver’s
doorjamb.
T135/90D16 102M
420 (4.2 [60])
16 x 7J*2
17 x 7J*3
16 x 4T
For the tyre size and pressure information, see the label on
driver’s doorjamb.
*1: Vehicle with compact spare tyre
*2: Models with 215/60R16 tyres
*3: Models with 215/55R17 tyres
■ Honda TRK Air Compressor*1
A weighted emission sound pressure level
A weighted sound power level
80 ± 5 dB (A)
91.5 ± 5 dB (A)
*1: Vehicle with tyre repair kit
Type
Front
Rear
Parking
* Not available on all models
Information
■ Brake
Power assisted
Ventilated disc
Solid disc
Electric parking brake system
Continued
609
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
610 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Dimensions
Length
Width
Height
Including antenna
Wheelbase
Track
Front
Rear
4,294 mm (169.1 in)
1,772 mm (69.8 in)
1,580 mm (62.2 in)
1,605 mm (63.2 in)
2,610 mm (102.8 in)
1,535 mm (60.4 in)
1,540 mm (60.6 in)
■ The mounting point/rear over hang of
coupling device
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
No.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Dimensions
610 mm (24.0 in)
592 mm (23.3 in)
358 mm (14.1 in)
227 mm (8.9 in)
950 mm (37.4 in)
1,068 mm (42.0 in)
1,078 mm (42.4 in)
888 mm (35.0 in)
■ Max. Towing Weight
(5) (6) (7)
(8)
Information
NOTE:
1.
marks show towbar fixing points.
2.
mark shows towbar coupling point.
610
Trailer with brakes
1,000 kg (2,205 Ibs)
Trailer without brakes
500 kg (1,102 Ibs)
The maximum permissible vertical load on
70 kg (154 Ibs)
the coupling device
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
611 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Engine Specifications
Diesel models
■ Vehicle Specifications
Type
*1
Model
HR-V
Honda HR-V*2
1,324 – 1,404 kg (2,919 – 3,095 lbs)
Curb Weight
Maximum permissible
1,870 kg (4,123 lbs)
weight
Maximum permissible Front 1,025 kg (2,260 lbs)
axle weight
Rear 865 kg (1,907 lbs)
*1: Except Turkish models
*2: Turkish models
Bore x Stroke
Displacement
Compression Ratio
Water cooled 4-stroke DOHC i-DTEC diesel
engine with turbo charger, intercooler
76.0 x 88.0 mm (2.99 x 3.46 in)
1,597 cm3 (97.4 cu-in)
16.0 : 1
■ Fuel
Fuel: Type
Fuel Tank Capacity
EN590 standard diesel fuel
50 L (11.0 Imp gal)
■ Battery
Capacity
Type
48AH(5)/60AH(20)
L2
■ Washer Fluid
Tank Capacity
2.5 L (2.2 Imp qt)
■ Light Bulbs
Headlights (High/Low Beam)*1
Headlights (Low Beam)*2
Headlights (High Beam)*2
Position/Daytime Running Lights
*1:
*2:
*3:
*4:
* Not available on all models
LED
LED
LED
LED
LED
21W (Amber)
16W
21W
LED
LED
LED
2W
5W
Models without LED low beam headlights
Models with LED low beam headlights
Models without LED type position/daytime running lights
Models with LED type position/daytime running lights
Continued
Information
Front Turn Signal Lights
Front Fog Lights *
Side Turn Signal Lights
(on Door Mirrors)
Brake/Taillights *
Brake Lights *
Taillights *
Taillights (on tailgate) *
Rear Turn Signal Lights
Back-Up Lights
Rear Fog Light
Rear Licence Plate Lights
High-Mount Brake Light
Interior Lights
Front and Rear Map
Lights
Vanity Mirror Lights
Luggage Area Light
60/55W (H4)
LED
60W (HB3)
21/5W*3
LED*4
21W (Amber)
35W (H8)
611
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
612 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Brake/Clutch Fluid
Specified
■ Engine Oil
Brake Fluid with DOT 3 or DOT 4
■ Tyre
European models
Honda Diesel Oil #1.0, ACEA C2/C3, 0W-30
■ Manual Transmission Fluid
Specified
Capacity
Recommended
Honda Manual Transmission Fluid
Change
1.9 L (1.7 Imp qt)
Capacity
Capacity
Pressure
Except European models
Honda Diesel Oil #1.0, ACEA C2/C3, 0W-30,
5W-30
Change
4.3 L (3.8 Imp qt)
Change
including
4.7 L (4.1 Imp qt)
filter
■ Engine Coolant
Specified
Ratio
Size
Regular
Honda All Season Antifreeze/Coolant Type2
50/50 with distilled water
4.46 L (0.981 Imp gal)
(change including the remaining 0.53 L
(0.117 Imp gal) in the reserve tank)
Compact
Spare*1
Wheel Size
Size
Pressure
kPa (bar [psi])
Regular
Compact Spare*1
215/60R16 95H
215/55R17 94V
See the label on driver’s
doorjamb.
T135/90D16 102M
420 (4.2 [60])
16 x 7J*2
17 x 7J*3
16 x 4T
For the tyre size and pressure information, see the label on
driver’s doorjamb.
*1: Vehicle with compact spare tyre
*2: Models with 215/60R16 tyres
*3: Models with 215/55R17 tyres
■ Honda TRK Air Compressor*1
A weighted emission sound pressure level
A weighted sound power level
*1: Vehicle with tyre repair kit
Information
612
■ Brake
Type
Front
Rear
Parking
Power assisted
Ventilated disc
Solid disc
Electric parking brake system
80 ± 5 dB (A)
91.5 ± 5 dB (A)
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
613 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Dimensions
Length
Width
Height
Including antenna
Wheelbase
Track
Front
Rear
4,294 mm (169.1 in)
1,772 mm (69.8 in)
1,580 mm (62.2 in)
1,605 mm (63.2 in)
2,610 mm (102.8 in)
1,535 mm (60.4 in)
1,540 mm (60.6 in)
■ The mounting point/rear over hang of
coupling device
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
No.
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
Dimensions
610 mm (24.0 in)
592 mm (23.3 in)
358 mm (14.1 in)
227 mm (8.9 in)
950 mm (37.4 in)
1,068 mm (42.0 in)
1,078 mm (42.4 in)
888 mm (35.0 in)
■ Max. Towing Weight
(5) (6) (7)
Trailer with brakes
1,400 kg (3,086 Ibs)
Trailer without brakes
500 kg (1,102 Ibs)
The maximum permissible vertical load on
70 kg (154 Ibs)
the coupling device
(8)
Information
NOTE:
1.
marks show towbar fixing points.
2.
mark shows towbar coupling point.
613
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
614 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number
and Transmission Number
Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle. See the
image below for the locations of your vehicle's VIN, engine number and
transmission number.
Petrol models
Engine Number
Cover
Certification Label/Vehicle Identification Number
Diesel models
Information
Engine Number
Vehicle
Identification
Number
Manual Transmission
Number
Vehicle Identification
Number
Certification Label/Vehicle Identification Number
614
* Not available on all models
The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is
located under the cover.
Vehicle
Identification
Number
Continuously Variable
Transmission Number */
Manual Transmission
Number *
Vehicle Identification
Number
1Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number and
Transmission Number
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
615 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Devices that Emit Radio Waves *
The following products and systems on your vehicle emit radio waves when in
operation.
Remote Transmitter
*
Immobilizer System
Keyless Access System
1Devices that Emit Radio Waves *
*
European models
Models with remote transmitter
Models with keyless access system
EC Directives
Each of the items in the table complies with the
essential requirements and other relevant provisions
of R & TTE (Radio equipment and
Telecommunications Terminal Equipment and the
mutual recognition of their conformity) Directive
1999/5/EC.
See the following URLs for Declaration of conformity:
http://www.techinfo.honda-eu.com
European models
Models with colour audio system
See the following URLs for Declaration of conformity
(DoC) of Hands Free Telephone:
http://www.ptc.panasonic.eu/
Information
* Not available on all models
615
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
616 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
EC Declaration of conformity Content Outline *
Information
616
* Not available on all models
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
617 ページ
2017年9月8日
金曜日 午後1時53分
Index
Index
Numbers
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode ................... 409
A
Security Code.......................................... 236
Theft Protection ...................................... 236
USB Flash Drives ...................................... 319
USB Port.................................................. 231
Audio/Information Screen ............... 238, 269
Auto Idle Stop .................................. 415, 419
Indicator.................................................. 100
OFF Button...................................... 415, 419
System Indicator...................................... 101
Automatic Brake Hold ............................. 461
Indicator............................................ 89, 461
Automatic Brake Hold System
Indicator............................................ 89, 461
Auxiliary Input Jack.................................. 233
Average Fuel Economy ............................ 131
Average Speed ......................................... 132
B
Battery ...................................................... 540
Charging System Indicator................. 90, 585
Jump Starting.......................................... 579
Maintenance (Checking the Battery)........ 540
Maintenance (Replacing) ......................... 541
Belts (Seat) .................................................. 38
Beverage Holders ..................................... 211
Bluetooth® Audio ............................. 265, 303
Booster Seats (For Children) ...................... 80
Brake System ............................................ 458
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)................... 464
Automatic Brake Hold ............................. 461
Index
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System).................. 464
Accessories and Modifications ................ 484
Accessory Power Sockets ......................... 214
Adding
Coolant .......................................... 510, 512
Engine Oil ............................................... 509
Washer ................................................... 516
Additives, Engine Oil ....................... 505, 506
Adjustable Speed Limiter ........................ 427
Adjusting
Armrest .................................................. 206
Clock ...................................................... 146
Front Seats.............................................. 197
Head Restraints....................................... 199
Headlights .............................................. 183
Mirrors.................................................... 193
Rear Seats............................................... 203
Steering Wheel ....................................... 192
Temperature ........................................... 132
Air Conditioning System (Climate Control
System).................................................... 219
Changing the Mode........................ 219, 220
Defrosting the Windscreen and
Windows .............................................. 222
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 547
Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode................... 221
Sensors.................................................... 227
Synchronized Mode ................................. 226
Using Automatic Climate Control ............ 219
Air Pressure ............................... 534, 609, 612
Airbags ........................................................ 50
After a Collision......................................... 53
Airbag Care ............................................... 62
Event Data Recorder .................................... 1
Front Airbags (SRS) .................................... 52
Indicator .............................................. 60, 94
Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator ......... 61
Sensors...................................................... 50
Side Airbags .............................................. 57
Side Curtain Airbags .................................. 59
AM/FM Radio .................................... 244, 287
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 464
Indicator .................................................... 94
Armrest ..................................................... 206
Audio Remote Controls............................ 234
Audio System ............................................ 230
Adjusting the Sound ........................ 242, 284
Auxiliary Input Jack .................................. 233
Error Messages ........................................ 314
General Information ................................ 317
HDMITM Port ............................................ 232
iPod................................................. 259, 297
MP3/WMA/AAC .............. 256, 262, 294, 300
Reactivating............................................. 236
Recommended CDs ................................. 317
Recommended Devices ............................ 319
Remote Controls ..................................... 234
617
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
618 ページ
2017年9月8日
Brake Assist System ................................. 465
Fluid ........................................................ 515
Foot Brake ............................................... 460
Indicator ...................................... 86, 87, 586
Parking Brake .......................................... 458
Brake System Indicator (Amber) ................ 87
Brake System Indicator (Red) ............. 86, 586
Brightness Control (Instrument Panel) .... 190
Bulb Replacement..................................... 519
Back-Up Lights......................................... 526
Brake Lights/Taillights .............................. 526
Front Fog Lights....................................... 521
Front Turn Signal Lights ........................... 523
Headlights ............................................... 519
High-Mount Brake Light .......................... 527
Luggage Area Light ................................. 529
Position/Daytime Running Lights .............. 524
Rear Fog Light ......................................... 528
Rear Licence Plate Lights .......................... 527
Rear Turn Signal Lights ............................ 525
Side Turn Signal Lights............................. 524
Taillights .................................................. 526
Bulb Specifications............................ 608, 611
Index
618
C
Carbon Monoxide Gas................................ 82
Carrying Luggage ............................. 389, 391
CD Player ........................................... 256, 294
Changing Bulbs......................................... 519
Charging System Indicator ................. 90, 585
金曜日 午後1時53分
Child Restraint System ............................... 63
Booster Seats ............................................ 80
Child Restraint System for Infants .............. 66
Child Restraint System for Small
Children .................................................. 68
Installing a Child Restraint System
with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt .................. 75
Larger Children ......................................... 79
Rear-facing Child Restraint System ............ 66
Selecting a Child Restraint System ............. 69
Using a Tether........................................... 78
Child Safety................................................. 63
Childproof Door Locks............................. 160
City-Brake Active System ......................... 466
Indicator.......................................... 108, 109
Cleaning the Exterior ............................... 551
Cleaning the Interior................................ 549
Climate Control System............................ 219
Changing the Mode ........................ 219, 220
Defrosting the Windscreen and
Windows............................................... 222
Dust and Pollen Filter............................... 547
Recirculation and Fresh Air Mode ............ 221
Sensors ................................................... 227
Synchronized Mode................................. 226
Using Automatic Climate Control ............ 219
Clock.......................................................... 146
Clutch Fluid............................................... 515
Coat Hooks ............................................... 216
Compact Spare Tyre ................. 568, 609, 612
Console Compartment ............................. 210
Continuously Variable Transmission ....... 404
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode ................... 409
Creeping................................................. 404
Fluid ....................................................... 514
Kickdown ............................................... 404
Operating the Shift Lever ................ 406, 408
Shift Lever Does Not Move ...................... 582
Shifting........................................... 405, 407
Controls .................................................... 145
Coolant (Engine) .............................. 510, 512
Adding to the Radiator ................... 511, 513
Adding to the Reserve Tank ............ 510, 512
Overheating............................................ 583
Creeping
(Continuously Variable Transmission)... 404
Cruise Control .......................................... 424
Cup Holders .............................................. 211
Customized Features ....................... 136, 322
D
DAB ................................................... 252, 291
Daytime Running Lights .......................... 186
Dead Battery ............................................ 579
Deflation Warning System ...................... 455
Calibration.............................................. 455
Indicator ................................................... 99
Defrosting the Windscreen and
Windows ................................................. 222
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ............... 615
Diesel .................................................. 26, 480
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
619 ページ
2017年9月8日
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF).................. 517
Dimming
Headlights .............................................. 178
Rearview Mirror ...................................... 193
Dipstick (Engine Oil) ................................ 507
Directional Signals (Turn Signals) ........... 177
Display Button.......................................... 234
Display Setup.................................... 243, 285
Door Mirrors............................................. 194
Doors ........................................................ 148
Door and Tailgate Open Indicator ....... 37, 97
Keys........................................................ 148
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Inside .............................................. 158
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from
the Outside ........................................... 152
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 157
Driving ...................................................... 387
Braking ................................................... 458
Continuously Variable Transmission ........ 404
Cruise Control ........................................ 424
Shifting Gear .......................... 405, 407, 412
Starting the Engine ......................... 397, 400
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 547
Eco Assist System........................................ 11
ECON Button ............................................ 423
Elapsed Time ............................................ 131
Electric Parking Brake
Indicator .................................................... 88
Electric Parking Brake System
Indicator ............................................ 88, 588
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator ............................................ 98, 587
Emergency ................................................ 600
Emergency Stop Signal............................. 471
Engine
Coolant ........................................... 510, 512
Jump Starting .......................................... 579
Oil ................................................... 505, 506
Starting ........................................... 397, 400
Switch Buzzer .......................................... 172
Engine Coolant ................................. 510, 512
Adding to the Radiator .................... 511, 513
Adding to the Reserve Tank ............. 510, 512
Overheating ............................................ 583
Engine Oil ......................................... 505, 506
Adding .................................................... 509
Checking ................................................. 507
Low Oil Level Symbol ............................... 590
Low Oil Pressure Indicator.................. 88, 585
Recommended Engine Oil................ 505, 506
Engine Start/Stop Button ......................... 173
EPS (Electric Power Steering)
System ............................................... 98, 587
Exhaust Gas Hazard
(Carbon Monoxide) .................................. 82
Expanded View Driver’s Mirror ............... 196
Exterior Care (Cleaning) ........................... 551
Exterior Mirrors ........................................ 194
F
Features .................................................... 229
Filter
Dust and Pollen ....................................... 547
Flat Tyre .................................................... 557
Floor Mats................................................. 550
Fluids
Brake/Clutch ........................................... 515
Continuously Variable Transmission......... 514
Engine Coolant ............................... 510, 512
Manual Transmission............................... 514
Windscreen Washer ................................ 516
FM/AM Radio.................................... 244, 287
Fog Light Indicator................................... 102
Folding Down the Rear Seats .................. 204
Foot Brake ................................................ 460
Forward Collision Warning...................... 438
Indicator.................................................. 106
Front Airbags (SRS)..................................... 52
Front Seats ................................................ 197
Adjusting ................................................ 197
Fuel............................................................ 479
Economy ................................................. 483
Gauge..................................................... 132
Instant Fuel Economy .............................. 132
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 93
Range ..................................................... 131
Recommendation ............................ 479, 480
Index
E
金曜日 午後1時53分
619
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
620 ページ
2017年9月8日
Refueling ................................................. 479
Fuel Economy............................................ 483
Fuel Fill Cap......................................... 25, 481
Fuel Fill Door......................... 25, 26, 481, 482
Fuses .......................................................... 591
Inspecting and Changing ......................... 599
Locations ................................................. 591
G
Gauges....................................................... 128
Gear Shift Lever Positions
Continuously Variable
Transmission .................................. 405, 407
Manual Transmission ............................... 412
Glass (care) ........................................ 549, 552
Glove Box .................................................. 210
Glow Plugs Indicator .................................. 92
H
Index
620
Halogen Bulbs................................... 519, 522
Hands-Free Telephone (HFT) System ....... 348
Automatic Import of Mobile Phonebook
and Call History ............................. 360, 380
HFT Buttons..................................... 348, 369
HFT Menus ...................................... 350, 372
HFT Status Display ........................... 349, 371
Limitations for Manual Operation .... 349, 371
Making a Call .................................. 363, 383
Options During a Call ...................... 368, 386
金曜日 午後1時53分
Phone Setup.................................... 354, 375
Receiving a Call ............................... 367, 386
Ring Tone........................................ 358, 379
Speed Dial....................................... 361, 381
Hazard Warning Button .......................... 4, 5
HDMITM ...................................................... 305
Head Restraints ........................................ 199
Headlights................................................. 178
Adjuster .................................................. 183
Aiming .................................................... 519
Automatic Operation............................... 179
Dimming ................................................. 178
High Beam Support ................................. 184
Operating................................................ 178
HFT (Hands-Free Telephone) ................... 348
High Beam Support System ..................... 184
High Beam Support System Indicator ..... 105
High-Beam Indicator ................................ 102
Hill Start Assist System ..................... 399, 402
Honda TRK................................................ 557
I
Identification Numbers ............................ 614
Vehicle Identification ............................... 614
Ignition Switch ......................................... 172
Illumination Control
Knob....................................................... 190
Immobilizer System .................................. 163
Indicator.................................................. 103
Indicators .................................................... 86
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................... 94
Auto Idle Stop......................................... 100
Auto Idle Stop System............................. 101
Automatic Brake Hold....................... 89, 461
Automatic Brake Hold System ........... 89, 461
Brake System (Amber) ............................... 87
Brake System (Red) ................................... 86
Charging System....................................... 90
City-Brake Active System (CTBA) ..... 108, 109
Cruise Main .................................... 424, 425
Door and Tailgate Open...................... 37, 97
ECON Mode ................................... 104, 423
Electric Parking Brake ................................ 88
Electric Parking Brake System ............ 88, 588
Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System ............................................ 98, 587
Fog Light ................................................ 102
Forward Collision Warning...................... 106
Glow Plugs ............................................... 92
High Beam Support System..................... 105
High-Beam.............................................. 102
Immobilizer System ................................. 103
Keyless Access System............................. 104
Lane Departure Warning......................... 107
Lights On ................................................ 102
Low Fuel ................................................... 93
Low Oil Pressure ....................................... 88
Low Tyre Pressure/Deflation Warning
System .................................................... 99
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ...................... 90
Passenger Front Airbag On/Off.................. 95
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
621 ページ
2017年9月8日
Seat Belt Reminder.................................... 92
Security System Alarm............................. 104
Shift Lever Position.................................... 90
Shift Up/Down .......................................... 91
Supplemental Restraint System ................. 94
System Message ....................................... 98
Transmission ............................................. 91
Turn Signal and Hazard Warning............. 102
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System.......... 96
VSA OFF ................................................... 96
Instant Fuel Economy .............................. 132
Instrument Panel........................................ 85
Brightness Control .................................. 190
Intelligent Speed Limiter......................... 431
Interior Lights........................................... 207
Interior Rearview Mirror ......................... 193
J
Jack (Wheel Nut Wrench)........................ 571
Jump Starting........................................... 579
K
150
152
157
148
157
148
150
Rear Door Won’t Open ............................ 160
Remote Transmitter ................................. 154
Types and Functions ................................ 148
Won’t Turn................................................ 29
Kickdown
(Continuously Variable Transmission) ... 404
L
Lane Departure Warning ......................... 442
Button ..................................................... 443
Indicator .................................................. 107
Language (HFT) ................................ 349, 371
Light Switches ........................................... 178
Lights................................................. 178, 519
Automatic ............................................... 179
Bulb Replacement.................................... 519
Daytime Running Lights ........................... 186
Fog Lights................................................ 181
High Beam Support System Indicator ....... 105
High-Beam Indicator ................................ 102
Interior .................................................... 207
Lights On Indicator .................................. 102
Turn Signals............................................. 177
Load Limit ................................................. 391
Locking/Unlocking .................................... 148
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 160
From Inside.............................................. 158
From Outside........................................... 152
Keys ........................................................ 148
Using a Key ............................................. 156
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 157
Low Battery Charge ................................. 585
Low Fuel Indicator...................................... 93
Low Keyless Remote Signal Strength...... 151
Low Oil Level .................................... 114, 590
Low Oil Pressure Indicator ................. 88, 585
Lower Anchorages ..................................... 72
Lubricant Specifications Chart......... 609, 612
Luggage (Load Limit) ............................... 391
Luggage Area
Light Bulb................................................ 529
M
Maintenance............................................. 485
Battery .................................................... 540
Brake/Clutch Fluid ................................... 515
Cleaning ................................................. 549
Climate Control....................................... 546
Coolant........................................... 510, 512
Oil........................................................... 507
Precautions ............................................. 486
Radiator .......................................... 511, 513
Remote Transmitter................................. 544
Replacing Light Bulbs .............................. 519
Safety...................................................... 487
Transmission Fluid ................................... 514
Tyres ....................................................... 534
Under the Bonnet.................................... 502
Malfunction Indicator Lamp.............. 90, 586
Manual Transmission ............................... 412
Index
Key Number Tag ......................................
Keyless Access System ..............................
Keyless Lockout Prevention.....................
Keys...........................................................
Lockout Prevention .................................
Master Keys ............................................
Number Tag............................................
金曜日 午後1時53分
621
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
622 ページ
2017年9月8日
Map Lights ................................................ 208
Maximum Permissible Weight ................. 391
Meters, Gauges ......................................... 128
Mirrors....................................................... 193
Adjusting................................................. 193
Door........................................................ 194
Exterior.................................................... 194
Interior Rearview...................................... 193
Modifications (and Accessories)............... 484
MP3.................................... 256, 262, 294, 300
Multi-Information Display........................ 129
Multi-View Rear Camera .......................... 477
N
Numbers (Identification) .......................... 614
O
Index
622
Odometer.................................................. 131
Oil (Engine) ....................................... 505, 506
Adding .................................................... 509
Checking ................................................. 507
Low Oil Level Symbol ....................... 114, 590
Low Oil Pressure Indicator.................. 88, 585
Recommended Engine Oil................ 505, 506
Viscosity .......................................... 505, 506
On Board Apps.......................................... 307
Open Source Licences ............................... 321
Opening/Closing
Bonnet .................................................... 504
金曜日 午後1時53分
Panoramic Glass Roof and Sunshade .......
Power Windows ......................................
Tailgate ...................................................
Outside Temperature Display..................
Overheating..............................................
170
167
161
132
583
P
Paddle Shifters
(7-Speed Manual Shift Mode)................ 409
Panoramic Glass Roof............................... 170
Parking Brake ........................................... 458
Parking Sensor System ............................. 473
Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator ....... 61
Passing Indicators ..................................... 178
Petrol................................................... 25, 479
Economy ................................................. 483
Gauge..................................................... 132
Information ............................................. 479
Instant Fuel Economy .............................. 132
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 93
Refueling................................................. 479
PGM-FI Symbol ................................. 127, 590
Playing Bluetooth® Audio................ 265, 303
Power Windows ....................................... 167
Precautions While Driving ....................... 403
Rain ........................................................ 403
Pregnant Women ....................................... 47
Puncture (Tyre) ......................................... 557
R
Radiator ............................................ 511, 513
Radio (AM/FM) ................................. 244, 287
Radio (DAB)...................................... 252, 291
Radio (FM/AM) ................................. 244, 287
Radio Data System (RDS) ................. 245, 289
Range........................................................ 131
RDS (Radio Data System) ................. 245, 289
Rear Demister/Heated Door Mirror
Icon ......................................................... 191
Rear Seats (Folding Down) ...................... 204
Rearview Mirror ....................................... 193
Refueling .................................................. 479
Diesel.............................................. 480, 611
Fuel Gauge ............................................. 132
Low Fuel Indicator..................................... 93
Petrol .............................................. 479, 608
Regulations .............................................. 615
Remote Transmitter ................................. 154
Replacement
Battery............................................ 541, 544
Bulbs ...................................................... 519
Fuses ...................................................... 591
Tyres....................................................... 536
Wiper Blade Rubber ................................ 530
Resetting a Trip Meter............................. 131
Reverse Tilt Door Mirror .......................... 194
S
Safe Driving................................................ 33
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
623 ページ
2017年9月8日
Shift Up/Down Indicator ............................ 91
Shifting
Continuously Variable
Transmission.................................. 405, 407
Manual Transmission ............................... 412
Shoulder Anchor......................................... 45
Side Airbags ................................................ 57
Side Curtain Airbags................................... 59
Siri Eyes Free ............................................. 313
Smartphone Connection .......................... 308
Spare Tyre ................................. 568, 609, 612
Spark Plugs................................................ 608
Specifications ............................................ 608
Specified Fuel.................... 479, 480, 608, 611
Speed Limiter, Adjustable ........................ 427
Speed Limiter, Intelligent ........................ 431
Speedometer ............................................ 128
SRS Airbags (Airbags) ................................. 52
Start/Stop Button...................................... 173
Starting Assist Brake Function ................. 418
Starting the Engine .......................... 397, 400
Does Not Start ......................................... 575
Engine Switch Buzzer .............................. 172
Jump Starting .......................................... 579
Steering Wheel
Adjusting................................................. 192
Stopping.................................................... 472
Sunshade ................................................... 171
Super Locking ........................................... 166
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) ........ 52
Switches (Around the Steering
Wheel)......................................... 4, 5, 6, 172
System Message Indicator.......................... 98
T
Tachometer............................................... 128
Tailgate ..................................................... 161
Temperature
Outside Temperature Display................... 132
Temperature Sensor......................... 132, 227
Temporary Repair Kit (TRK)..................... 557
Time (Setting) ........................................... 146
Tonneau Cover ......................................... 217
Tools.......................................................... 556
Towing a Trailer ....................................... 392
Equipment and Accessories ..................... 394
Load Limits.............................................. 392
Towing Your Vehicle
Emergency .............................................. 600
Traffic Sign Recognition System.............. 446
Small Icons On and Off............................ 452
Transmission ............................. 405, 407, 412
7-Speed Manual Shift Mode.................... 409
Continuously Variable ..................... 405, 407
Fluid........................................................ 514
Manual ................................................... 412
Shift Lever Position Indicator...... 90, 406, 408
Trip Meter................................................. 131
TRK (Temporary Repair Kit)..................... 557
Troubleshooting....................................... 555
Index
Safety Check............................................... 37
Safety Labels .............................................. 83
Safety Message ............................................ 0
Seat Belts .................................................... 38
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor ................. 45
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................. 42
Checking .................................................. 48
Fastening .................................................. 43
Installing a Child Restraint System
with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt.................. 75
Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt .............................. 43
Pregnant Women...................................... 47
Reminder .................................................. 40
Warning Indicator ............................... 40, 92
Seat Heaters ............................................. 218
Seats.......................................................... 197
Adjusting ................................................ 197
Front Seats.............................................. 197
Rear Seats............................................... 203
Security System ........................................ 163
Immobilizer System Indicator................... 103
Security System Alarm Indicator .............. 104
SEL/RESET Button ..................................... 130
Selecting a Child Restraint System............ 69
Selector Knob (Audio) ............................. 237
Setting the Clock...................................... 146
Shift Lever .......................... 23, 405, 407, 412
Operation ......................... 23, 406, 408, 412
Releasing ................................................ 582
Won’t Move ........................................... 582
Shift Lever Position Indicator .... 90, 406, 408
金曜日 午後1時53分
623
16 2XP-B HDMC (KE KG)-32T7A6100.book
624 ページ
2017年9月8日
Blown Fuse .............................................. 591
Brake Pedal Vibrates .................................. 29
Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door .......... 30
Emergency Towing .................................. 600
Engine Won’t Start .................................. 575
Noise When Braking .................................. 31
Overheating............................................. 583
Puncture/Flat Tyre ............................ 557, 568
Rear Door Won’t Open .............................. 30
Shift Lever Won’t Move ........................... 582
Warning Indicators .................................... 86
Turn Signals............................................... 177
Indicators (Instrument Panel).................... 102
Tyres .......................................................... 534
Air Pressure ............................. 534, 609, 612
Checking and Maintaining....................... 534
Inspection................................................ 534
Puncture (Flat Tyre) .......................... 557, 568
Rotation .................................................. 537
Spare Tyre ............................... 568, 609, 612
Temporary Repair Kit (TRK) ...................... 557
Tyre Chains.............................................. 538
Wear Indicators ....................................... 535
Winter ..................................................... 538
Index
U
Ultrasonic Sensors.....................................
Unlocking the Doors from the Inside ......
Unlocking the Doors from the Outside...
USB Flash Drives........................................
624
165
158
152
319
金曜日 午後1時53分
USB Port .................................................... 231
Using the Keyless Access System ............. 152
V
Vanity Mirrors............................................... 9
Vehicle Identification Numbers............... 614
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) ................... 453
Off Button............................................... 454
Off Indicator.............................................. 96
System Indicator........................................ 96
Ventilation........................................ 219, 221
Viscosity (Oil) .................... 505, 506, 609, 612
VSA (Vehicle Stability Assist) ................... 453
W
Warning and Information
Messages ................................................. 110
Warning Indicator On/Blinking ............... 585
Warning Labels........................................... 83
Watts................................................. 608, 611
WAV .......................................................... 300
Wear Indicators (Tyre).............................. 535
Wheel Nut Wrench (Jack Handle) ........... 572
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate .... 603
Wi-Fi Connection...................................... 311
Window Washers
Adding/Refilling Fluid .............................. 516
Switch..................................................... 187
Windows (Opening and Closing) ............ 167
Windscreen
Cleaning ......................................... 549, 552
Defrosting/Defogging ............................. 222
Washer Fluid........................................... 516
Wiper Blades........................................... 530
Wipers and Washers ............................... 187
Winter Tyres ............................................. 538
Tyre Chains............................................. 538
Wipers and Washers ................................ 187
Checking and Replacing Wiper Blades..... 530
WMA................................. 256, 262, 294, 300
Worn Tyres ............................................... 534